blob: 792d615363f4dadf6781fb43dbe1d10d89483c0e [file] [log] [blame]
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00001//===- InstructionCombining.cpp - Combine multiple instructions -----------===//
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002//
John Criswellb576c942003-10-20 19:43:21 +00003// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
5// This file was developed by the LLVM research group and is distributed under
6// the University of Illinois Open Source License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007//
John Criswellb576c942003-10-20 19:43:21 +00008//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00009//
10// InstructionCombining - Combine instructions to form fewer, simple
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000011// instructions. This pass does not modify the CFG This pass is where algebraic
12// simplification happens.
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000013//
14// This pass combines things like:
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +000015// %Y = add i32 %X, 1
16// %Z = add i32 %Y, 1
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000017// into:
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +000018// %Z = add i32 %X, 2
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000019//
20// This is a simple worklist driven algorithm.
21//
Chris Lattner065a6162003-09-10 05:29:43 +000022// This pass guarantees that the following canonicalizations are performed on
Chris Lattner2cd91962003-07-23 21:41:57 +000023// the program:
24// 1. If a binary operator has a constant operand, it is moved to the RHS
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +000025// 2. Bitwise operators with constant operands are always grouped so that
26// shifts are performed first, then or's, then and's, then xor's.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000027// 3. Compare instructions are converted from <,>,<=,>= to ==,!= if possible
28// 4. All cmp instructions on boolean values are replaced with logical ops
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +000029// 5. add X, X is represented as (X*2) => (X << 1)
30// 6. Multiplies with a power-of-two constant argument are transformed into
31// shifts.
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000032// ... etc.
Chris Lattner2cd91962003-07-23 21:41:57 +000033//
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000034//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
35
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +000036#define DEBUG_TYPE "instcombine"
Chris Lattner022103b2002-05-07 20:03:00 +000037#include "llvm/Transforms/Scalar.h"
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +000038#include "llvm/IntrinsicInst.h"
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000039#include "llvm/Pass.h"
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000040#include "llvm/DerivedTypes.h"
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000041#include "llvm/GlobalVariable.h"
Chris Lattner79066fa2007-01-30 23:46:24 +000042#include "llvm/Analysis/ConstantFolding.h"
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +000043#include "llvm/Target/TargetData.h"
44#include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/BasicBlockUtils.h"
45#include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/Local.h"
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000046#include "llvm/Support/CallSite.h"
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000047#include "llvm/Support/Debug.h"
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000048#include "llvm/Support/GetElementPtrTypeIterator.h"
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000049#include "llvm/Support/InstVisitor.h"
Chris Lattnerbcd7db52005-08-02 19:16:58 +000050#include "llvm/Support/MathExtras.h"
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000051#include "llvm/Support/PatternMatch.h"
Chris Lattnera4f0b3a2006-08-27 12:54:02 +000052#include "llvm/Support/Compiler.h"
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000053#include "llvm/ADT/DenseMap.h"
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000054#include "llvm/ADT/SmallVector.h"
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +000055#include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h"
Reid Spencer551ccae2004-09-01 22:55:40 +000056#include "llvm/ADT/Statistic.h"
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000057#include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h"
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +000058#include <algorithm>
Reid Spencera9b81012007-03-26 17:44:01 +000059#include <sstream>
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +000060using namespace llvm;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000061using namespace llvm::PatternMatch;
Brian Gaeked0fde302003-11-11 22:41:34 +000062
Chris Lattner0e5f4992006-12-19 21:40:18 +000063STATISTIC(NumCombined , "Number of insts combined");
64STATISTIC(NumConstProp, "Number of constant folds");
65STATISTIC(NumDeadInst , "Number of dead inst eliminated");
66STATISTIC(NumDeadStore, "Number of dead stores eliminated");
67STATISTIC(NumSunkInst , "Number of instructions sunk");
Chris Lattnera92f6962002-10-01 22:38:41 +000068
Chris Lattner0e5f4992006-12-19 21:40:18 +000069namespace {
Chris Lattnerf4b54612006-06-28 22:08:15 +000070 class VISIBILITY_HIDDEN InstCombiner
71 : public FunctionPass,
72 public InstVisitor<InstCombiner, Instruction*> {
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000073 // Worklist of all of the instructions that need to be simplified.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000074 std::vector<Instruction*> Worklist;
75 DenseMap<Instruction*, unsigned> WorklistMap;
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +000076 TargetData *TD;
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +000077 bool MustPreserveLCSSA;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000078 public:
Nick Lewyckyecd94c82007-05-06 13:37:16 +000079 static char ID; // Pass identification, replacement for typeid
Devang Patel794fd752007-05-01 21:15:47 +000080 InstCombiner() : FunctionPass((intptr_t)&ID) {}
81
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000082 /// AddToWorkList - Add the specified instruction to the worklist if it
83 /// isn't already in it.
84 void AddToWorkList(Instruction *I) {
85 if (WorklistMap.insert(std::make_pair(I, Worklist.size())))
86 Worklist.push_back(I);
87 }
88
89 // RemoveFromWorkList - remove I from the worklist if it exists.
90 void RemoveFromWorkList(Instruction *I) {
91 DenseMap<Instruction*, unsigned>::iterator It = WorklistMap.find(I);
92 if (It == WorklistMap.end()) return; // Not in worklist.
93
94 // Don't bother moving everything down, just null out the slot.
95 Worklist[It->second] = 0;
96
97 WorklistMap.erase(It);
98 }
99
100 Instruction *RemoveOneFromWorkList() {
101 Instruction *I = Worklist.back();
102 Worklist.pop_back();
103 WorklistMap.erase(I);
104 return I;
105 }
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000106
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000107
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000108 /// AddUsersToWorkList - When an instruction is simplified, add all users of
109 /// the instruction to the work lists because they might get more simplified
110 /// now.
111 ///
Chris Lattner6dce1a72006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000112 void AddUsersToWorkList(Value &I) {
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000113 for (Value::use_iterator UI = I.use_begin(), UE = I.use_end();
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000114 UI != UE; ++UI)
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000115 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(*UI));
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000116 }
117
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000118 /// AddUsesToWorkList - When an instruction is simplified, add operands to
119 /// the work lists because they might get more simplified now.
120 ///
121 void AddUsesToWorkList(Instruction &I) {
122 for (unsigned i = 0, e = I.getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
123 if (Instruction *Op = dyn_cast<Instruction>(I.getOperand(i)))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000124 AddToWorkList(Op);
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000125 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000126
127 /// AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist - The specified instruction is about to become
128 /// dead. Add all of its operands to the worklist, turning them into
129 /// undef's to reduce the number of uses of those instructions.
130 ///
131 /// Return the specified operand before it is turned into an undef.
132 ///
133 Value *AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(Instruction &I, unsigned op) {
134 Value *R = I.getOperand(op);
135
136 for (unsigned i = 0, e = I.getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
137 if (Instruction *Op = dyn_cast<Instruction>(I.getOperand(i))) {
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000138 AddToWorkList(Op);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000139 // Set the operand to undef to drop the use.
140 I.setOperand(i, UndefValue::get(Op->getType()));
141 }
142
143 return R;
144 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000145
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000146 public:
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000147 virtual bool runOnFunction(Function &F);
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +0000148
149 bool DoOneIteration(Function &F, unsigned ItNum);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000150
Chris Lattner97e52e42002-04-28 21:27:06 +0000151 virtual void getAnalysisUsage(AnalysisUsage &AU) const {
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +0000152 AU.addRequired<TargetData>();
Owen Andersond1b78a12006-07-10 19:03:49 +0000153 AU.addPreservedID(LCSSAID);
Chris Lattnercb2610e2002-10-21 20:00:28 +0000154 AU.setPreservesCFG();
Chris Lattner97e52e42002-04-28 21:27:06 +0000155 }
156
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +0000157 TargetData &getTargetData() const { return *TD; }
158
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000159 // Visitation implementation - Implement instruction combining for different
160 // instruction types. The semantics are as follows:
161 // Return Value:
162 // null - No change was made
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +0000163 // I - Change was made, I is still valid, I may be dead though
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000164 // otherwise - Change was made, replace I with returned instruction
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000165 //
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000166 Instruction *visitAdd(BinaryOperator &I);
167 Instruction *visitSub(BinaryOperator &I);
168 Instruction *visitMul(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +0000169 Instruction *visitURem(BinaryOperator &I);
170 Instruction *visitSRem(BinaryOperator &I);
171 Instruction *visitFRem(BinaryOperator &I);
172 Instruction *commonRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
173 Instruction *commonIRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +0000174 Instruction *commonDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
175 Instruction *commonIDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
176 Instruction *visitUDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
177 Instruction *visitSDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
178 Instruction *visitFDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000179 Instruction *visitAnd(BinaryOperator &I);
180 Instruction *visitOr (BinaryOperator &I);
181 Instruction *visitXor(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +0000182 Instruction *visitShl(BinaryOperator &I);
183 Instruction *visitAShr(BinaryOperator &I);
184 Instruction *visitLShr(BinaryOperator &I);
185 Instruction *commonShiftTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000186 Instruction *visitFCmpInst(FCmpInst &I);
187 Instruction *visitICmpInst(ICmpInst &I);
188 Instruction *visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(ICmpInst &ICI);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +0000189 Instruction *visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(ICmpInst &ICI,
190 Instruction *LHS,
191 ConstantInt *RHS);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +0000192 Instruction *FoldICmpDivCst(ICmpInst &ICI, BinaryOperator *DivI,
193 ConstantInt *DivRHS);
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +0000194
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000195 Instruction *FoldGEPICmp(User *GEPLHS, Value *RHS,
196 ICmpInst::Predicate Cond, Instruction &I);
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +0000197 Instruction *FoldShiftByConstant(Value *Op0, ConstantInt *Op1,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +0000198 BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000199 Instruction *commonCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
200 Instruction *commonIntCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +0000201 Instruction *commonPointerCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +0000202 Instruction *visitTrunc(TruncInst &CI);
203 Instruction *visitZExt(ZExtInst &CI);
204 Instruction *visitSExt(SExtInst &CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000205 Instruction *visitFPTrunc(CastInst &CI);
206 Instruction *visitFPExt(CastInst &CI);
207 Instruction *visitFPToUI(CastInst &CI);
208 Instruction *visitFPToSI(CastInst &CI);
209 Instruction *visitUIToFP(CastInst &CI);
210 Instruction *visitSIToFP(CastInst &CI);
211 Instruction *visitPtrToInt(CastInst &CI);
212 Instruction *visitIntToPtr(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +0000213 Instruction *visitBitCast(BitCastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +0000214 Instruction *FoldSelectOpOp(SelectInst &SI, Instruction *TI,
215 Instruction *FI);
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +0000216 Instruction *visitSelectInst(SelectInst &CI);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000217 Instruction *visitCallInst(CallInst &CI);
218 Instruction *visitInvokeInst(InvokeInst &II);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000219 Instruction *visitPHINode(PHINode &PN);
220 Instruction *visitGetElementPtrInst(GetElementPtrInst &GEP);
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +0000221 Instruction *visitAllocationInst(AllocationInst &AI);
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +0000222 Instruction *visitFreeInst(FreeInst &FI);
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +0000223 Instruction *visitLoadInst(LoadInst &LI);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +0000224 Instruction *visitStoreInst(StoreInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +0000225 Instruction *visitBranchInst(BranchInst &BI);
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +0000226 Instruction *visitSwitchInst(SwitchInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +0000227 Instruction *visitInsertElementInst(InsertElementInst &IE);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +0000228 Instruction *visitExtractElementInst(ExtractElementInst &EI);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +0000229 Instruction *visitShuffleVectorInst(ShuffleVectorInst &SVI);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000230
231 // visitInstruction - Specify what to return for unhandled instructions...
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000232 Instruction *visitInstruction(Instruction &I) { return 0; }
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000233
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000234 private:
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +0000235 Instruction *visitCallSite(CallSite CS);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000236 bool transformConstExprCastCall(CallSite CS);
237
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +0000238 public:
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000239 // InsertNewInstBefore - insert an instruction New before instruction Old
240 // in the program. Add the new instruction to the worklist.
241 //
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000242 Instruction *InsertNewInstBefore(Instruction *New, Instruction &Old) {
Chris Lattnere6f9a912002-08-23 18:32:43 +0000243 assert(New && New->getParent() == 0 &&
244 "New instruction already inserted into a basic block!");
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000245 BasicBlock *BB = Old.getParent();
246 BB->getInstList().insert(&Old, New); // Insert inst
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000247 AddToWorkList(New);
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000248 return New;
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000249 }
250
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000251 /// InsertCastBefore - Insert a cast of V to TY before the instruction POS.
252 /// This also adds the cast to the worklist. Finally, this returns the
253 /// cast.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000254 Value *InsertCastBefore(Instruction::CastOps opc, Value *V, const Type *Ty,
255 Instruction &Pos) {
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000256 if (V->getType() == Ty) return V;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000257
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +0000258 if (Constant *CV = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000259 return ConstantExpr::getCast(opc, CV, Ty);
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +0000260
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000261 Instruction *C = CastInst::create(opc, V, Ty, V->getName(), &Pos);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000262 AddToWorkList(C);
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000263 return C;
264 }
265
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000266 // ReplaceInstUsesWith - This method is to be used when an instruction is
267 // found to be dead, replacable with another preexisting expression. Here
268 // we add all uses of I to the worklist, replace all uses of I with the new
269 // value, then return I, so that the inst combiner will know that I was
270 // modified.
271 //
272 Instruction *ReplaceInstUsesWith(Instruction &I, Value *V) {
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000273 AddUsersToWorkList(I); // Add all modified instrs to worklist
Chris Lattner15a76c02004-04-05 02:10:19 +0000274 if (&I != V) {
275 I.replaceAllUsesWith(V);
276 return &I;
277 } else {
278 // If we are replacing the instruction with itself, this must be in a
279 // segment of unreachable code, so just clobber the instruction.
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +0000280 I.replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner15a76c02004-04-05 02:10:19 +0000281 return &I;
282 }
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000283 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000284
Chris Lattner6dce1a72006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000285 // UpdateValueUsesWith - This method is to be used when an value is
286 // found to be replacable with another preexisting expression or was
287 // updated. Here we add all uses of I to the worklist, replace all uses of
288 // I with the new value (unless the instruction was just updated), then
289 // return true, so that the inst combiner will know that I was modified.
290 //
291 bool UpdateValueUsesWith(Value *Old, Value *New) {
292 AddUsersToWorkList(*Old); // Add all modified instrs to worklist
293 if (Old != New)
294 Old->replaceAllUsesWith(New);
295 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Old))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000296 AddToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +0000297 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(New))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000298 AddToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner6dce1a72006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000299 return true;
300 }
301
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000302 // EraseInstFromFunction - When dealing with an instruction that has side
303 // effects or produces a void value, we can't rely on DCE to delete the
304 // instruction. Instead, visit methods should return the value returned by
305 // this function.
306 Instruction *EraseInstFromFunction(Instruction &I) {
307 assert(I.use_empty() && "Cannot erase instruction that is used!");
308 AddUsesToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000309 RemoveFromWorkList(&I);
Chris Lattner954f66a2004-11-18 21:41:39 +0000310 I.eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000311 return 0; // Don't do anything with FI
312 }
313
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +0000314 private:
Chris Lattner24c8e382003-07-24 17:35:25 +0000315 /// InsertOperandCastBefore - This inserts a cast of V to DestTy before the
316 /// InsertBefore instruction. This is specialized a bit to avoid inserting
317 /// casts that are known to not do anything...
318 ///
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000319 Value *InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::CastOps opcode,
320 Value *V, const Type *DestTy,
Chris Lattner24c8e382003-07-24 17:35:25 +0000321 Instruction *InsertBefore);
322
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000323 /// SimplifyCommutative - This performs a few simplifications for
324 /// commutative operators.
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000325 bool SimplifyCommutative(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +0000326
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000327 /// SimplifyCompare - This reorders the operands of a CmpInst to get them in
328 /// most-complex to least-complex order.
329 bool SimplifyCompare(CmpInst &I);
330
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +0000331 /// SimplifyDemandedBits - Attempts to replace V with a simpler value based
332 /// on the demanded bits.
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000333 bool SimplifyDemandedBits(Value *V, APInt DemandedMask,
334 APInt& KnownZero, APInt& KnownOne,
335 unsigned Depth = 0);
336
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000337 Value *SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(Value *V, uint64_t DemandedElts,
338 uint64_t &UndefElts, unsigned Depth = 0);
339
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +0000340 // FoldOpIntoPhi - Given a binary operator or cast instruction which has a
341 // PHI node as operand #0, see if we can fold the instruction into the PHI
342 // (which is only possible if all operands to the PHI are constants).
343 Instruction *FoldOpIntoPhi(Instruction &I);
344
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +0000345 // FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI - If all operands to a PHI node are the same "unary"
346 // operator and they all are only used by the PHI, PHI together their
347 // inputs, and do the operation once, to the result of the PHI.
348 Instruction *FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN);
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +0000349 Instruction *FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN);
350
351
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000352 Instruction *OptAndOp(Instruction *Op, ConstantInt *OpRHS,
353 ConstantInt *AndRHS, BinaryOperator &TheAnd);
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +0000354
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000355 Value *FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS, ConstantInt *Mask,
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +0000356 bool isSub, Instruction &I);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000357 Instruction *InsertRangeTest(Value *V, Constant *Lo, Constant *Hi,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000358 bool isSigned, bool Inside, Instruction &IB);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +0000359 Instruction *PromoteCastOfAllocation(BitCastInst &CI, AllocationInst &AI);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +0000360 Instruction *MatchBSwap(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +0000361 bool SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(StoreInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +0000362
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +0000363 Value *EvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const Type *Ty, bool isSigned);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000364 };
Chris Lattnerf6293092002-07-23 18:06:35 +0000365
Devang Patel19974732007-05-03 01:11:54 +0000366 char InstCombiner::ID = 0;
Chris Lattner7f8897f2006-08-27 22:42:52 +0000367 RegisterPass<InstCombiner> X("instcombine", "Combine redundant instructions");
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000368}
369
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000370// getComplexity: Assign a complexity or rank value to LLVM Values...
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000371// 0 -> undef, 1 -> Const, 2 -> Other, 3 -> Arg, 3 -> Unary, 4 -> OtherInst
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000372static unsigned getComplexity(Value *V) {
373 if (isa<Instruction>(V)) {
374 if (BinaryOperator::isNeg(V) || BinaryOperator::isNot(V))
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000375 return 3;
376 return 4;
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000377 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000378 if (isa<Argument>(V)) return 3;
379 return isa<Constant>(V) ? (isa<UndefValue>(V) ? 0 : 1) : 2;
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000380}
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000381
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000382// isOnlyUse - Return true if this instruction will be deleted if we stop using
383// it.
384static bool isOnlyUse(Value *V) {
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +0000385 return V->hasOneUse() || isa<Constant>(V);
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000386}
387
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000388// getPromotedType - Return the specified type promoted as it would be to pass
389// though a va_arg area...
390static const Type *getPromotedType(const Type *Ty) {
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +0000391 if (const IntegerType* ITy = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(Ty)) {
392 if (ITy->getBitWidth() < 32)
393 return Type::Int32Ty;
Chris Lattner2b7e0ad2007-05-23 01:17:04 +0000394 }
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +0000395 return Ty;
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000396}
397
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000398/// getBitCastOperand - If the specified operand is a CastInst or a constant
399/// expression bitcast, return the operand value, otherwise return null.
400static Value *getBitCastOperand(Value *V) {
401 if (BitCastInst *I = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(V))
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +0000402 return I->getOperand(0);
403 else if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(V))
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000404 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::BitCast)
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +0000405 return CE->getOperand(0);
406 return 0;
407}
408
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000409/// This function is a wrapper around CastInst::isEliminableCastPair. It
410/// simply extracts arguments and returns what that function returns.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000411static Instruction::CastOps
412isEliminableCastPair(
413 const CastInst *CI, ///< The first cast instruction
414 unsigned opcode, ///< The opcode of the second cast instruction
415 const Type *DstTy, ///< The target type for the second cast instruction
416 TargetData *TD ///< The target data for pointer size
417) {
418
419 const Type *SrcTy = CI->getOperand(0)->getType(); // A from above
420 const Type *MidTy = CI->getType(); // B from above
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000421
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000422 // Get the opcodes of the two Cast instructions
423 Instruction::CastOps firstOp = Instruction::CastOps(CI->getOpcode());
424 Instruction::CastOps secondOp = Instruction::CastOps(opcode);
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000425
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000426 return Instruction::CastOps(
427 CastInst::isEliminableCastPair(firstOp, secondOp, SrcTy, MidTy,
428 DstTy, TD->getIntPtrType()));
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000429}
430
431/// ValueRequiresCast - Return true if the cast from "V to Ty" actually results
432/// in any code being generated. It does not require codegen if V is simple
433/// enough or if the cast can be folded into other casts.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000434static bool ValueRequiresCast(Instruction::CastOps opcode, const Value *V,
435 const Type *Ty, TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000436 if (V->getType() == Ty || isa<Constant>(V)) return false;
437
Chris Lattner01575b72006-05-25 23:24:33 +0000438 // If this is another cast that can be eliminated, it isn't codegen either.
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000439 if (const CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(V))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000440 if (isEliminableCastPair(CI, opcode, Ty, TD))
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000441 return false;
442 return true;
443}
444
445/// InsertOperandCastBefore - This inserts a cast of V to DestTy before the
446/// InsertBefore instruction. This is specialized a bit to avoid inserting
447/// casts that are known to not do anything...
448///
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000449Value *InstCombiner::InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::CastOps opcode,
450 Value *V, const Type *DestTy,
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000451 Instruction *InsertBefore) {
452 if (V->getType() == DestTy) return V;
453 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000454 return ConstantExpr::getCast(opcode, C, DestTy);
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000455
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000456 return InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, DestTy, *InsertBefore);
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000457}
458
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000459// SimplifyCommutative - This performs a few simplifications for commutative
460// operators:
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000461//
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000462// 1. Order operands such that they are listed from right (least complex) to
463// left (most complex). This puts constants before unary operators before
464// binary operators.
465//
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000466// 2. Transform: (op (op V, C1), C2) ==> (op V, (op C1, C2))
467// 3. Transform: (op (op V1, C1), (op V2, C2)) ==> (op (op V1, V2), (op C1,C2))
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000468//
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000469bool InstCombiner::SimplifyCommutative(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000470 bool Changed = false;
471 if (getComplexity(I.getOperand(0)) < getComplexity(I.getOperand(1)))
472 Changed = !I.swapOperands();
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000473
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000474 if (!I.isAssociative()) return Changed;
475 Instruction::BinaryOps Opcode = I.getOpcode();
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000476 if (BinaryOperator *Op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(0)))
477 if (Op->getOpcode() == Opcode && isa<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1))) {
478 if (isa<Constant>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner2a9c8472003-05-27 16:40:51 +0000479 Constant *Folded = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(),
480 cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1)),
481 cast<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1)));
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000482 I.setOperand(0, Op->getOperand(0));
483 I.setOperand(1, Folded);
484 return true;
485 } else if (BinaryOperator *Op1=dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(1)))
486 if (Op1->getOpcode() == Opcode && isa<Constant>(Op1->getOperand(1)) &&
487 isOnlyUse(Op) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
488 Constant *C1 = cast<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1));
489 Constant *C2 = cast<Constant>(Op1->getOperand(1));
490
491 // Fold (op (op V1, C1), (op V2, C2)) ==> (op (op V1, V2), (op C1,C2))
Chris Lattner2a9c8472003-05-27 16:40:51 +0000492 Constant *Folded = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), C1, C2);
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000493 Instruction *New = BinaryOperator::create(Opcode, Op->getOperand(0),
494 Op1->getOperand(0),
495 Op1->getName(), &I);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000496 AddToWorkList(New);
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000497 I.setOperand(0, New);
498 I.setOperand(1, Folded);
499 return true;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000500 }
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000501 }
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000502 return Changed;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000503}
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +0000504
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000505/// SimplifyCompare - For a CmpInst this function just orders the operands
506/// so that theyare listed from right (least complex) to left (most complex).
507/// This puts constants before unary operators before binary operators.
508bool InstCombiner::SimplifyCompare(CmpInst &I) {
509 if (getComplexity(I.getOperand(0)) >= getComplexity(I.getOperand(1)))
510 return false;
511 I.swapOperands();
512 // Compare instructions are not associative so there's nothing else we can do.
513 return true;
514}
515
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000516// dyn_castNegVal - Given a 'sub' instruction, return the RHS of the instruction
517// if the LHS is a constant zero (which is the 'negate' form).
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +0000518//
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000519static inline Value *dyn_castNegVal(Value *V) {
520 if (BinaryOperator::isNeg(V))
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +0000521 return BinaryOperator::getNegArgument(V);
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000522
Chris Lattner0ce85802004-12-14 20:08:06 +0000523 // Constants can be considered to be negated values if they can be folded.
524 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
525 return ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000526 return 0;
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +0000527}
528
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000529static inline Value *dyn_castNotVal(Value *V) {
530 if (BinaryOperator::isNot(V))
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +0000531 return BinaryOperator::getNotArgument(V);
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000532
533 // Constants can be considered to be not'ed values...
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000534 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +0000535 return ConstantInt::get(~C->getValue());
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000536 return 0;
537}
538
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000539// dyn_castFoldableMul - If this value is a multiply that can be folded into
540// other computations (because it has a constant operand), return the
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000541// non-constant operand of the multiply, and set CST to point to the multiplier.
542// Otherwise, return null.
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000543//
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000544static inline Value *dyn_castFoldableMul(Value *V, ConstantInt *&CST) {
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +0000545 if (V->hasOneUse() && V->getType()->isInteger())
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000546 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V)) {
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000547 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul)
Chris Lattner50e60c72004-11-15 05:54:07 +0000548 if ((CST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))))
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000549 return I->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000550 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
Chris Lattner50e60c72004-11-15 05:54:07 +0000551 if ((CST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1)))) {
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000552 // The multiplier is really 1 << CST.
Zhou Sheng97b52c22007-03-29 01:57:21 +0000553 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +0000554 uint32_t CSTVal = CST->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng97b52c22007-03-29 01:57:21 +0000555 CST = ConstantInt::get(APInt(BitWidth, 1).shl(CSTVal));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000556 return I->getOperand(0);
557 }
558 }
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000559 return 0;
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +0000560}
Chris Lattneraf2930e2002-08-14 17:51:49 +0000561
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +0000562/// dyn_castGetElementPtr - If this is a getelementptr instruction or constant
563/// expression, return it.
564static User *dyn_castGetElementPtr(Value *V) {
565 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(V)) return cast<User>(V);
566 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(V))
567 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr)
568 return cast<User>(V);
569 return false;
570}
571
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000572/// AddOne - Add one to a ConstantInt
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000573static ConstantInt *AddOne(ConstantInt *C) {
Reid Spencer2149a9d2007-03-25 19:55:33 +0000574 APInt Val(C->getValue());
575 return ConstantInt::get(++Val);
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000576}
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000577/// SubOne - Subtract one from a ConstantInt
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000578static ConstantInt *SubOne(ConstantInt *C) {
Reid Spencer2149a9d2007-03-25 19:55:33 +0000579 APInt Val(C->getValue());
580 return ConstantInt::get(--Val);
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000581}
582/// Add - Add two ConstantInts together
583static ConstantInt *Add(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
584 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() + C2->getValue());
585}
586/// And - Bitwise AND two ConstantInts together
587static ConstantInt *And(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
588 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() & C2->getValue());
589}
590/// Subtract - Subtract one ConstantInt from another
591static ConstantInt *Subtract(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
592 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() - C2->getValue());
593}
594/// Multiply - Multiply two ConstantInts together
595static ConstantInt *Multiply(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
596 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() * C2->getValue());
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000597}
598
Chris Lattner68d5ff22006-02-09 07:38:58 +0000599/// ComputeMaskedBits - Determine which of the bits specified in Mask are
600/// known to be either zero or one and return them in the KnownZero/KnownOne
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000601/// bit sets. This code only analyzes bits in Mask, in order to short-circuit
602/// processing.
603/// NOTE: we cannot consider 'undef' to be "IsZero" here. The problem is that
604/// we cannot optimize based on the assumption that it is zero without changing
605/// it to be an explicit zero. If we don't change it to zero, other code could
606/// optimized based on the contradictory assumption that it is non-zero.
607/// Because instcombine aggressively folds operations with undef args anyway,
608/// this won't lose us code quality.
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +0000609static void ComputeMaskedBits(Value *V, const APInt &Mask, APInt& KnownZero,
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000610 APInt& KnownOne, unsigned Depth = 0) {
Zhou Sheng771dbf72007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000611 assert(V && "No Value?");
612 assert(Depth <= 6 && "Limit Search Depth");
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000613 uint32_t BitWidth = Mask.getBitWidth();
Zhou Shengaa305ab2007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000614 assert(cast<IntegerType>(V->getType())->getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
Zhou Sheng771dbf72007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000615 KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000616 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
Zhou Shengaa305ab2007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000617 "V, Mask, KnownOne and KnownZero should have same BitWidth");
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000618 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V)) {
619 // We know all of the bits for a constant!
Zhou Sheng771dbf72007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000620 KnownOne = CI->getValue() & Mask;
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000621 KnownZero = ~KnownOne & Mask;
622 return;
623 }
624
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000625 if (Depth == 6 || Mask == 0)
626 return; // Limit search depth.
627
628 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
629 if (!I) return;
630
Zhou Sheng771dbf72007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000631 KnownZero.clear(); KnownOne.clear(); // Don't know anything.
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000632 APInt KnownZero2(KnownZero), KnownOne2(KnownOne);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000633
634 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Reid Spencer2b812072007-03-25 02:03:12 +0000635 case Instruction::And: {
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000636 // If either the LHS or the RHS are Zero, the result is zero.
637 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(1), Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
Reid Spencer2b812072007-03-25 02:03:12 +0000638 APInt Mask2(Mask & ~KnownZero);
639 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask2, KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000640 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
641 assert((KnownZero2 & KnownOne2) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
642
643 // Output known-1 bits are only known if set in both the LHS & RHS.
644 KnownOne &= KnownOne2;
645 // Output known-0 are known to be clear if zero in either the LHS | RHS.
646 KnownZero |= KnownZero2;
647 return;
Reid Spencer2b812072007-03-25 02:03:12 +0000648 }
649 case Instruction::Or: {
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000650 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(1), Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
Reid Spencer2b812072007-03-25 02:03:12 +0000651 APInt Mask2(Mask & ~KnownOne);
652 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask2, KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000653 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
654 assert((KnownZero2 & KnownOne2) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
655
656 // Output known-0 bits are only known if clear in both the LHS & RHS.
657 KnownZero &= KnownZero2;
658 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in either the LHS | RHS.
659 KnownOne |= KnownOne2;
660 return;
Reid Spencer2b812072007-03-25 02:03:12 +0000661 }
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000662 case Instruction::Xor: {
663 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(1), Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
664 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask, KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1);
665 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
666 assert((KnownZero2 & KnownOne2) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
667
668 // Output known-0 bits are known if clear or set in both the LHS & RHS.
669 APInt KnownZeroOut = (KnownZero & KnownZero2) | (KnownOne & KnownOne2);
670 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in only one of the LHS, RHS.
671 KnownOne = (KnownZero & KnownOne2) | (KnownOne & KnownZero2);
672 KnownZero = KnownZeroOut;
673 return;
674 }
675 case Instruction::Select:
676 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(2), Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
677 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(1), Mask, KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1);
678 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
679 assert((KnownZero2 & KnownOne2) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
680
681 // Only known if known in both the LHS and RHS.
682 KnownOne &= KnownOne2;
683 KnownZero &= KnownZero2;
684 return;
685 case Instruction::FPTrunc:
686 case Instruction::FPExt:
687 case Instruction::FPToUI:
688 case Instruction::FPToSI:
689 case Instruction::SIToFP:
690 case Instruction::PtrToInt:
691 case Instruction::UIToFP:
692 case Instruction::IntToPtr:
693 return; // Can't work with floating point or pointers
Zhou Sheng771dbf72007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000694 case Instruction::Trunc: {
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000695 // All these have integer operands
Zhou Sheng771dbf72007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000696 uint32_t SrcBitWidth =
697 cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Shengaa305ab2007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000698 APInt MaskIn(Mask);
699 MaskIn.zext(SrcBitWidth);
700 KnownZero.zext(SrcBitWidth);
701 KnownOne.zext(SrcBitWidth);
702 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), MaskIn, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
Zhou Sheng771dbf72007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000703 KnownZero.trunc(BitWidth);
704 KnownOne.trunc(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000705 return;
Zhou Sheng771dbf72007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000706 }
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000707 case Instruction::BitCast: {
708 const Type *SrcTy = I->getOperand(0)->getType();
709 if (SrcTy->isInteger()) {
710 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
711 return;
712 }
713 break;
714 }
715 case Instruction::ZExt: {
716 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
717 const IntegerType *SrcTy = cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
Zhou Sheng771dbf72007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000718 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = SrcTy->getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +0000719
Zhou Shengaa305ab2007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000720 APInt MaskIn(Mask);
721 MaskIn.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
722 KnownZero.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
723 KnownOne.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
724 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), MaskIn, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000725 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
726 // The top bits are known to be zero.
Zhou Sheng771dbf72007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000727 KnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
728 KnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
Zhou Shengaa305ab2007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000729 KnownZero |= APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000730 return;
731 }
732 case Instruction::SExt: {
733 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
734 const IntegerType *SrcTy = cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
Zhou Sheng771dbf72007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000735 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = SrcTy->getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +0000736
Zhou Shengaa305ab2007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000737 APInt MaskIn(Mask);
738 MaskIn.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
739 KnownZero.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
740 KnownOne.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
741 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), MaskIn, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000742 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Zhou Sheng771dbf72007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000743 KnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
744 KnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000745
746 // If the sign bit of the input is known set or clear, then we know the
747 // top bits of the result.
Zhou Shengaa305ab2007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000748 if (KnownZero[SrcBitWidth-1]) // Input sign bit known zero
Zhou Sheng34a4b382007-03-28 17:38:21 +0000749 KnownZero |= APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth);
Zhou Shengaa305ab2007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000750 else if (KnownOne[SrcBitWidth-1]) // Input sign bit known set
Zhou Sheng34a4b382007-03-28 17:38:21 +0000751 KnownOne |= APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000752 return;
753 }
754 case Instruction::Shl:
755 // (shl X, C1) & C2 == 0 iff (X & C2 >>u C1) == 0
756 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +0000757 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer2b812072007-03-25 02:03:12 +0000758 APInt Mask2(Mask.lshr(ShiftAmt));
759 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask2, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000760 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Zhou Sheng430f6262007-03-12 05:44:52 +0000761 KnownZero <<= ShiftAmt;
762 KnownOne <<= ShiftAmt;
Reid Spencer2149a9d2007-03-25 19:55:33 +0000763 KnownZero |= APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt); // low bits known 0
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000764 return;
765 }
766 break;
767 case Instruction::LShr:
768 // (ushr X, C1) & C2 == 0 iff (-1 >> C1) & C2 == 0
769 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
770 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +0000771 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000772
773 // Unsigned shift right.
Reid Spencer2b812072007-03-25 02:03:12 +0000774 APInt Mask2(Mask.shl(ShiftAmt));
775 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask2, KnownZero,KnownOne,Depth+1);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000776 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0&&"Bits known to be one AND zero?");
777 KnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(KnownZero, ShiftAmt);
778 KnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(KnownOne, ShiftAmt);
Zhou Shengaa305ab2007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000779 // high bits known zero.
780 KnownZero |= APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000781 return;
782 }
783 break;
784 case Instruction::AShr:
Zhou Shengaa305ab2007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000785 // (ashr X, C1) & C2 == 0 iff (-1 >> C1) & C2 == 0
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000786 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
787 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +0000788 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000789
790 // Signed shift right.
Reid Spencer2b812072007-03-25 02:03:12 +0000791 APInt Mask2(Mask.shl(ShiftAmt));
792 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask2, KnownZero,KnownOne,Depth+1);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000793 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0&&"Bits known to be one AND zero?");
794 KnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(KnownZero, ShiftAmt);
795 KnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(KnownOne, ShiftAmt);
796
Zhou Shengaa305ab2007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000797 APInt HighBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt));
798 if (KnownZero[BitWidth-ShiftAmt-1]) // New bits are known zero.
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000799 KnownZero |= HighBits;
Zhou Shengaa305ab2007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000800 else if (KnownOne[BitWidth-ShiftAmt-1]) // New bits are known one.
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000801 KnownOne |= HighBits;
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000802 return;
803 }
804 break;
805 }
806}
807
Reid Spencere7816b52007-03-08 01:52:58 +0000808/// MaskedValueIsZero - Return true if 'V & Mask' is known to be zero. We use
809/// this predicate to simplify operations downstream. Mask is known to be zero
810/// for bits that V cannot have.
811static bool MaskedValueIsZero(Value *V, const APInt& Mask, unsigned Depth = 0) {
Zhou Shengedd089c2007-03-12 16:54:56 +0000812 APInt KnownZero(Mask.getBitWidth(), 0), KnownOne(Mask.getBitWidth(), 0);
Reid Spencere7816b52007-03-08 01:52:58 +0000813 ComputeMaskedBits(V, Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth);
814 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
815 return (KnownZero & Mask) == Mask;
816}
817
Chris Lattner255d8912006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000818/// ShrinkDemandedConstant - Check to see if the specified operand of the
819/// specified instruction is a constant integer. If so, check to see if there
820/// are any bits set in the constant that are not demanded. If so, shrink the
821/// constant and return true.
822static bool ShrinkDemandedConstant(Instruction *I, unsigned OpNo,
Reid Spencer6b79e2d2007-03-12 17:15:10 +0000823 APInt Demanded) {
824 assert(I && "No instruction?");
825 assert(OpNo < I->getNumOperands() && "Operand index too large");
826
827 // If the operand is not a constant integer, nothing to do.
828 ConstantInt *OpC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(OpNo));
829 if (!OpC) return false;
830
831 // If there are no bits set that aren't demanded, nothing to do.
832 Demanded.zextOrTrunc(OpC->getValue().getBitWidth());
833 if ((~Demanded & OpC->getValue()) == 0)
834 return false;
835
836 // This instruction is producing bits that are not demanded. Shrink the RHS.
837 Demanded &= OpC->getValue();
838 I->setOperand(OpNo, ConstantInt::get(Demanded));
839 return true;
840}
841
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000842// ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits - Given a signed integer type and a
843// set of known zero and one bits, compute the maximum and minimum values that
844// could have the specified known zero and known one bits, returning them in
845// min/max.
846static void ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(const Type *Ty,
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +0000847 const APInt& KnownZero,
848 const APInt& KnownOne,
849 APInt& Min, APInt& Max) {
850 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Ty)->getBitWidth();
851 assert(KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
852 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
853 Min.getBitWidth() == BitWidth && Max.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
854 "Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne and Min, Max must have equal bitwidth.");
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +0000855 APInt UnknownBits = ~(KnownZero|KnownOne);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000856
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000857 // The minimum value is when all unknown bits are zeros, EXCEPT for the sign
858 // bit if it is unknown.
859 Min = KnownOne;
860 Max = KnownOne|UnknownBits;
861
Zhou Sheng4acf1552007-03-28 05:15:57 +0000862 if (UnknownBits[BitWidth-1]) { // Sign bit is unknown
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +0000863 Min.set(BitWidth-1);
864 Max.clear(BitWidth-1);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000865 }
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000866}
867
868// ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits - Given an unsigned integer type and
869// a set of known zero and one bits, compute the maximum and minimum values that
870// could have the specified known zero and known one bits, returning them in
871// min/max.
872static void ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(const Type *Ty,
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +0000873 const APInt& KnownZero,
874 const APInt& KnownOne,
875 APInt& Min,
876 APInt& Max) {
877 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Ty)->getBitWidth();
878 assert(KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
879 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
880 Min.getBitWidth() == BitWidth && Max.getBitWidth() &&
881 "Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne and Min, Max must have equal bitwidth.");
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +0000882 APInt UnknownBits = ~(KnownZero|KnownOne);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000883
884 // The minimum value is when the unknown bits are all zeros.
885 Min = KnownOne;
886 // The maximum value is when the unknown bits are all ones.
887 Max = KnownOne|UnknownBits;
888}
Chris Lattner255d8912006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000889
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000890/// SimplifyDemandedBits - This function attempts to replace V with a simpler
891/// value based on the demanded bits. When this function is called, it is known
892/// that only the bits set in DemandedMask of the result of V are ever used
893/// downstream. Consequently, depending on the mask and V, it may be possible
894/// to replace V with a constant or one of its operands. In such cases, this
895/// function does the replacement and returns true. In all other cases, it
896/// returns false after analyzing the expression and setting KnownOne and known
897/// to be one in the expression. KnownZero contains all the bits that are known
898/// to be zero in the expression. These are provided to potentially allow the
899/// caller (which might recursively be SimplifyDemandedBits itself) to simplify
900/// the expression. KnownOne and KnownZero always follow the invariant that
901/// KnownOne & KnownZero == 0. That is, a bit can't be both 1 and 0. Note that
902/// the bits in KnownOne and KnownZero may only be accurate for those bits set
903/// in DemandedMask. Note also that the bitwidth of V, DemandedMask, KnownZero
904/// and KnownOne must all be the same.
905bool InstCombiner::SimplifyDemandedBits(Value *V, APInt DemandedMask,
906 APInt& KnownZero, APInt& KnownOne,
907 unsigned Depth) {
908 assert(V != 0 && "Null pointer of Value???");
909 assert(Depth <= 6 && "Limit Search Depth");
910 uint32_t BitWidth = DemandedMask.getBitWidth();
911 const IntegerType *VTy = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType());
912 assert(VTy->getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
913 KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
914 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
915 "Value *V, DemandedMask, KnownZero and KnownOne \
916 must have same BitWidth");
917 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V)) {
918 // We know all of the bits for a constant!
919 KnownOne = CI->getValue() & DemandedMask;
920 KnownZero = ~KnownOne & DemandedMask;
921 return false;
922 }
923
Zhou Sheng96704452007-03-14 03:21:24 +0000924 KnownZero.clear();
925 KnownOne.clear();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000926 if (!V->hasOneUse()) { // Other users may use these bits.
927 if (Depth != 0) { // Not at the root.
928 // Just compute the KnownZero/KnownOne bits to simplify things downstream.
929 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth);
930 return false;
931 }
932 // If this is the root being simplified, allow it to have multiple uses,
933 // just set the DemandedMask to all bits.
934 DemandedMask = APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth);
935 } else if (DemandedMask == 0) { // Not demanding any bits from V.
936 if (V != UndefValue::get(VTy))
937 return UpdateValueUsesWith(V, UndefValue::get(VTy));
938 return false;
939 } else if (Depth == 6) { // Limit search depth.
940 return false;
941 }
942
943 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
944 if (!I) return false; // Only analyze instructions.
945
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000946 APInt LHSKnownZero(BitWidth, 0), LHSKnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
947 APInt &RHSKnownZero = KnownZero, &RHSKnownOne = KnownOne;
948 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
949 default: break;
950 case Instruction::And:
951 // If either the LHS or the RHS are Zero, the result is zero.
952 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
953 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
954 return true;
955 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
956 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
957
958 // If something is known zero on the RHS, the bits aren't demanded on the
959 // LHS.
960 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero,
961 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
962 return true;
963 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
964 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
965
966 // If all of the demanded bits are known 1 on one side, return the other.
967 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'and'.
968 if ((DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) ==
969 (DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero))
970 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
971 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) ==
972 (DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero))
973 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
974
975 // If all of the demanded bits in the inputs are known zeros, return zero.
976 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|LHSKnownZero)) == DemandedMask)
977 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(VTy));
978
979 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
980 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero))
981 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
982
983 // Output known-1 bits are only known if set in both the LHS & RHS.
984 RHSKnownOne &= LHSKnownOne;
985 // Output known-0 are known to be clear if zero in either the LHS | RHS.
986 RHSKnownZero |= LHSKnownZero;
987 break;
988 case Instruction::Or:
989 // If either the LHS or the RHS are One, the result is One.
990 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
991 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
992 return true;
993 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
994 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
995 // If something is known one on the RHS, the bits aren't demanded on the
996 // LHS.
997 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne,
998 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
999 return true;
1000 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1001 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1002
1003 // If all of the demanded bits are known zero on one side, return the other.
1004 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'or'.
1005 if ((DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownOne & RHSKnownZero) ==
1006 (DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownOne))
1007 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
1008 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownZero) ==
1009 (DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne))
1010 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
1011
1012 // If all of the potentially set bits on one side are known to be set on
1013 // the other side, just use the 'other' side.
1014 if ((DemandedMask & (~RHSKnownZero) & LHSKnownOne) ==
1015 (DemandedMask & (~RHSKnownZero)))
1016 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
1017 if ((DemandedMask & (~LHSKnownZero) & RHSKnownOne) ==
1018 (DemandedMask & (~LHSKnownZero)))
1019 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
1020
1021 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
1022 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
1023 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
1024
1025 // Output known-0 bits are only known if clear in both the LHS & RHS.
1026 RHSKnownZero &= LHSKnownZero;
1027 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in either the LHS | RHS.
1028 RHSKnownOne |= LHSKnownOne;
1029 break;
1030 case Instruction::Xor: {
1031 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
1032 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1033 return true;
1034 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1035 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1036 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
1037 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1038 return true;
1039 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1040 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1041
1042 // If all of the demanded bits are known zero on one side, return the other.
1043 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'xor'.
1044 if ((DemandedMask & RHSKnownZero) == DemandedMask)
1045 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
1046 if ((DemandedMask & LHSKnownZero) == DemandedMask)
1047 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
1048
1049 // Output known-0 bits are known if clear or set in both the LHS & RHS.
1050 APInt KnownZeroOut = (RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownZero) |
1051 (RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownOne);
1052 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in only one of the LHS, RHS.
1053 APInt KnownOneOut = (RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) |
1054 (RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownZero);
1055
1056 // If all of the demanded bits are known to be zero on one side or the
1057 // other, turn this into an *inclusive* or.
1058 // e.g. (A & C1)^(B & C2) -> (A & C1)|(B & C2) iff C1&C2 == 0
1059 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero & ~LHSKnownZero) == 0) {
1060 Instruction *Or =
1061 BinaryOperator::createOr(I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1),
1062 I->getName());
1063 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, *I);
1064 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, Or);
1065 }
1066
1067 // If all of the demanded bits on one side are known, and all of the set
1068 // bits on that side are also known to be set on the other side, turn this
1069 // into an AND, as we know the bits will be cleared.
1070 // e.g. (X | C1) ^ C2 --> (X | C1) & ~C2 iff (C1&C2) == C2
1071 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|RHSKnownOne)) == DemandedMask) {
1072 // all known
1073 if ((RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownOne) == RHSKnownOne) {
1074 Constant *AndC = ConstantInt::get(~RHSKnownOne & DemandedMask);
1075 Instruction *And =
1076 BinaryOperator::createAnd(I->getOperand(0), AndC, "tmp");
1077 InsertNewInstBefore(And, *I);
1078 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, And);
1079 }
1080 }
1081
1082 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
1083 // FIXME: for XOR, we prefer to force bits to 1 if they will make a -1.
1084 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
1085 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
1086
1087 RHSKnownZero = KnownZeroOut;
1088 RHSKnownOne = KnownOneOut;
1089 break;
1090 }
1091 case Instruction::Select:
1092 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(2), DemandedMask,
1093 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1094 return true;
1095 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
1096 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1097 return true;
1098 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1099 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1100 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1101 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1102
1103 // If the operands are constants, see if we can simplify them.
1104 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
1105 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
1106 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 2, DemandedMask))
1107 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
1108
1109 // Only known if known in both the LHS and RHS.
1110 RHSKnownOne &= LHSKnownOne;
1111 RHSKnownZero &= LHSKnownZero;
1112 break;
1113 case Instruction::Trunc: {
1114 uint32_t truncBf =
1115 cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001116 DemandedMask.zext(truncBf);
1117 RHSKnownZero.zext(truncBf);
1118 RHSKnownOne.zext(truncBf);
1119 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
1120 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001121 return true;
1122 DemandedMask.trunc(BitWidth);
1123 RHSKnownZero.trunc(BitWidth);
1124 RHSKnownOne.trunc(BitWidth);
1125 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1126 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1127 break;
1128 }
1129 case Instruction::BitCast:
1130 if (!I->getOperand(0)->getType()->isInteger())
1131 return false;
1132
1133 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
1134 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1135 return true;
1136 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1137 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1138 break;
1139 case Instruction::ZExt: {
1140 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
1141 const IntegerType *SrcTy = cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +00001142 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = SrcTy->getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001143
Zhou Shengd48653a2007-03-29 04:45:55 +00001144 DemandedMask.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1145 RHSKnownZero.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1146 RHSKnownOne.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001147 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
1148 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001149 return true;
1150 DemandedMask.zext(BitWidth);
1151 RHSKnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
1152 RHSKnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
1153 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1154 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1155 // The top bits are known to be zero.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001156 RHSKnownZero |= APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001157 break;
1158 }
1159 case Instruction::SExt: {
1160 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
1161 const IntegerType *SrcTy = cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +00001162 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = SrcTy->getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001163
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001164 APInt InputDemandedBits = DemandedMask &
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001165 APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, SrcBitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001166
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001167 APInt NewBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001168 // If any of the sign extended bits are demanded, we know that the sign
1169 // bit is demanded.
1170 if ((NewBits & DemandedMask) != 0)
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00001171 InputDemandedBits.set(SrcBitWidth-1);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001172
Zhou Shengd48653a2007-03-29 04:45:55 +00001173 InputDemandedBits.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1174 RHSKnownZero.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1175 RHSKnownOne.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001176 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), InputDemandedBits,
1177 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001178 return true;
1179 InputDemandedBits.zext(BitWidth);
1180 RHSKnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
1181 RHSKnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
1182 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1183 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1184
1185 // If the sign bit of the input is known set or clear, then we know the
1186 // top bits of the result.
1187
1188 // If the input sign bit is known zero, or if the NewBits are not demanded
1189 // convert this into a zero extension.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001190 if (RHSKnownZero[SrcBitWidth-1] || (NewBits & ~DemandedMask) == NewBits)
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001191 {
1192 // Convert to ZExt cast
1193 CastInst *NewCast = new ZExtInst(I->getOperand(0), VTy, I->getName(), I);
1194 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewCast);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001195 } else if (RHSKnownOne[SrcBitWidth-1]) { // Input sign bit known set
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001196 RHSKnownOne |= NewBits;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001197 }
1198 break;
1199 }
1200 case Instruction::Add: {
1201 // Figure out what the input bits are. If the top bits of the and result
1202 // are not demanded, then the add doesn't demand them from its input
1203 // either.
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00001204 uint32_t NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001205
1206 // If there is a constant on the RHS, there are a variety of xformations
1207 // we can do.
1208 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
1209 // If null, this should be simplified elsewhere. Some of the xforms here
1210 // won't work if the RHS is zero.
1211 if (RHS->isZero())
1212 break;
1213
1214 // If the top bit of the output is demanded, demand everything from the
1215 // input. Otherwise, we demand all the input bits except NLZ top bits.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001216 APInt InDemandedBits(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - NLZ));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001217
1218 // Find information about known zero/one bits in the input.
1219 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), InDemandedBits,
1220 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1221 return true;
1222
1223 // If the RHS of the add has bits set that can't affect the input, reduce
1224 // the constant.
1225 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, InDemandedBits))
1226 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
1227
1228 // Avoid excess work.
1229 if (LHSKnownZero == 0 && LHSKnownOne == 0)
1230 break;
1231
1232 // Turn it into OR if input bits are zero.
1233 if ((LHSKnownZero & RHS->getValue()) == RHS->getValue()) {
1234 Instruction *Or =
1235 BinaryOperator::createOr(I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1),
1236 I->getName());
1237 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, *I);
1238 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, Or);
1239 }
1240
1241 // We can say something about the output known-zero and known-one bits,
1242 // depending on potential carries from the input constant and the
1243 // unknowns. For example if the LHS is known to have at most the 0x0F0F0
1244 // bits set and the RHS constant is 0x01001, then we know we have a known
1245 // one mask of 0x00001 and a known zero mask of 0xE0F0E.
1246
1247 // To compute this, we first compute the potential carry bits. These are
1248 // the bits which may be modified. I'm not aware of a better way to do
1249 // this scan.
Zhou Shengb9cb95f2007-03-31 02:38:39 +00001250 const APInt& RHSVal = RHS->getValue();
1251 APInt CarryBits((~LHSKnownZero + RHSVal) ^ (~LHSKnownZero ^ RHSVal));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001252
1253 // Now that we know which bits have carries, compute the known-1/0 sets.
1254
1255 // Bits are known one if they are known zero in one operand and one in the
1256 // other, and there is no input carry.
1257 RHSKnownOne = ((LHSKnownZero & RHSVal) |
1258 (LHSKnownOne & ~RHSVal)) & ~CarryBits;
1259
1260 // Bits are known zero if they are known zero in both operands and there
1261 // is no input carry.
1262 RHSKnownZero = LHSKnownZero & ~RHSVal & ~CarryBits;
1263 } else {
1264 // If the high-bits of this ADD are not demanded, then it does not demand
1265 // the high bits of its LHS or RHS.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001266 if (DemandedMask[BitWidth-1] == 0) {
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001267 // Right fill the mask of bits for this ADD to demand the most
1268 // significant bit and all those below it.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001269 APInt DemandedFromOps(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-NLZ));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001270 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedFromOps,
1271 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1272 return true;
1273 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedFromOps,
1274 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1275 return true;
1276 }
1277 }
1278 break;
1279 }
1280 case Instruction::Sub:
1281 // If the high-bits of this SUB are not demanded, then it does not demand
1282 // the high bits of its LHS or RHS.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001283 if (DemandedMask[BitWidth-1] == 0) {
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001284 // Right fill the mask of bits for this SUB to demand the most
1285 // significant bit and all those below it.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00001286 uint32_t NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001287 APInt DemandedFromOps(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-NLZ));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001288 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedFromOps,
1289 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1290 return true;
1291 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedFromOps,
1292 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1293 return true;
1294 }
1295 break;
1296 case Instruction::Shl:
1297 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00001298 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001299 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.lshr(ShiftAmt));
1300 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001301 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1302 return true;
1303 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1304 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1305 RHSKnownZero <<= ShiftAmt;
1306 RHSKnownOne <<= ShiftAmt;
1307 // low bits known zero.
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001308 if (ShiftAmt)
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00001309 RHSKnownZero |= APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001310 }
1311 break;
1312 case Instruction::LShr:
1313 // For a logical shift right
1314 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00001315 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001316
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001317 // Unsigned shift right.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001318 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.shl(ShiftAmt));
1319 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001320 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1321 return true;
1322 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1323 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001324 RHSKnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownZero, ShiftAmt);
1325 RHSKnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownOne, ShiftAmt);
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001326 if (ShiftAmt) {
1327 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001328 APInt HighBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt));
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001329 RHSKnownZero |= HighBits; // high bits known zero.
1330 }
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001331 }
1332 break;
1333 case Instruction::AShr:
1334 // If this is an arithmetic shift right and only the low-bit is set, we can
1335 // always convert this into a logical shr, even if the shift amount is
1336 // variable. The low bit of the shift cannot be an input sign bit unless
1337 // the shift amount is >= the size of the datatype, which is undefined.
1338 if (DemandedMask == 1) {
1339 // Perform the logical shift right.
1340 Value *NewVal = BinaryOperator::createLShr(
1341 I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1), I->getName());
1342 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(NewVal), *I);
1343 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewVal);
1344 }
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00001345
1346 // If the sign bit is the only bit demanded by this ashr, then there is no
1347 // need to do it, the shift doesn't change the high bit.
1348 if (DemandedMask.isSignBit())
1349 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001350
1351 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00001352 uint32_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001353
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001354 // Signed shift right.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001355 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.shl(ShiftAmt));
Lauro Ramos Venanciod0499af2007-06-06 17:08:48 +00001356 // If any of the "high bits" are demanded, we should set the sign bit as
1357 // demanded.
1358 if (DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros() <= ShiftAmt)
1359 DemandedMaskIn.set(BitWidth-1);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001360 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0),
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001361 DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001362 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1363 return true;
1364 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1365 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1366 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001367 APInt HighBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001368 RHSKnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownZero, ShiftAmt);
1369 RHSKnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownOne, ShiftAmt);
1370
1371 // Handle the sign bits.
1372 APInt SignBit(APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth));
1373 // Adjust to where it is now in the mask.
1374 SignBit = APIntOps::lshr(SignBit, ShiftAmt);
1375
1376 // If the input sign bit is known to be zero, or if none of the top bits
1377 // are demanded, turn this into an unsigned shift right.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001378 if (RHSKnownZero[BitWidth-ShiftAmt-1] ||
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001379 (HighBits & ~DemandedMask) == HighBits) {
1380 // Perform the logical shift right.
1381 Value *NewVal = BinaryOperator::createLShr(
1382 I->getOperand(0), SA, I->getName());
1383 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(NewVal), *I);
1384 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewVal);
1385 } else if ((RHSKnownOne & SignBit) != 0) { // New bits are known one.
1386 RHSKnownOne |= HighBits;
1387 }
1388 }
1389 break;
1390 }
1391
1392 // If the client is only demanding bits that we know, return the known
1393 // constant.
1394 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|RHSKnownOne)) == DemandedMask)
1395 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(RHSKnownOne));
1396 return false;
1397}
1398
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001399
1400/// SimplifyDemandedVectorElts - The specified value producecs a vector with
1401/// 64 or fewer elements. DemandedElts contains the set of elements that are
1402/// actually used by the caller. This method analyzes which elements of the
1403/// operand are undef and returns that information in UndefElts.
1404///
1405/// If the information about demanded elements can be used to simplify the
1406/// operation, the operation is simplified, then the resultant value is
1407/// returned. This returns null if no change was made.
1408Value *InstCombiner::SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(Value *V, uint64_t DemandedElts,
1409 uint64_t &UndefElts,
1410 unsigned Depth) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001411 unsigned VWidth = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001412 assert(VWidth <= 64 && "Vector too wide to analyze!");
1413 uint64_t EltMask = ~0ULL >> (64-VWidth);
1414 assert(DemandedElts != EltMask && (DemandedElts & ~EltMask) == 0 &&
1415 "Invalid DemandedElts!");
1416
1417 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
1418 // If the entire vector is undefined, just return this info.
1419 UndefElts = EltMask;
1420 return 0;
1421 } else if (DemandedElts == 0) { // If nothing is demanded, provide undef.
1422 UndefElts = EltMask;
1423 return UndefValue::get(V->getType());
1424 }
1425
1426 UndefElts = 0;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001427 if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V)) {
1428 const Type *EltTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001429 Constant *Undef = UndefValue::get(EltTy);
1430
1431 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
1432 for (unsigned i = 0; i != VWidth; ++i)
1433 if (!(DemandedElts & (1ULL << i))) { // If not demanded, set to undef.
1434 Elts.push_back(Undef);
1435 UndefElts |= (1ULL << i);
1436 } else if (isa<UndefValue>(CP->getOperand(i))) { // Already undef.
1437 Elts.push_back(Undef);
1438 UndefElts |= (1ULL << i);
1439 } else { // Otherwise, defined.
1440 Elts.push_back(CP->getOperand(i));
1441 }
1442
1443 // If we changed the constant, return it.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001444 Constant *NewCP = ConstantVector::get(Elts);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001445 return NewCP != CP ? NewCP : 0;
1446 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V)) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001447 // Simplify the CAZ to a ConstantVector where the non-demanded elements are
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001448 // set to undef.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001449 const Type *EltTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001450 Constant *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(EltTy);
1451 Constant *Undef = UndefValue::get(EltTy);
1452 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
1453 for (unsigned i = 0; i != VWidth; ++i)
1454 Elts.push_back((DemandedElts & (1ULL << i)) ? Zero : Undef);
1455 UndefElts = DemandedElts ^ EltMask;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001456 return ConstantVector::get(Elts);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001457 }
1458
1459 if (!V->hasOneUse()) { // Other users may use these bits.
1460 if (Depth != 0) { // Not at the root.
1461 // TODO: Just compute the UndefElts information recursively.
1462 return false;
1463 }
1464 return false;
1465 } else if (Depth == 10) { // Limit search depth.
1466 return false;
1467 }
1468
1469 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
1470 if (!I) return false; // Only analyze instructions.
1471
1472 bool MadeChange = false;
1473 uint64_t UndefElts2;
1474 Value *TmpV;
1475 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
1476 default: break;
1477
1478 case Instruction::InsertElement: {
1479 // If this is a variable index, we don't know which element it overwrites.
1480 // demand exactly the same input as we produce.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00001481 ConstantInt *Idx = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001482 if (Idx == 0) {
1483 // Note that we can't propagate undef elt info, because we don't know
1484 // which elt is getting updated.
1485 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts,
1486 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1487 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1488 break;
1489 }
1490
1491 // If this is inserting an element that isn't demanded, remove this
1492 // insertelement.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00001493 unsigned IdxNo = Idx->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001494 if (IdxNo >= VWidth || (DemandedElts & (1ULL << IdxNo)) == 0)
1495 return AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(*I, 0);
1496
1497 // Otherwise, the element inserted overwrites whatever was there, so the
1498 // input demanded set is simpler than the output set.
1499 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0),
1500 DemandedElts & ~(1ULL << IdxNo),
1501 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1502 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1503
1504 // The inserted element is defined.
1505 UndefElts |= 1ULL << IdxNo;
1506 break;
1507 }
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001508 case Instruction::BitCast: {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +00001509 // Vector->vector casts only.
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001510 const VectorType *VTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
1511 if (!VTy) break;
1512 unsigned InVWidth = VTy->getNumElements();
1513 uint64_t InputDemandedElts = 0;
1514 unsigned Ratio;
1515
1516 if (VWidth == InVWidth) {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +00001517 // If we are converting from <4 x i32> -> <4 x f32>, we demand the same
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001518 // elements as are demanded of us.
1519 Ratio = 1;
1520 InputDemandedElts = DemandedElts;
1521 } else if (VWidth > InVWidth) {
1522 // Untested so far.
1523 break;
1524
1525 // If there are more elements in the result than there are in the source,
1526 // then an input element is live if any of the corresponding output
1527 // elements are live.
1528 Ratio = VWidth/InVWidth;
1529 for (unsigned OutIdx = 0; OutIdx != VWidth; ++OutIdx) {
1530 if (DemandedElts & (1ULL << OutIdx))
1531 InputDemandedElts |= 1ULL << (OutIdx/Ratio);
1532 }
1533 } else {
1534 // Untested so far.
1535 break;
1536
1537 // If there are more elements in the source than there are in the result,
1538 // then an input element is live if the corresponding output element is
1539 // live.
1540 Ratio = InVWidth/VWidth;
1541 for (unsigned InIdx = 0; InIdx != InVWidth; ++InIdx)
1542 if (DemandedElts & (1ULL << InIdx/Ratio))
1543 InputDemandedElts |= 1ULL << InIdx;
1544 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001545
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001546 // div/rem demand all inputs, because they don't want divide by zero.
1547 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), InputDemandedElts,
1548 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1549 if (TmpV) {
1550 I->setOperand(0, TmpV);
1551 MadeChange = true;
1552 }
1553
1554 UndefElts = UndefElts2;
1555 if (VWidth > InVWidth) {
1556 assert(0 && "Unimp");
1557 // If there are more elements in the result than there are in the source,
1558 // then an output element is undef if the corresponding input element is
1559 // undef.
1560 for (unsigned OutIdx = 0; OutIdx != VWidth; ++OutIdx)
1561 if (UndefElts2 & (1ULL << (OutIdx/Ratio)))
1562 UndefElts |= 1ULL << OutIdx;
1563 } else if (VWidth < InVWidth) {
1564 assert(0 && "Unimp");
1565 // If there are more elements in the source than there are in the result,
1566 // then a result element is undef if all of the corresponding input
1567 // elements are undef.
1568 UndefElts = ~0ULL >> (64-VWidth); // Start out all undef.
1569 for (unsigned InIdx = 0; InIdx != InVWidth; ++InIdx)
1570 if ((UndefElts2 & (1ULL << InIdx)) == 0) // Not undef?
1571 UndefElts &= ~(1ULL << (InIdx/Ratio)); // Clear undef bit.
1572 }
1573 break;
1574 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001575 case Instruction::And:
1576 case Instruction::Or:
1577 case Instruction::Xor:
1578 case Instruction::Add:
1579 case Instruction::Sub:
1580 case Instruction::Mul:
1581 // div/rem demand all inputs, because they don't want divide by zero.
1582 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts,
1583 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1584 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1585 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(1), DemandedElts,
1586 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1587 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1588
1589 // Output elements are undefined if both are undefined. Consider things
1590 // like undef&0. The result is known zero, not undef.
1591 UndefElts &= UndefElts2;
1592 break;
1593
1594 case Instruction::Call: {
1595 IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(I);
1596 if (!II) break;
1597 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1598 default: break;
1599
1600 // Binary vector operations that work column-wise. A dest element is a
1601 // function of the corresponding input elements from the two inputs.
1602 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1603 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1604 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_min_ss:
1605 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_max_ss:
1606 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
1607 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
1608 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_min_sd:
1609 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_max_sd:
1610 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(1), DemandedElts,
1611 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1612 if (TmpV) { II->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1613 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(2), DemandedElts,
1614 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1615 if (TmpV) { II->setOperand(2, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1616
1617 // If only the low elt is demanded and this is a scalarizable intrinsic,
1618 // scalarize it now.
1619 if (DemandedElts == 1) {
1620 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1621 default: break;
1622 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1623 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1624 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
1625 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
1626 // TODO: Lower MIN/MAX/ABS/etc
1627 Value *LHS = II->getOperand(1);
1628 Value *RHS = II->getOperand(2);
1629 // Extract the element as scalars.
1630 LHS = InsertNewInstBefore(new ExtractElementInst(LHS, 0U,"tmp"), *II);
1631 RHS = InsertNewInstBefore(new ExtractElementInst(RHS, 0U,"tmp"), *II);
1632
1633 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1634 default: assert(0 && "Case stmts out of sync!");
1635 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1636 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
1637 TmpV = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createSub(LHS, RHS,
1638 II->getName()), *II);
1639 break;
1640 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1641 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
1642 TmpV = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createMul(LHS, RHS,
1643 II->getName()), *II);
1644 break;
1645 }
1646
1647 Instruction *New =
1648 new InsertElementInst(UndefValue::get(II->getType()), TmpV, 0U,
1649 II->getName());
1650 InsertNewInstBefore(New, *II);
1651 AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(*II, 0);
1652 return New;
1653 }
1654 }
1655
1656 // Output elements are undefined if both are undefined. Consider things
1657 // like undef&0. The result is known zero, not undef.
1658 UndefElts &= UndefElts2;
1659 break;
1660 }
1661 break;
1662 }
1663 }
1664 return MadeChange ? I : 0;
1665}
1666
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001667/// @returns true if the specified compare instruction is
1668/// true when both operands are equal...
1669/// @brief Determine if the ICmpInst returns true if both operands are equal
1670static bool isTrueWhenEqual(ICmpInst &ICI) {
1671 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = ICI.getPredicate();
1672 return pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ || pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE ||
1673 pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE || pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
1674 pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE;
1675}
1676
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001677/// AssociativeOpt - Perform an optimization on an associative operator. This
1678/// function is designed to check a chain of associative operators for a
1679/// potential to apply a certain optimization. Since the optimization may be
1680/// applicable if the expression was reassociated, this checks the chain, then
1681/// reassociates the expression as necessary to expose the optimization
1682/// opportunity. This makes use of a special Functor, which must define
1683/// 'shouldApply' and 'apply' methods.
1684///
1685template<typename Functor>
1686Instruction *AssociativeOpt(BinaryOperator &Root, const Functor &F) {
1687 unsigned Opcode = Root.getOpcode();
1688 Value *LHS = Root.getOperand(0);
1689
1690 // Quick check, see if the immediate LHS matches...
1691 if (F.shouldApply(LHS))
1692 return F.apply(Root);
1693
1694 // Otherwise, if the LHS is not of the same opcode as the root, return.
1695 Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS);
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00001696 while (LHSI && LHSI->getOpcode() == Opcode && LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001697 // Should we apply this transform to the RHS?
1698 bool ShouldApply = F.shouldApply(LHSI->getOperand(1));
1699
1700 // If not to the RHS, check to see if we should apply to the LHS...
1701 if (!ShouldApply && F.shouldApply(LHSI->getOperand(0))) {
1702 cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI)->swapOperands(); // Make the LHS the RHS
1703 ShouldApply = true;
1704 }
1705
1706 // If the functor wants to apply the optimization to the RHS of LHSI,
1707 // reassociate the expression from ((? op A) op B) to (? op (A op B))
1708 if (ShouldApply) {
1709 BasicBlock *BB = Root.getParent();
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001710
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001711 // Now all of the instructions are in the current basic block, go ahead
1712 // and perform the reassociation.
1713 Instruction *TmpLHSI = cast<Instruction>(Root.getOperand(0));
1714
1715 // First move the selected RHS to the LHS of the root...
1716 Root.setOperand(0, LHSI->getOperand(1));
1717
1718 // Make what used to be the LHS of the root be the user of the root...
1719 Value *ExtraOperand = TmpLHSI->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001720 if (&Root == TmpLHSI) {
Chris Lattner15a76c02004-04-05 02:10:19 +00001721 Root.replaceAllUsesWith(Constant::getNullValue(TmpLHSI->getType()));
1722 return 0;
1723 }
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001724 Root.replaceAllUsesWith(TmpLHSI); // Users now use TmpLHSI
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001725 TmpLHSI->setOperand(1, &Root); // TmpLHSI now uses the root
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001726 TmpLHSI->getParent()->getInstList().remove(TmpLHSI);
1727 BasicBlock::iterator ARI = &Root; ++ARI;
1728 BB->getInstList().insert(ARI, TmpLHSI); // Move TmpLHSI to after Root
1729 ARI = Root;
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001730
1731 // Now propagate the ExtraOperand down the chain of instructions until we
1732 // get to LHSI.
1733 while (TmpLHSI != LHSI) {
1734 Instruction *NextLHSI = cast<Instruction>(TmpLHSI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001735 // Move the instruction to immediately before the chain we are
1736 // constructing to avoid breaking dominance properties.
1737 NextLHSI->getParent()->getInstList().remove(NextLHSI);
1738 BB->getInstList().insert(ARI, NextLHSI);
1739 ARI = NextLHSI;
1740
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001741 Value *NextOp = NextLHSI->getOperand(1);
1742 NextLHSI->setOperand(1, ExtraOperand);
1743 TmpLHSI = NextLHSI;
1744 ExtraOperand = NextOp;
1745 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001746
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001747 // Now that the instructions are reassociated, have the functor perform
1748 // the transformation...
1749 return F.apply(Root);
1750 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001751
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001752 LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHSI->getOperand(0));
1753 }
1754 return 0;
1755}
1756
1757
1758// AddRHS - Implements: X + X --> X << 1
1759struct AddRHS {
1760 Value *RHS;
1761 AddRHS(Value *rhs) : RHS(rhs) {}
1762 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const { return LHS == RHS; }
1763 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Add) const {
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00001764 return BinaryOperator::createShl(Add.getOperand(0),
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00001765 ConstantInt::get(Add.getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001766 }
1767};
1768
1769// AddMaskingAnd - Implements (A & C1)+(B & C2) --> (A & C1)|(B & C2)
1770// iff C1&C2 == 0
1771struct AddMaskingAnd {
1772 Constant *C2;
1773 AddMaskingAnd(Constant *c) : C2(c) {}
1774 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const {
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00001775 ConstantInt *C1;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001776 return match(LHS, m_And(m_Value(), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00001777 ConstantExpr::getAnd(C1, C2)->isNullValue();
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001778 }
1779 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Add) const {
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00001780 return BinaryOperator::createOr(Add.getOperand(0), Add.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001781 }
1782};
1783
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001784static Value *FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Instruction &I, Value *SO,
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001785 InstCombiner *IC) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001786 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(&I)) {
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001787 if (Constant *SOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO))
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001788 return ConstantExpr::getCast(CI->getOpcode(), SOC, I.getType());
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001789
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001790 return IC->InsertNewInstBefore(CastInst::create(
1791 CI->getOpcode(), SO, I.getType(), SO->getName() + ".cast"), I);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001792 }
1793
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001794 // Figure out if the constant is the left or the right argument.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001795 bool ConstIsRHS = isa<Constant>(I.getOperand(1));
1796 Constant *ConstOperand = cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(ConstIsRHS));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001797
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001798 if (Constant *SOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO)) {
1799 if (ConstIsRHS)
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001800 return ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), SOC, ConstOperand);
1801 return ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), ConstOperand, SOC);
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001802 }
1803
1804 Value *Op0 = SO, *Op1 = ConstOperand;
1805 if (!ConstIsRHS)
1806 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
1807 Instruction *New;
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001808 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(&I))
1809 New = BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(), Op0, Op1,SO->getName()+".op");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001810 else if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
1811 New = CmpInst::create(CI->getOpcode(), CI->getPredicate(), Op0, Op1,
1812 SO->getName()+".cmp");
Chris Lattner326c0f32004-04-10 19:15:56 +00001813 else {
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001814 assert(0 && "Unknown binary instruction type!");
Chris Lattner326c0f32004-04-10 19:15:56 +00001815 abort();
1816 }
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001817 return IC->InsertNewInstBefore(New, I);
1818}
1819
1820// FoldOpIntoSelect - Given an instruction with a select as one operand and a
1821// constant as the other operand, try to fold the binary operator into the
1822// select arguments. This also works for Cast instructions, which obviously do
1823// not have a second operand.
1824static Instruction *FoldOpIntoSelect(Instruction &Op, SelectInst *SI,
1825 InstCombiner *IC) {
1826 // Don't modify shared select instructions
1827 if (!SI->hasOneUse()) return 0;
1828 Value *TV = SI->getOperand(1);
1829 Value *FV = SI->getOperand(2);
1830
1831 if (isa<Constant>(TV) || isa<Constant>(FV)) {
Chris Lattner956db272005-04-21 05:43:13 +00001832 // Bool selects with constant operands can be folded to logical ops.
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00001833 if (SI->getType() == Type::Int1Ty) return 0;
Chris Lattner956db272005-04-21 05:43:13 +00001834
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001835 Value *SelectTrueVal = FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Op, TV, IC);
1836 Value *SelectFalseVal = FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Op, FV, IC);
1837
1838 return new SelectInst(SI->getCondition(), SelectTrueVal,
1839 SelectFalseVal);
1840 }
1841 return 0;
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001842}
1843
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001844
1845/// FoldOpIntoPhi - Given a binary operator or cast instruction which has a PHI
1846/// node as operand #0, see if we can fold the instruction into the PHI (which
1847/// is only possible if all operands to the PHI are constants).
1848Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldOpIntoPhi(Instruction &I) {
1849 PHINode *PN = cast<PHINode>(I.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001850 unsigned NumPHIValues = PN->getNumIncomingValues();
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001851 if (!PN->hasOneUse() || NumPHIValues == 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001852
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001853 // Check to see if all of the operands of the PHI are constants. If there is
1854 // one non-constant value, remember the BB it is. If there is more than one
Chris Lattnerb3036682007-02-24 01:03:45 +00001855 // or if *it* is a PHI, bail out.
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001856 BasicBlock *NonConstBB = 0;
1857 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i)
1858 if (!isa<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
1859 if (NonConstBB) return 0; // More than one non-const value.
Chris Lattnerb3036682007-02-24 01:03:45 +00001860 if (isa<PHINode>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) return 0; // Itself a phi.
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001861 NonConstBB = PN->getIncomingBlock(i);
1862
1863 // If the incoming non-constant value is in I's block, we have an infinite
1864 // loop.
1865 if (NonConstBB == I.getParent())
1866 return 0;
1867 }
1868
1869 // If there is exactly one non-constant value, we can insert a copy of the
1870 // operation in that block. However, if this is a critical edge, we would be
1871 // inserting the computation one some other paths (e.g. inside a loop). Only
1872 // do this if the pred block is unconditionally branching into the phi block.
1873 if (NonConstBB) {
1874 BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(NonConstBB->getTerminator());
1875 if (!BI || !BI->isUnconditional()) return 0;
1876 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001877
1878 // Okay, we can do the transformation: create the new PHI node.
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00001879 PHINode *NewPN = new PHINode(I.getType(), "");
Chris Lattner55517062005-01-29 00:39:08 +00001880 NewPN->reserveOperandSpace(PN->getNumOperands()/2);
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001881 InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, *PN);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00001882 NewPN->takeName(PN);
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001883
1884 // Next, add all of the operands to the PHI.
1885 if (I.getNumOperands() == 2) {
1886 Constant *C = cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001887 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i) {
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001888 Value *InV;
1889 if (Constant *InC = dyn_cast<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001890 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
1891 InV = ConstantExpr::getCompare(CI->getPredicate(), InC, C);
1892 else
1893 InV = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), InC, C);
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001894 } else {
1895 assert(PN->getIncomingBlock(i) == NonConstBB);
1896 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(&I))
1897 InV = BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(),
1898 PN->getIncomingValue(i), C, "phitmp",
1899 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001900 else if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
1901 InV = CmpInst::create(CI->getOpcode(),
1902 CI->getPredicate(),
1903 PN->getIncomingValue(i), C, "phitmp",
1904 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001905 else
1906 assert(0 && "Unknown binop!");
1907
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00001908 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(InV));
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001909 }
1910 NewPN->addIncoming(InV, PN->getIncomingBlock(i));
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001911 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001912 } else {
1913 CastInst *CI = cast<CastInst>(&I);
1914 const Type *RetTy = CI->getType();
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001915 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i) {
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001916 Value *InV;
1917 if (Constant *InC = dyn_cast<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001918 InV = ConstantExpr::getCast(CI->getOpcode(), InC, RetTy);
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001919 } else {
1920 assert(PN->getIncomingBlock(i) == NonConstBB);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001921 InV = CastInst::create(CI->getOpcode(), PN->getIncomingValue(i),
1922 I.getType(), "phitmp",
1923 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00001924 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(InV));
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001925 }
1926 NewPN->addIncoming(InV, PN->getIncomingBlock(i));
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001927 }
1928 }
1929 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, NewPN);
1930}
1931
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00001932Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAdd(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00001933 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00001934 Value *LHS = I.getOperand(0), *RHS = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00001935
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001936 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(RHS)) {
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00001937 // X + undef -> undef
1938 if (isa<UndefValue>(RHS))
1939 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
1940
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001941 // X + 0 --> X
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00001942 if (!I.getType()->isFPOrFPVector()) { // NOTE: -0 + +0 = +0.
Chris Lattner5e678e02005-10-17 17:56:38 +00001943 if (RHSC->isNullValue())
1944 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Chris Lattner8532cf62005-10-17 20:18:38 +00001945 } else if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHSC)) {
1946 if (CFP->isExactlyValue(-0.0))
1947 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Chris Lattner5e678e02005-10-17 17:56:38 +00001948 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001949
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001950 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHSC)) {
Chris Lattnerb4a2f052006-11-09 05:12:27 +00001951 // X + (signbit) --> X ^ signbit
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00001952 const APInt& Val = CI->getValue();
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00001953 uint32_t BitWidth = Val.getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001954 if (Val == APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth))
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00001955 return BinaryOperator::createXor(LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattnerb4a2f052006-11-09 05:12:27 +00001956
1957 // See if SimplifyDemandedBits can simplify this. This handles stuff like
1958 // (X & 254)+1 -> (X&254)|1
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001959 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
1960 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
1961 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
1962 KnownZero, KnownOne))
1963 return &I;
1964 }
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001965 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001966
1967 if (isa<PHINode>(LHS))
1968 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
1969 return NV;
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001970
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00001971 ConstantInt *XorRHS = 0;
1972 Value *XorLHS = 0;
Chris Lattnerc5eff442007-01-30 22:32:46 +00001973 if (isa<ConstantInt>(RHSC) &&
1974 match(LHS, m_Xor(m_Value(XorLHS), m_ConstantInt(XorRHS)))) {
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00001975 uint32_t TySizeBits = I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00001976 const APInt& RHSVal = cast<ConstantInt>(RHSC)->getValue();
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001977
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00001978 uint32_t Size = TySizeBits / 2;
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001979 APInt C0080Val(APInt(TySizeBits, 1ULL).shl(Size - 1));
1980 APInt CFF80Val(-C0080Val);
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001981 do {
1982 if (TySizeBits > Size) {
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001983 // If we have ADD(XOR(AND(X, 0xFF), 0x80), 0xF..F80), it's a sext.
1984 // If we have ADD(XOR(AND(X, 0xFF), 0xF..F80), 0x80), it's a sext.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001985 if ((RHSVal == CFF80Val && XorRHS->getValue() == C0080Val) ||
1986 (RHSVal == C0080Val && XorRHS->getValue() == CFF80Val)) {
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001987 // This is a sign extend if the top bits are known zero.
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00001988 if (!MaskedValueIsZero(XorLHS,
1989 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TySizeBits, TySizeBits - Size)))
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001990 Size = 0; // Not a sign ext, but can't be any others either.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001991 break;
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001992 }
1993 }
1994 Size >>= 1;
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001995 C0080Val = APIntOps::lshr(C0080Val, Size);
1996 CFF80Val = APIntOps::ashr(CFF80Val, Size);
1997 } while (Size >= 1);
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001998
Reid Spencer35c38852007-03-28 01:36:16 +00001999 // FIXME: This shouldn't be necessary. When the backends can handle types
2000 // with funny bit widths then this whole cascade of if statements should
2001 // be removed. It is just here to get the size of the "middle" type back
2002 // up to something that the back ends can handle.
2003 const Type *MiddleType = 0;
2004 switch (Size) {
2005 default: break;
2006 case 32: MiddleType = Type::Int32Ty; break;
2007 case 16: MiddleType = Type::Int16Ty; break;
2008 case 8: MiddleType = Type::Int8Ty; break;
2009 }
2010 if (MiddleType) {
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00002011 Instruction *NewTrunc = new TruncInst(XorLHS, MiddleType, "sext");
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002012 InsertNewInstBefore(NewTrunc, I);
Reid Spencer35c38852007-03-28 01:36:16 +00002013 return new SExtInst(NewTrunc, I.getType(), I.getName());
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002014 }
2015 }
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00002016 }
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002017
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00002018 // X + X --> X << 1
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00002019 if (I.getType()->isInteger() && I.getType() != Type::Int1Ty) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00002020 if (Instruction *Result = AssociativeOpt(I, AddRHS(RHS))) return Result;
Chris Lattner7edc8c22005-04-07 17:14:51 +00002021
2022 if (Instruction *RHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RHS)) {
2023 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub)
2024 if (LHS == RHSI->getOperand(1)) // A + (B - A) --> B
2025 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHSI->getOperand(0));
2026 }
2027 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS)) {
2028 if (LHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub)
2029 if (RHS == LHSI->getOperand(1)) // (B - A) + A --> B
2030 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHSI->getOperand(0));
2031 }
Robert Bocchino71698282004-07-27 21:02:21 +00002032 }
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002033
Chris Lattner5c4afb92002-05-08 22:46:53 +00002034 // -A + B --> B - A
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00002035 if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(LHS))
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002036 return BinaryOperator::createSub(RHS, V);
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002037
2038 // A + -B --> A - B
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00002039 if (!isa<Constant>(RHS))
2040 if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(RHS))
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002041 return BinaryOperator::createSub(LHS, V);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002042
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002043
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002044 ConstantInt *C2;
2045 if (Value *X = dyn_castFoldableMul(LHS, C2)) {
2046 if (X == RHS) // X*C + X --> X * (C+1)
2047 return BinaryOperator::createMul(RHS, AddOne(C2));
2048
2049 // X*C1 + X*C2 --> X * (C1+C2)
2050 ConstantInt *C1;
2051 if (X == dyn_castFoldableMul(RHS, C1))
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002052 return BinaryOperator::createMul(X, Add(C1, C2));
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002053 }
2054
2055 // X + X*C --> X * (C+1)
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002056 if (dyn_castFoldableMul(RHS, C2) == LHS)
2057 return BinaryOperator::createMul(LHS, AddOne(C2));
2058
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002059 // X + ~X --> -1 since ~X = -X-1
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00002060 if (dyn_castNotVal(LHS) == RHS || dyn_castNotVal(RHS) == LHS)
2061 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002062
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002063
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00002064 // (A & C1)+(B & C2) --> (A & C1)|(B & C2) iff C1&C2 == 0
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002065 if (match(RHS, m_And(m_Value(), m_ConstantInt(C2))))
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002066 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, AddMaskingAnd(C2)))
2067 return R;
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +00002068
Chris Lattner6b032052003-10-02 15:11:26 +00002069 if (ConstantInt *CRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS)) {
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00002070 Value *X = 0;
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002071 if (match(LHS, m_Not(m_Value(X)))) // ~X + C --> (C-1) - X
2072 return BinaryOperator::createSub(SubOne(CRHS), X);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002073
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002074 // (X & FF00) + xx00 -> (X+xx00) & FF00
2075 if (LHS->hasOneUse() && match(LHS, m_And(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C2)))) {
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002076 Constant *Anded = And(CRHS, C2);
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002077 if (Anded == CRHS) {
2078 // See if all bits from the first bit set in the Add RHS up are included
2079 // in the mask. First, get the rightmost bit.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002080 const APInt& AddRHSV = CRHS->getValue();
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002081
2082 // Form a mask of all bits from the lowest bit added through the top.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002083 APInt AddRHSHighBits(~((AddRHSV & -AddRHSV)-1));
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002084
2085 // See if the and mask includes all of these bits.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002086 APInt AddRHSHighBitsAnd(AddRHSHighBits & C2->getValue());
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002087
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002088 if (AddRHSHighBits == AddRHSHighBitsAnd) {
2089 // Okay, the xform is safe. Insert the new add pronto.
2090 Value *NewAdd = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAdd(X, CRHS,
2091 LHS->getName()), I);
2092 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(NewAdd, C2);
2093 }
2094 }
2095 }
2096
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002097 // Try to fold constant add into select arguments.
2098 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(LHS))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002099 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002100 return R;
Chris Lattner6b032052003-10-02 15:11:26 +00002101 }
2102
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002103 // add (cast *A to intptrtype) B ->
2104 // cast (GEP (cast *A to sbyte*) B) ->
2105 // intptrtype
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002106 {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002107 CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(LHS);
2108 Value *Other = RHS;
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002109 if (!CI) {
2110 CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(RHS);
2111 Other = LHS;
2112 }
Andrew Lenharth45633262006-09-20 15:37:57 +00002113 if (CI && CI->getType()->isSized() &&
Reid Spencerabaa8ca2007-01-08 16:32:00 +00002114 (CI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() ==
2115 TD->getIntPtrType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits())
Andrew Lenharth45633262006-09-20 15:37:57 +00002116 && isa<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType())) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00002117 Value *I2 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, CI->getOperand(0),
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00002118 PointerType::get(Type::Int8Ty), I);
Andrew Lenharth45633262006-09-20 15:37:57 +00002119 I2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new GetElementPtrInst(I2, Other, "ctg2"), I);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002120 return new PtrToIntInst(I2, CI->getType());
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002121 }
2122 }
2123
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002124 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002125}
2126
Chris Lattner1ba5bcd2003-07-22 21:46:59 +00002127// isSignBit - Return true if the value represented by the constant only has the
2128// highest order bit set.
2129static bool isSignBit(ConstantInt *CI) {
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00002130 uint32_t NumBits = CI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer5a1e3e12007-03-19 20:58:18 +00002131 return CI->getValue() == APInt::getSignBit(NumBits);
Chris Lattner1ba5bcd2003-07-22 21:46:59 +00002132}
2133
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002134Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSub(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002135 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002136
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002137 if (Op0 == Op1) // sub X, X -> 0
2138 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002139
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002140 // If this is a 'B = x-(-A)', change to B = x+A...
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00002141 if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(Op1))
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002142 return BinaryOperator::createAdd(Op0, V);
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002143
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002144 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0))
2145 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // undef - X -> undef
2146 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
2147 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X - undef -> undef
2148
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002149 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0)) {
2150 // Replace (-1 - A) with (~A)...
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002151 if (C->isAllOnesValue())
2152 return BinaryOperator::createNot(Op1);
Chris Lattner40371712002-05-09 01:29:19 +00002153
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002154 // C - ~X == X + (1+C)
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +00002155 Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002156 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(X))))
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002157 return BinaryOperator::createAdd(X, AddOne(C));
2158
Chris Lattner76b7a062007-01-15 07:02:54 +00002159 // -(X >>u 31) -> (X >>s 31)
2160 // -(X >>s 31) -> (X >>u 31)
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002161 if (C->isZero()) {
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002162 if (BinaryOperator *SI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1))
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002163 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002164 if (ConstantInt *CU = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner9c290672004-03-12 23:53:13 +00002165 // Check to see if we are shifting out everything but the sign bit.
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002166 if (CU->getLimitedValue(SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) ==
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002167 SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1) {
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002168 // Ok, the transformation is safe. Insert AShr.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002169 return BinaryOperator::create(Instruction::AShr,
2170 SI->getOperand(0), CU, SI->getName());
Chris Lattner9c290672004-03-12 23:53:13 +00002171 }
2172 }
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002173 }
2174 else if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) {
2175 if (ConstantInt *CU = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1))) {
2176 // Check to see if we are shifting out everything but the sign bit.
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002177 if (CU->getLimitedValue(SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) ==
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002178 SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00002179 // Ok, the transformation is safe. Insert LShr.
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00002180 return BinaryOperator::createLShr(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002181 SI->getOperand(0), CU, SI->getName());
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002182 }
2183 }
2184 }
Chris Lattnerbfe492b2004-03-13 00:11:49 +00002185 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002186
2187 // Try to fold constant sub into select arguments.
2188 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002189 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002190 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002191
2192 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2193 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2194 return NV;
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002195 }
2196
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002197 if (BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
2198 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add &&
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00002199 !Op0->getType()->isFPOrFPVector()) {
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002200 if (Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0) // X-(X+Y) == -Y
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002201 return BinaryOperator::createNeg(Op1I->getOperand(1), I.getName());
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002202 else if (Op1I->getOperand(1) == Op0) // X-(Y+X) == -Y
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002203 return BinaryOperator::createNeg(Op1I->getOperand(0), I.getName());
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002204 else if (ConstantInt *CI1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I.getOperand(0))) {
2205 if (ConstantInt *CI2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1I->getOperand(1)))
2206 // C1-(X+C2) --> (C1-C2)-X
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002207 return BinaryOperator::createSub(Subtract(CI1, CI2),
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002208 Op1I->getOperand(0));
2209 }
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002210 }
2211
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00002212 if (Op1I->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002213 // Replace (x - (y - z)) with (x + (z - y)) if the (y - z) subexpression
2214 // is not used by anyone else...
2215 //
Chris Lattner0517e722004-02-02 20:09:56 +00002216 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00002217 !Op1I->getType()->isFPOrFPVector()) {
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002218 // Swap the two operands of the subexpr...
2219 Value *IIOp0 = Op1I->getOperand(0), *IIOp1 = Op1I->getOperand(1);
2220 Op1I->setOperand(0, IIOp1);
2221 Op1I->setOperand(1, IIOp0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002222
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002223 // Create the new top level add instruction...
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002224 return BinaryOperator::createAdd(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002225 }
2226
2227 // Replace (A - (A & B)) with (A & ~B) if this is the only use of (A&B)...
2228 //
2229 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
2230 (Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0 || Op1I->getOperand(1) == Op0)) {
2231 Value *OtherOp = Op1I->getOperand(Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0);
2232
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +00002233 Value *NewNot =
2234 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createNot(OtherOp, "B.not"), I);
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002235 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0, NewNot);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002236 }
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002237
Reid Spencerac5209e2006-10-16 23:08:08 +00002238 // 0 - (X sdiv C) -> (X sdiv -C)
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002239 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv)
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002240 if (ConstantInt *CSI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
Zhou Sheng843f07672007-04-19 05:39:12 +00002241 if (CSI->isZero())
Chris Lattner91ccc152004-10-06 15:08:25 +00002242 if (Constant *DivRHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1I->getOperand(1)))
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002243 return BinaryOperator::createSDiv(Op1I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner91ccc152004-10-06 15:08:25 +00002244 ConstantExpr::getNeg(DivRHS));
2245
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002246 // X - X*C --> X * (1-C)
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +00002247 ConstantInt *C2 = 0;
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002248 if (dyn_castFoldableMul(Op1I, C2) == Op0) {
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002249 Constant *CP1 = Subtract(ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1), C2);
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002250 return BinaryOperator::createMul(Op0, CP1);
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002251 }
Chris Lattner40371712002-05-09 01:29:19 +00002252 }
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002253 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002254
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00002255 if (!Op0->getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
Chris Lattner7edc8c22005-04-07 17:14:51 +00002256 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
2257 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00002258 if (Op0I->getOperand(0) == Op1) // (Y+X)-Y == X
2259 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0I->getOperand(1));
2260 else if (Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1) // (X+Y)-Y == X
2261 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner7edc8c22005-04-07 17:14:51 +00002262 } else if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub) {
2263 if (Op0I->getOperand(0) == Op1) // (X-Y)-X == -Y
2264 return BinaryOperator::createNeg(Op0I->getOperand(1), I.getName());
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00002265 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002266
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002267 ConstantInt *C1;
2268 if (Value *X = dyn_castFoldableMul(Op0, C1)) {
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002269 if (X == Op1) // X*C - X --> X * (C-1)
2270 return BinaryOperator::createMul(Op1, SubOne(C1));
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002271
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002272 ConstantInt *C2; // X*C1 - X*C2 -> X * (C1-C2)
2273 if (X == dyn_castFoldableMul(Op1, C2))
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002274 return BinaryOperator::createMul(Op1, Subtract(C1, C2));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002275 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002276 return 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002277}
2278
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002279/// isSignBitCheck - Given an exploded icmp instruction, return true if the
2280/// comparison only checks the sign bit. If it only checks the sign bit, set
2281/// TrueIfSigned if the result of the comparison is true when the input value is
2282/// signed.
2283static bool isSignBitCheck(ICmpInst::Predicate pred, ConstantInt *RHS,
2284 bool &TrueIfSigned) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002285 switch (pred) {
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002286 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // True if LHS s< 0
2287 TrueIfSigned = true;
2288 return RHS->isZero();
Chris Lattnercb7122b2007-07-16 04:15:34 +00002289 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: // True if LHS s<= RHS and RHS == -1
2290 TrueIfSigned = true;
2291 return RHS->isAllOnesValue();
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002292 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // True if LHS s> -1
2293 TrueIfSigned = false;
2294 return RHS->isAllOnesValue();
Chris Lattnercb7122b2007-07-16 04:15:34 +00002295 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
2296 // True if LHS u> RHS and RHS == high-bit-mask - 1
2297 TrueIfSigned = true;
2298 return RHS->getValue() ==
2299 APInt::getSignedMaxValue(RHS->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits());
2300 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
2301 // True if LHS u>= RHS and RHS == high-bit-mask (2^7, 2^15, 2^31, etc)
2302 TrueIfSigned = true;
2303 return RHS->getValue() ==
2304 APInt::getSignBit(RHS->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits());
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002305 default:
2306 return false;
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002307 }
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002308}
2309
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002310Instruction *InstCombiner::visitMul(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00002311 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002312 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002313
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002314 if (isa<UndefValue>(I.getOperand(1))) // undef * X -> 0
2315 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2316
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002317 // Simplify mul instructions with a constant RHS...
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002318 if (Constant *Op1 = dyn_cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1))) {
2319 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002320
2321 // ((X << C1)*C2) == (X * (C2 << C1))
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002322 if (BinaryOperator *SI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002323 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
2324 if (Constant *ShOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002325 return BinaryOperator::createMul(SI->getOperand(0),
2326 ConstantExpr::getShl(CI, ShOp));
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002327
Zhou Sheng843f07672007-04-19 05:39:12 +00002328 if (CI->isZero())
Chris Lattner515c97c2003-09-11 22:24:54 +00002329 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X * 0 == 0
2330 if (CI->equalsInt(1)) // X * 1 == X
2331 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2332 if (CI->isAllOnesValue()) // X * -1 == 0 - X
Chris Lattner0af1fab2003-06-25 17:09:20 +00002333 return BinaryOperator::createNeg(Op0, I.getName());
Chris Lattner6c1ce212002-04-29 22:24:47 +00002334
Zhou Sheng97b52c22007-03-29 01:57:21 +00002335 const APInt& Val = cast<ConstantInt>(CI)->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002336 if (Val.isPowerOf2()) { // Replace X*(2^C) with X << C
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00002337 return BinaryOperator::createShl(Op0,
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002338 ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), Val.logBase2()));
Chris Lattnerbcd7db52005-08-02 19:16:58 +00002339 }
Robert Bocchino71698282004-07-27 21:02:21 +00002340 } else if (ConstantFP *Op1F = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002341 if (Op1F->isNullValue())
2342 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner6c1ce212002-04-29 22:24:47 +00002343
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002344 // "In IEEE floating point, x*1 is not equivalent to x for nans. However,
2345 // ANSI says we can drop signals, so we can do this anyway." (from GCC)
2346 if (Op1F->getValue() == 1.0)
2347 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // Eliminate 'mul double %X, 1.0'
2348 }
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002349
2350 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
2351 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add && Op0I->hasOneUse() &&
2352 isa<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1))) {
2353 // Canonicalize (X+C1)*C2 -> X*C2+C1*C2.
2354 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::createMul(Op0I->getOperand(0),
2355 Op1, "tmp");
2356 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
2357 Value *C1C2 = ConstantExpr::getMul(Op1,
2358 cast<Constant>(Op0I->getOperand(1)));
2359 return BinaryOperator::createAdd(Add, C1C2);
2360
2361 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002362
2363 // Try to fold constant mul into select arguments.
2364 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002365 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002366 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002367
2368 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2369 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2370 return NV;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002371 }
2372
Chris Lattnera4f445b2003-03-10 23:23:04 +00002373 if (Value *Op0v = dyn_castNegVal(Op0)) // -X * -Y = X*Y
2374 if (Value *Op1v = dyn_castNegVal(I.getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002375 return BinaryOperator::createMul(Op0v, Op1v);
Chris Lattnera4f445b2003-03-10 23:23:04 +00002376
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002377 // If one of the operands of the multiply is a cast from a boolean value, then
2378 // we know the bool is either zero or one, so this is a 'masking' multiply.
2379 // See if we can simplify things based on how the boolean was originally
2380 // formed.
2381 CastInst *BoolCast = 0;
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00002382 if (ZExtInst *CI = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(I.getOperand(0)))
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00002383 if (CI->getOperand(0)->getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002384 BoolCast = CI;
2385 if (!BoolCast)
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00002386 if (ZExtInst *CI = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(I.getOperand(1)))
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00002387 if (CI->getOperand(0)->getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002388 BoolCast = CI;
2389 if (BoolCast) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002390 if (ICmpInst *SCI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(BoolCast->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002391 Value *SCIOp0 = SCI->getOperand(0), *SCIOp1 = SCI->getOperand(1);
2392 const Type *SCOpTy = SCIOp0->getType();
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002393 bool TIS = false;
2394
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002395 // If the icmp is true iff the sign bit of X is set, then convert this
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002396 // multiply into a shift/and combination.
2397 if (isa<ConstantInt>(SCIOp1) &&
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002398 isSignBitCheck(SCI->getPredicate(), cast<ConstantInt>(SCIOp1), TIS) &&
2399 TIS) {
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002400 // Shift the X value right to turn it into "all signbits".
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002401 Constant *Amt = ConstantInt::get(SCIOp0->getType(),
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00002402 SCOpTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002403 Value *V =
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002404 InsertNewInstBefore(
2405 BinaryOperator::create(Instruction::AShr, SCIOp0, Amt,
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002406 BoolCast->getOperand(0)->getName()+
2407 ".mask"), I);
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002408
2409 // If the multiply type is not the same as the source type, sign extend
2410 // or truncate to the multiply type.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00002411 if (I.getType() != V->getType()) {
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00002412 uint32_t SrcBits = V->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
2413 uint32_t DstBits = I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00002414 Instruction::CastOps opcode =
2415 (SrcBits == DstBits ? Instruction::BitCast :
2416 (SrcBits < DstBits ? Instruction::SExt : Instruction::Trunc));
2417 V = InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, I.getType(), I);
2418 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002419
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002420 Value *OtherOp = Op0 == BoolCast ? I.getOperand(1) : Op0;
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002421 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(V, OtherOp);
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002422 }
2423 }
2424 }
2425
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002426 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002427}
2428
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002429/// This function implements the transforms on div instructions that work
2430/// regardless of the kind of div instruction it is (udiv, sdiv, or fdiv). It is
2431/// used by the visitors to those instructions.
2432/// @brief Transforms common to all three div instructions
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002433Instruction *InstCombiner::commonDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002434 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002435
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002436 // undef / X -> 0
2437 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0))
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002438 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002439
2440 // X / undef -> undef
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002441 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002442 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002443
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002444 // Handle cases involving: div X, (select Cond, Y, Z)
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002445 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1)) {
2446 // div X, (Cond ? 0 : Y) -> div X, Y. If the div and the select are in the
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002447 // same basic block, then we replace the select with Y, and the condition
2448 // of the select with false (if the cond value is in the same BB). If the
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002449 // select has uses other than the div, this allows them to be simplified
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002450 // also. Note that div X, Y is just as good as div X, 0 (undef)
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002451 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
2452 if (ST->isNullValue()) {
2453 Instruction *CondI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(SI->getOperand(0));
2454 if (CondI && CondI->getParent() == I.getParent())
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002455 UpdateValueUsesWith(CondI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002456 else if (I.getParent() != SI->getParent() || SI->hasOneUse())
2457 I.setOperand(1, SI->getOperand(2));
2458 else
2459 UpdateValueUsesWith(SI, SI->getOperand(2));
2460 return &I;
2461 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002462
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002463 // Likewise for: div X, (Cond ? Y : 0) -> div X, Y
2464 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(2)))
2465 if (ST->isNullValue()) {
2466 Instruction *CondI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(SI->getOperand(0));
2467 if (CondI && CondI->getParent() == I.getParent())
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002468 UpdateValueUsesWith(CondI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002469 else if (I.getParent() != SI->getParent() || SI->hasOneUse())
2470 I.setOperand(1, SI->getOperand(1));
2471 else
2472 UpdateValueUsesWith(SI, SI->getOperand(1));
2473 return &I;
2474 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002475 }
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002476
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002477 return 0;
2478}
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002479
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002480/// This function implements the transforms common to both integer division
2481/// instructions (udiv and sdiv). It is called by the visitors to those integer
2482/// division instructions.
2483/// @brief Common integer divide transforms
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002484Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002485 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2486
2487 if (Instruction *Common = commonDivTransforms(I))
2488 return Common;
2489
2490 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
2491 // div X, 1 == X
2492 if (RHS->equalsInt(1))
2493 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2494
2495 // (X / C1) / C2 -> X / (C1*C2)
2496 if (Instruction *LHS = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
2497 if (Instruction::BinaryOps(LHS->getOpcode()) == I.getOpcode())
2498 if (ConstantInt *LHSRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHS->getOperand(1))) {
2499 return BinaryOperator::create(I.getOpcode(), LHS->getOperand(0),
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002500 Multiply(RHS, LHSRHS));
Chris Lattnerbf70b832005-04-08 04:03:26 +00002501 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002502
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002503 if (!RHS->isZero()) { // avoid X udiv 0
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002504 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
2505 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
2506 return R;
2507 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2508 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2509 return NV;
2510 }
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002511 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002512
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002513 // 0 / X == 0, we don't need to preserve faults!
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002514 if (ConstantInt *LHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002515 if (LHS->equalsInt(0))
2516 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2517
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002518 return 0;
2519}
2520
2521Instruction *InstCombiner::visitUDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
2522 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2523
2524 // Handle the integer div common cases
2525 if (Instruction *Common = commonIDivTransforms(I))
2526 return Common;
2527
2528 // X udiv C^2 -> X >> C
2529 // Check to see if this is an unsigned division with an exact power of 2,
2530 // if so, convert to a right shift.
2531 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencer6eb0d992007-03-26 23:58:26 +00002532 if (C->getValue().isPowerOf2()) // 0 not included in isPowerOf2
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002533 return BinaryOperator::createLShr(Op0,
Zhou Sheng0fc50952007-03-25 05:01:29 +00002534 ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), C->getValue().logBase2()));
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002535 }
2536
2537 // X udiv (C1 << N), where C1 is "1<<C2" --> X >> (N+C2)
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002538 if (BinaryOperator *RHSI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002539 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
2540 isa<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002541 const APInt& C1 = cast<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002542 if (C1.isPowerOf2()) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002543 Value *N = RHSI->getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002544 const Type *NTy = N->getType();
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002545 if (uint32_t C2 = C1.logBase2()) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002546 Constant *C2V = ConstantInt::get(NTy, C2);
2547 N = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAdd(N, C2V, "tmp"), I);
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002548 }
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00002549 return BinaryOperator::createLShr(Op0, N);
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002550 }
2551 }
Chris Lattnerc812e5d2005-11-05 07:40:31 +00002552 }
2553
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002554 // udiv X, (Select Cond, C1, C2) --> Select Cond, (shr X, C1), (shr X, C2)
2555 // where C1&C2 are powers of two.
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002556 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002557 if (ConstantInt *STO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1)))
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002558 if (ConstantInt *SFO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(2))) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002559 const APInt &TVA = STO->getValue(), &FVA = SFO->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002560 if (TVA.isPowerOf2() && FVA.isPowerOf2()) {
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002561 // Compute the shift amounts
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002562 uint32_t TSA = TVA.logBase2(), FSA = FVA.logBase2();
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002563 // Construct the "on true" case of the select
2564 Constant *TC = ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), TSA);
2565 Instruction *TSI = BinaryOperator::createLShr(
2566 Op0, TC, SI->getName()+".t");
2567 TSI = InsertNewInstBefore(TSI, I);
2568
2569 // Construct the "on false" case of the select
2570 Constant *FC = ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), FSA);
2571 Instruction *FSI = BinaryOperator::createLShr(
2572 Op0, FC, SI->getName()+".f");
2573 FSI = InsertNewInstBefore(FSI, I);
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002574
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002575 // construct the select instruction and return it.
2576 return new SelectInst(SI->getOperand(0), TSI, FSI, SI->getName());
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002577 }
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002578 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002579 return 0;
2580}
2581
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002582Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
2583 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2584
2585 // Handle the integer div common cases
2586 if (Instruction *Common = commonIDivTransforms(I))
2587 return Common;
2588
2589 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
2590 // sdiv X, -1 == -X
2591 if (RHS->isAllOnesValue())
2592 return BinaryOperator::createNeg(Op0);
2593
2594 // -X/C -> X/-C
2595 if (Value *LHSNeg = dyn_castNegVal(Op0))
2596 return BinaryOperator::createSDiv(LHSNeg, ConstantExpr::getNeg(RHS));
2597 }
2598
2599 // If the sign bits of both operands are zero (i.e. we can prove they are
2600 // unsigned inputs), turn this into a udiv.
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00002601 if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002602 APInt Mask(APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()));
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002603 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, Mask) && MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, Mask)) {
2604 return BinaryOperator::createUDiv(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
2605 }
2606 }
2607
2608 return 0;
2609}
2610
2611Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
2612 return commonDivTransforms(I);
2613}
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002614
Chris Lattnerdb3f8732006-03-02 06:50:58 +00002615/// GetFactor - If we can prove that the specified value is at least a multiple
2616/// of some factor, return that factor.
2617static Constant *GetFactor(Value *V) {
2618 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
2619 return CI;
2620
2621 // Unless we can be tricky, we know this is a multiple of 1.
2622 Constant *Result = ConstantInt::get(V->getType(), 1);
2623
2624 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
2625 if (!I) return Result;
2626
2627 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul) {
2628 // Handle multiplies by a constant, etc.
2629 return ConstantExpr::getMul(GetFactor(I->getOperand(0)),
2630 GetFactor(I->getOperand(1)));
2631 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
2632 // (X<<C) -> X * (1 << C)
2633 if (Constant *ShRHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(I->getOperand(1))) {
2634 ShRHS = ConstantExpr::getShl(Result, ShRHS);
2635 return ConstantExpr::getMul(GetFactor(I->getOperand(0)), ShRHS);
2636 }
2637 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And) {
2638 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
2639 // X & 0xFFF0 is known to be a multiple of 16.
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00002640 uint32_t Zeros = RHS->getValue().countTrailingZeros();
Chris Lattnerdb3f8732006-03-02 06:50:58 +00002641 if (Zeros != V->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits())
2642 return ConstantExpr::getShl(Result,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002643 ConstantInt::get(Result->getType(), Zeros));
Chris Lattnerdb3f8732006-03-02 06:50:58 +00002644 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002645 } else if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(I)) {
Chris Lattnerdb3f8732006-03-02 06:50:58 +00002646 // Only handle int->int casts.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002647 if (!CI->isIntegerCast())
2648 return Result;
2649 Value *Op = CI->getOperand(0);
2650 return ConstantExpr::getCast(CI->getOpcode(), GetFactor(Op), V->getType());
Chris Lattnerdb3f8732006-03-02 06:50:58 +00002651 }
2652 return Result;
2653}
2654
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002655/// This function implements the transforms on rem instructions that work
2656/// regardless of the kind of rem instruction it is (urem, srem, or frem). It
2657/// is used by the visitors to those instructions.
2658/// @brief Transforms common to all three rem instructions
2659Instruction *InstCombiner::commonRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002660 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002661
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00002662 // 0 % X == 0, we don't need to preserve faults!
2663 if (Constant *LHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op0))
2664 if (LHS->isNullValue())
2665 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2666
2667 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) // undef % X -> 0
2668 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2669 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
2670 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X % undef -> undef
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002671
2672 // Handle cases involving: rem X, (select Cond, Y, Z)
2673 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1)) {
2674 // rem X, (Cond ? 0 : Y) -> rem X, Y. If the rem and the select are in
2675 // the same basic block, then we replace the select with Y, and the
2676 // condition of the select with false (if the cond value is in the same
2677 // BB). If the select has uses other than the div, this allows them to be
2678 // simplified also.
2679 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
2680 if (ST->isNullValue()) {
2681 Instruction *CondI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(SI->getOperand(0));
2682 if (CondI && CondI->getParent() == I.getParent())
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002683 UpdateValueUsesWith(CondI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002684 else if (I.getParent() != SI->getParent() || SI->hasOneUse())
2685 I.setOperand(1, SI->getOperand(2));
2686 else
2687 UpdateValueUsesWith(SI, SI->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner5b73c082004-07-06 07:01:22 +00002688 return &I;
2689 }
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002690 // Likewise for: rem X, (Cond ? Y : 0) -> rem X, Y
2691 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(2)))
2692 if (ST->isNullValue()) {
2693 Instruction *CondI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(SI->getOperand(0));
2694 if (CondI && CondI->getParent() == I.getParent())
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002695 UpdateValueUsesWith(CondI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002696 else if (I.getParent() != SI->getParent() || SI->hasOneUse())
2697 I.setOperand(1, SI->getOperand(1));
2698 else
2699 UpdateValueUsesWith(SI, SI->getOperand(1));
2700 return &I;
2701 }
Chris Lattner11a49f22005-11-05 07:28:37 +00002702 }
Chris Lattner5b73c082004-07-06 07:01:22 +00002703
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002704 return 0;
2705}
2706
2707/// This function implements the transforms common to both integer remainder
2708/// instructions (urem and srem). It is called by the visitors to those integer
2709/// remainder instructions.
2710/// @brief Common integer remainder transforms
2711Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
2712 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2713
2714 if (Instruction *common = commonRemTransforms(I))
2715 return common;
2716
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002717 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00002718 // X % 0 == undef, we don't need to preserve faults!
2719 if (RHS->equalsInt(0))
2720 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(I.getType()));
2721
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002722 if (RHS->equalsInt(1)) // X % 1 == 0
2723 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2724
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00002725 if (Instruction *Op0I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0)) {
2726 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0I)) {
2727 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
2728 return R;
2729 } else if (isa<PHINode>(Op0I)) {
2730 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2731 return NV;
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00002732 }
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002733 // (X * C1) % C2 --> 0 iff C1 % C2 == 0
2734 if (ConstantExpr::getSRem(GetFactor(Op0I), RHS)->isNullValue())
Chris Lattnerdb3f8732006-03-02 06:50:58 +00002735 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00002736 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002737 }
2738
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002739 return 0;
2740}
2741
2742Instruction *InstCombiner::visitURem(BinaryOperator &I) {
2743 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2744
2745 if (Instruction *common = commonIRemTransforms(I))
2746 return common;
2747
2748 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
2749 // X urem C^2 -> X and C
2750 // Check to see if this is an unsigned remainder with an exact power of 2,
2751 // if so, convert to a bitwise and.
2752 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS))
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002753 if (C->getValue().isPowerOf2())
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002754 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0, SubOne(C));
2755 }
2756
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002757 if (Instruction *RHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002758 // Turn A % (C << N), where C is 2^k, into A & ((C << N)-1)
2759 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
2760 isa<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))) {
Zhou Sheng0fc50952007-03-25 05:01:29 +00002761 if (cast<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))->getValue().isPowerOf2()) {
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002762 Constant *N1 = ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(I.getType());
2763 Value *Add = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAdd(RHSI, N1,
2764 "tmp"), I);
2765 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0, Add);
2766 }
2767 }
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002768 }
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002769
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002770 // urem X, (select Cond, 2^C1, 2^C2) --> select Cond, (and X, C1), (and X, C2)
2771 // where C1&C2 are powers of two.
2772 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1)) {
2773 if (ConstantInt *STO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1)))
2774 if (ConstantInt *SFO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(2))) {
2775 // STO == 0 and SFO == 0 handled above.
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002776 if ((STO->getValue().isPowerOf2()) &&
2777 (SFO->getValue().isPowerOf2())) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002778 Value *TrueAnd = InsertNewInstBefore(
2779 BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0, SubOne(STO), SI->getName()+".t"), I);
2780 Value *FalseAnd = InsertNewInstBefore(
2781 BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0, SubOne(SFO), SI->getName()+".f"), I);
2782 return new SelectInst(SI->getOperand(0), TrueAnd, FalseAnd);
2783 }
2784 }
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002785 }
2786
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002787 return 0;
2788}
2789
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002790Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSRem(BinaryOperator &I) {
2791 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2792
2793 if (Instruction *common = commonIRemTransforms(I))
2794 return common;
2795
2796 if (Value *RHSNeg = dyn_castNegVal(Op1))
2797 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(RHSNeg) ||
Zhou Sheng0fc50952007-03-25 05:01:29 +00002798 cast<ConstantInt>(RHSNeg)->getValue().isStrictlyPositive()) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002799 // X % -Y -> X % Y
2800 AddUsesToWorkList(I);
2801 I.setOperand(1, RHSNeg);
2802 return &I;
2803 }
2804
2805 // If the top bits of both operands are zero (i.e. we can prove they are
2806 // unsigned inputs), turn this into a urem.
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002807 APInt Mask(APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()));
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002808 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, Mask) && MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, Mask)) {
2809 // X srem Y -> X urem Y, iff X and Y don't have sign bit set
2810 return BinaryOperator::createURem(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
2811 }
2812
2813 return 0;
2814}
2815
2816Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFRem(BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002817 return commonRemTransforms(I);
2818}
2819
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00002820// isMaxValueMinusOne - return true if this is Max-1
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002821static bool isMaxValueMinusOne(const ConstantInt *C, bool isSigned) {
Reid Spencer3a2a9fb2007-03-19 21:10:28 +00002822 uint32_t TypeBits = C->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002823 if (!isSigned)
2824 return C->getValue() == APInt::getAllOnesValue(TypeBits) - 1;
2825 return C->getValue() == APInt::getSignedMaxValue(TypeBits)-1;
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00002826}
2827
2828// isMinValuePlusOne - return true if this is Min+1
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002829static bool isMinValuePlusOne(const ConstantInt *C, bool isSigned) {
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002830 if (!isSigned)
2831 return C->getValue() == 1; // unsigned
2832
2833 // Calculate 1111111111000000000000
2834 uint32_t TypeBits = C->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
2835 return C->getValue() == APInt::getSignedMinValue(TypeBits)+1;
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00002836}
2837
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00002838// isOneBitSet - Return true if there is exactly one bit set in the specified
2839// constant.
2840static bool isOneBitSet(const ConstantInt *CI) {
Reid Spencer5f6a8952007-03-20 00:16:52 +00002841 return CI->getValue().isPowerOf2();
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00002842}
2843
Chris Lattnerb20ba0a2004-09-23 21:46:38 +00002844// isHighOnes - Return true if the constant is of the form 1+0+.
2845// This is the same as lowones(~X).
2846static bool isHighOnes(const ConstantInt *CI) {
Zhou Sheng2cde46c2007-03-20 12:49:06 +00002847 return (~CI->getValue() + 1).isPowerOf2();
Chris Lattnerb20ba0a2004-09-23 21:46:38 +00002848}
2849
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002850/// getICmpCode - Encode a icmp predicate into a three bit mask. These bits
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002851/// are carefully arranged to allow folding of expressions such as:
2852///
2853/// (A < B) | (A > B) --> (A != B)
2854///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002855/// Note that this is only valid if the first and second predicates have the
2856/// same sign. Is illegal to do: (A u< B) | (A s> B)
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002857///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002858/// Three bits are used to represent the condition, as follows:
2859/// 0 A > B
2860/// 1 A == B
2861/// 2 A < B
2862///
2863/// <=> Value Definition
2864/// 000 0 Always false
2865/// 001 1 A > B
2866/// 010 2 A == B
2867/// 011 3 A >= B
2868/// 100 4 A < B
2869/// 101 5 A != B
2870/// 110 6 A <= B
2871/// 111 7 Always true
2872///
2873static unsigned getICmpCode(const ICmpInst *ICI) {
2874 switch (ICI->getPredicate()) {
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002875 // False -> 0
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002876 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: return 1; // 001
2877 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: return 1; // 001
2878 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: return 2; // 010
2879 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE: return 3; // 011
2880 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE: return 3; // 011
2881 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: return 4; // 100
2882 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: return 4; // 100
2883 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: return 5; // 101
2884 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE: return 6; // 110
2885 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: return 6; // 110
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002886 // True -> 7
2887 default:
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002888 assert(0 && "Invalid ICmp predicate!");
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002889 return 0;
2890 }
2891}
2892
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002893/// getICmpValue - This is the complement of getICmpCode, which turns an
2894/// opcode and two operands into either a constant true or false, or a brand
2895/// new /// ICmp instruction. The sign is passed in to determine which kind
2896/// of predicate to use in new icmp instructions.
2897static Value *getICmpValue(bool sign, unsigned code, Value *LHS, Value *RHS) {
2898 switch (code) {
2899 default: assert(0 && "Illegal ICmp code!");
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002900 case 0: return ConstantInt::getFalse();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002901 case 1:
2902 if (sign)
2903 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, LHS, RHS);
2904 else
2905 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, LHS, RHS);
2906 case 2: return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, LHS, RHS);
2907 case 3:
2908 if (sign)
2909 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, LHS, RHS);
2910 else
2911 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, LHS, RHS);
2912 case 4:
2913 if (sign)
2914 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, LHS, RHS);
2915 else
2916 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, LHS, RHS);
2917 case 5: return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, LHS, RHS);
2918 case 6:
2919 if (sign)
2920 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE, LHS, RHS);
2921 else
2922 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE, LHS, RHS);
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002923 case 7: return ConstantInt::getTrue();
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002924 }
2925}
2926
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002927static bool PredicatesFoldable(ICmpInst::Predicate p1, ICmpInst::Predicate p2) {
2928 return (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p1) == ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p2)) ||
2929 (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p1) &&
2930 (p2 == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ || p2 == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)) ||
2931 (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p2) &&
2932 (p1 == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ || p1 == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE));
2933}
2934
2935namespace {
2936// FoldICmpLogical - Implements (icmp1 A, B) & (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
2937struct FoldICmpLogical {
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002938 InstCombiner &IC;
2939 Value *LHS, *RHS;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002940 ICmpInst::Predicate pred;
2941 FoldICmpLogical(InstCombiner &ic, ICmpInst *ICI)
2942 : IC(ic), LHS(ICI->getOperand(0)), RHS(ICI->getOperand(1)),
2943 pred(ICI->getPredicate()) {}
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002944 bool shouldApply(Value *V) const {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002945 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(V))
2946 if (PredicatesFoldable(pred, ICI->getPredicate()))
2947 return (ICI->getOperand(0) == LHS && ICI->getOperand(1) == RHS ||
2948 ICI->getOperand(0) == RHS && ICI->getOperand(1) == LHS);
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002949 return false;
2950 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002951 Instruction *apply(Instruction &Log) const {
2952 ICmpInst *ICI = cast<ICmpInst>(Log.getOperand(0));
2953 if (ICI->getOperand(0) != LHS) {
2954 assert(ICI->getOperand(1) == LHS);
2955 ICI->swapOperands(); // Swap the LHS and RHS of the ICmp
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002956 }
2957
Chris Lattnerbc1dbfc2007-03-13 14:27:42 +00002958 ICmpInst *RHSICI = cast<ICmpInst>(Log.getOperand(1));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002959 unsigned LHSCode = getICmpCode(ICI);
Chris Lattnerbc1dbfc2007-03-13 14:27:42 +00002960 unsigned RHSCode = getICmpCode(RHSICI);
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002961 unsigned Code;
2962 switch (Log.getOpcode()) {
2963 case Instruction::And: Code = LHSCode & RHSCode; break;
2964 case Instruction::Or: Code = LHSCode | RHSCode; break;
2965 case Instruction::Xor: Code = LHSCode ^ RHSCode; break;
Chris Lattner021c1902003-09-22 20:33:34 +00002966 default: assert(0 && "Illegal logical opcode!"); return 0;
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002967 }
2968
Chris Lattnerbc1dbfc2007-03-13 14:27:42 +00002969 bool isSigned = ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(RHSICI->getPredicate()) ||
2970 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(ICI->getPredicate());
2971
2972 Value *RV = getICmpValue(isSigned, Code, LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002973 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RV))
2974 return I;
2975 // Otherwise, it's a constant boolean value...
2976 return IC.ReplaceInstUsesWith(Log, RV);
2977 }
2978};
Chris Lattnerd23b5ba2006-11-15 04:53:24 +00002979} // end anonymous namespace
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002980
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002981// OptAndOp - This handles expressions of the form ((val OP C1) & C2). Where
2982// the Op parameter is 'OP', OpRHS is 'C1', and AndRHS is 'C2'. Op is
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002983// guaranteed to be a binary operator.
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002984Instruction *InstCombiner::OptAndOp(Instruction *Op,
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002985 ConstantInt *OpRHS,
2986 ConstantInt *AndRHS,
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002987 BinaryOperator &TheAnd) {
2988 Value *X = Op->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner76f7fe22004-01-12 19:47:05 +00002989 Constant *Together = 0;
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002990 if (!Op->isShift())
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002991 Together = And(AndRHS, OpRHS);
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00002992
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002993 switch (Op->getOpcode()) {
2994 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002995 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002996 // (X ^ C1) & C2 --> (X & C2) ^ (C1&C2)
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00002997 Instruction *And = BinaryOperator::createAnd(X, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002998 InsertNewInstBefore(And, TheAnd);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00002999 And->takeName(Op);
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00003000 return BinaryOperator::createXor(And, Together);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003001 }
3002 break;
3003 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003004 if (Together == AndRHS) // (X | C) & C --> C
3005 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, AndRHS);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003006
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003007 if (Op->hasOneUse() && Together != OpRHS) {
3008 // (X | C1) & C2 --> (X | (C1&C2)) & C2
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003009 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::createOr(X, Together);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003010 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, TheAnd);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003011 Or->takeName(Op);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003012 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Or, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003013 }
3014 break;
3015 case Instruction::Add:
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00003016 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003017 // Adding a one to a single bit bit-field should be turned into an XOR
3018 // of the bit. First thing to check is to see if this AND is with a
3019 // single bit constant.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003020 const APInt& AndRHSV = cast<ConstantInt>(AndRHS)->getValue();
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003021
3022 // If there is only one bit set...
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00003023 if (isOneBitSet(cast<ConstantInt>(AndRHS))) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003024 // Ok, at this point, we know that we are masking the result of the
3025 // ADD down to exactly one bit. If the constant we are adding has
3026 // no bits set below this bit, then we can eliminate the ADD.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003027 const APInt& AddRHS = cast<ConstantInt>(OpRHS)->getValue();
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003028
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003029 // Check to see if any bits below the one bit set in AndRHSV are set.
3030 if ((AddRHS & (AndRHSV-1)) == 0) {
3031 // If not, the only thing that can effect the output of the AND is
3032 // the bit specified by AndRHSV. If that bit is set, the effect of
3033 // the XOR is to toggle the bit. If it is clear, then the ADD has
3034 // no effect.
3035 if ((AddRHS & AndRHSV) == 0) { // Bit is not set, noop
3036 TheAnd.setOperand(0, X);
3037 return &TheAnd;
3038 } else {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003039 // Pull the XOR out of the AND.
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003040 Instruction *NewAnd = BinaryOperator::createAnd(X, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003041 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, TheAnd);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003042 NewAnd->takeName(Op);
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00003043 return BinaryOperator::createXor(NewAnd, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003044 }
3045 }
3046 }
3047 }
3048 break;
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003049
3050 case Instruction::Shl: {
3051 // We know that the AND will not produce any of the bits shifted in, so if
3052 // the anded constant includes them, clear them now!
3053 //
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003054 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003055 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003056 APInt ShlMask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-OpRHSVal));
3057 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(AndRHS->getValue() & ShlMask);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003058
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003059 if (CI->getValue() == ShlMask) {
3060 // Masking out bits that the shift already masks
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003061 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, Op); // No need for the and.
3062 } else if (CI != AndRHS) { // Reducing bits set in and.
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003063 TheAnd.setOperand(1, CI);
3064 return &TheAnd;
3065 }
3066 break;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003067 }
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003068 case Instruction::LShr:
3069 {
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003070 // We know that the AND will not produce any of the bits shifted in, so if
3071 // the anded constant includes them, clear them now! This only applies to
3072 // unsigned shifts, because a signed shr may bring in set bits!
3073 //
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003074 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003075 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003076 APInt ShrMask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - OpRHSVal));
3077 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(AndRHS->getValue() & ShrMask);
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003078
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003079 if (CI->getValue() == ShrMask) {
3080 // Masking out bits that the shift already masks.
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003081 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, Op);
3082 } else if (CI != AndRHS) {
3083 TheAnd.setOperand(1, CI); // Reduce bits set in and cst.
3084 return &TheAnd;
3085 }
3086 break;
3087 }
3088 case Instruction::AShr:
3089 // Signed shr.
3090 // See if this is shifting in some sign extension, then masking it out
3091 // with an and.
3092 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003093 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003094 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003095 APInt ShrMask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - OpRHSVal));
3096 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(AndRHS->getValue() & ShrMask);
Reid Spencer7eb76382006-12-13 17:19:09 +00003097 if (C == AndRHS) { // Masking out bits shifted in.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00003098 // (Val ashr C1) & C2 -> (Val lshr C1) & C2
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003099 // Make the argument unsigned.
3100 Value *ShVal = Op->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003101 ShVal = InsertNewInstBefore(
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00003102 BinaryOperator::createLShr(ShVal, OpRHS,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003103 Op->getName()), TheAnd);
Reid Spencer7eb76382006-12-13 17:19:09 +00003104 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(ShVal, AndRHS, TheAnd.getName());
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003105 }
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003106 }
3107 break;
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003108 }
3109 return 0;
3110}
3111
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00003112
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003113/// InsertRangeTest - Emit a computation of: (V >= Lo && V < Hi) if Inside is
3114/// true, otherwise (V < Lo || V >= Hi). In pratice, we emit the more efficient
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003115/// (V-Lo) <u Hi-Lo. This method expects that Lo <= Hi. isSigned indicates
3116/// whether to treat the V, Lo and HI as signed or not. IB is the location to
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003117/// insert new instructions.
3118Instruction *InstCombiner::InsertRangeTest(Value *V, Constant *Lo, Constant *Hi,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003119 bool isSigned, bool Inside,
3120 Instruction &IB) {
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003121 assert(cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getICmp((isSigned ?
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00003122 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE), Lo, Hi))->getZExtValue() &&
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003123 "Lo is not <= Hi in range emission code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003124
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003125 if (Inside) {
3126 if (Lo == Hi) // Trivially false.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003127 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, V, V);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003128
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003129 // V >= Min && V < Hi --> V < Hi
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003130 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Lo)->isMinValue(isSigned)) {
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003131 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = (isSigned ?
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003132 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT : ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT);
3133 return new ICmpInst(pred, V, Hi);
3134 }
3135
3136 // Emit V-Lo <u Hi-Lo
3137 Constant *NegLo = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Lo);
3138 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::createAdd(V, NegLo, V->getName()+".off");
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003139 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, IB);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003140 Constant *UpperBound = ConstantExpr::getAdd(NegLo, Hi);
3141 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Add, UpperBound);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003142 }
3143
3144 if (Lo == Hi) // Trivially true.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003145 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, V, V);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003146
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003147 // V < Min || V >= Hi -> V > Hi-1
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003148 Hi = SubOne(cast<ConstantInt>(Hi));
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003149 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Lo)->isMinValue(isSigned)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003150 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = (isSigned ?
3151 ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT : ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT);
3152 return new ICmpInst(pred, V, Hi);
3153 }
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00003154
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003155 // Emit V-Lo >u Hi-1-Lo
3156 // Note that Hi has already had one subtracted from it, above.
3157 ConstantInt *NegLo = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(Lo));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003158 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::createAdd(V, NegLo, V->getName()+".off");
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003159 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, IB);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003160 Constant *LowerBound = ConstantExpr::getAdd(NegLo, Hi);
3161 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Add, LowerBound);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003162}
3163
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003164// isRunOfOnes - Returns true iff Val consists of one contiguous run of 1s with
3165// any number of 0s on either side. The 1s are allowed to wrap from LSB to
3166// MSB, so 0x000FFF0, 0x0000FFFF, and 0xFF0000FF are all runs. 0x0F0F0000 is
3167// not, since all 1s are not contiguous.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00003168static bool isRunOfOnes(ConstantInt *Val, uint32_t &MB, uint32_t &ME) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003169 const APInt& V = Val->getValue();
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003170 uint32_t BitWidth = Val->getType()->getBitWidth();
3171 if (!APIntOps::isShiftedMask(BitWidth, V)) return false;
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003172
3173 // look for the first zero bit after the run of ones
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003174 MB = BitWidth - ((V - 1) ^ V).countLeadingZeros();
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003175 // look for the first non-zero bit
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003176 ME = V.getActiveBits();
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003177 return true;
3178}
3179
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003180/// FoldLogicalPlusAnd - This is part of an expression (LHS +/- RHS) & Mask,
3181/// where isSub determines whether the operator is a sub. If we can fold one of
3182/// the following xforms:
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003183///
3184/// ((A & N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == Mask
3185/// ((A | N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == 0
3186/// ((A ^ N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == 0
3187///
3188/// return (A +/- B).
3189///
3190Value *InstCombiner::FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS,
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003191 ConstantInt *Mask, bool isSub,
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003192 Instruction &I) {
3193 Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS);
3194 if (!LHSI || LHSI->getNumOperands() != 2 ||
3195 !isa<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) return 0;
3196
3197 ConstantInt *N = cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
3198
3199 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
3200 default: return 0;
3201 case Instruction::And:
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00003202 if (And(N, Mask) == Mask) {
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003203 // If the AndRHS is a power of two minus one (0+1+), this is simple.
Zhou Sheng00f436c2007-03-24 15:34:37 +00003204 if ((Mask->getValue().countLeadingZeros() +
3205 Mask->getValue().countPopulation()) ==
3206 Mask->getValue().getBitWidth())
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003207 break;
3208
3209 // Otherwise, if Mask is 0+1+0+, and if B is known to have the low 0+
3210 // part, we don't need any explicit masks to take them out of A. If that
3211 // is all N is, ignore it.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00003212 uint32_t MB = 0, ME = 0;
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003213 if (isRunOfOnes(Mask, MB, ME)) { // begin/end bit of run, inclusive
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00003214 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(RHS->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003215 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, MB-1));
Chris Lattner3bedbd92006-02-07 07:27:52 +00003216 if (MaskedValueIsZero(RHS, Mask))
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003217 break;
3218 }
3219 }
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003220 return 0;
3221 case Instruction::Or:
3222 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003223 // If the AndRHS is a power of two minus one (0+1+), and N&Mask == 0
Zhou Sheng00f436c2007-03-24 15:34:37 +00003224 if ((Mask->getValue().countLeadingZeros() +
3225 Mask->getValue().countPopulation()) == Mask->getValue().getBitWidth()
Reid Spencer6eb0d992007-03-26 23:58:26 +00003226 && And(N, Mask)->isZero())
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003227 break;
3228 return 0;
3229 }
3230
3231 Instruction *New;
3232 if (isSub)
3233 New = BinaryOperator::createSub(LHSI->getOperand(0), RHS, "fold");
3234 else
3235 New = BinaryOperator::createAdd(LHSI->getOperand(0), RHS, "fold");
3236 return InsertNewInstBefore(New, I);
3237}
3238
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003239Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAnd(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00003240 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003241 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003242
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00003243 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X & undef -> 0
3244 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
3245
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003246 // and X, X = X
3247 if (Op0 == Op1)
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00003248 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003249
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00003250 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00003251 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00003252 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00003253 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
3254 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
3255 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003256 KnownZero, KnownOne))
Reid Spencer6eb0d992007-03-26 23:58:26 +00003257 return &I;
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003258 } else {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00003259 if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00003260 if (CP->isAllOnesValue()) // X & <-1,-1> -> X
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003261 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, I.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00003262 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1)) {
3263 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X & <0,0> -> <0,0>
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003264 }
3265 }
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00003266
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003267 if (ConstantInt *AndRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003268 const APInt& AndRHSMask = AndRHS->getValue();
3269 APInt NotAndRHS(~AndRHSMask);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003270
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003271 // Optimize a variety of ((val OP C1) & C2) combinations...
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003272 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003273 Instruction *Op0I = cast<Instruction>(Op0);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003274 Value *Op0LHS = Op0I->getOperand(0);
3275 Value *Op0RHS = Op0I->getOperand(1);
3276 switch (Op0I->getOpcode()) {
3277 case Instruction::Xor:
3278 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003279 // If the mask is only needed on one incoming arm, push it up.
3280 if (Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
3281 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0LHS, NotAndRHS)) {
3282 // Not masking anything out for the LHS, move to RHS.
3283 Instruction *NewRHS = BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0RHS, AndRHS,
3284 Op0RHS->getName()+".masked");
3285 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRHS, I);
3286 return BinaryOperator::create(
3287 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0I)->getOpcode(), Op0LHS, NewRHS);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003288 }
Chris Lattner3bedbd92006-02-07 07:27:52 +00003289 if (!isa<Constant>(Op0RHS) &&
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003290 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0RHS, NotAndRHS)) {
3291 // Not masking anything out for the RHS, move to LHS.
3292 Instruction *NewLHS = BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0LHS, AndRHS,
3293 Op0LHS->getName()+".masked");
3294 InsertNewInstBefore(NewLHS, I);
3295 return BinaryOperator::create(
3296 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0I)->getOpcode(), NewLHS, Op0RHS);
3297 }
3298 }
3299
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003300 break;
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003301 case Instruction::Add:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003302 // ((A & N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == AndRHS.
3303 // ((A | N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3304 // ((A ^ N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3305 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0LHS, Op0RHS, AndRHS, false, I))
3306 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(V, AndRHS);
3307 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0RHS, Op0LHS, AndRHS, false, I))
3308 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(V, AndRHS); // Add commutes
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003309 break;
3310
3311 case Instruction::Sub:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003312 // ((A & N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == AndRHS.
3313 // ((A | N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3314 // ((A ^ N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3315 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0LHS, Op0RHS, AndRHS, true, I))
3316 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(V, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003317 break;
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003318 }
3319
Chris Lattner58403262003-07-23 19:25:52 +00003320 if (ConstantInt *Op0CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003321 if (Instruction *Res = OptAndOp(Op0I, Op0CI, AndRHS, I))
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003322 return Res;
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003323 } else if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003324 // If this is an integer truncation or change from signed-to-unsigned, and
3325 // if the source is an and/or with immediate, transform it. This
3326 // frequently occurs for bitfield accesses.
3327 if (Instruction *CastOp = dyn_cast<Instruction>(CI->getOperand(0))) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003328 if ((isa<TruncInst>(CI) || isa<BitCastInst>(CI)) &&
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003329 CastOp->getNumOperands() == 2)
Chris Lattner7560c3a2006-02-08 07:34:50 +00003330 if (ConstantInt *AndCI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CastOp->getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003331 if (CastOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::And) {
3332 // Change: and (cast (and X, C1) to T), C2
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003333 // into : and (cast X to T), trunc_or_bitcast(C1)&C2
3334 // This will fold the two constants together, which may allow
3335 // other simplifications.
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00003336 Instruction *NewCast = CastInst::createTruncOrBitCast(
3337 CastOp->getOperand(0), I.getType(),
3338 CastOp->getName()+".shrunk");
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003339 NewCast = InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, I);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003340 // trunc_or_bitcast(C1)&C2
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00003341 Constant *C3 = ConstantExpr::getTruncOrBitCast(AndCI,I.getType());
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003342 C3 = ConstantExpr::getAnd(C3, AndRHS);
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003343 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(NewCast, C3);
3344 } else if (CastOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
3345 // Change: and (cast (or X, C1) to T), C2
3346 // into : trunc(C1)&C2 iff trunc(C1)&C2 == C2
Chris Lattnerbb4e7b22006-12-12 19:11:20 +00003347 Constant *C3 = ConstantExpr::getTruncOrBitCast(AndCI,I.getType());
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003348 if (ConstantExpr::getAnd(C3, AndRHS) == AndRHS) // trunc(C1)&C2
3349 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, AndRHS);
3350 }
3351 }
Chris Lattner06782f82003-07-23 19:36:21 +00003352 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003353
3354 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
3355 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003356 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003357 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00003358 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
3359 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
3360 return NV;
Chris Lattnerc6a8aff2003-07-23 17:57:01 +00003361 }
3362
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00003363 Value *Op0NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op0);
3364 Value *Op1NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op1);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003365
Chris Lattner5b62aa72004-06-18 06:07:51 +00003366 if (Op0NotVal == Op1 || Op1NotVal == Op0) // A & ~A == ~A & A == 0
3367 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
3368
Misha Brukmancb6267b2004-07-30 12:50:08 +00003369 // (~A & ~B) == (~(A | B)) - De Morgan's Law
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00003370 if (Op0NotVal && Op1NotVal && isOnlyUse(Op0) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00003371 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::createOr(Op0NotVal, Op1NotVal,
3372 I.getName()+".demorgan");
Chris Lattnerc6a8aff2003-07-23 17:57:01 +00003373 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003374 return BinaryOperator::createNot(Or);
3375 }
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003376
3377 {
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003378 Value *A = 0, *B = 0, *C = 0, *D = 0;
3379 if (match(Op0, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003380 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) // (A | ?) & A --> A
3381 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003382
3383 // (A|B) & ~(A&B) -> A^B
3384 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D))))) {
3385 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
3386 return BinaryOperator::createXor(A, B);
3387 }
3388 }
3389
3390 if (match(Op1, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003391 if (A == Op0 || B == Op0) // A & (A | ?) --> A
3392 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003393
3394 // ~(A&B) & (A|B) -> A^B
3395 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D))))) {
3396 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
3397 return BinaryOperator::createXor(A, B);
3398 }
3399 }
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00003400
3401 if (Op0->hasOneUse() &&
3402 match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
3403 if (A == Op1) { // (A^B)&A -> A&(A^B)
3404 I.swapOperands(); // Simplify below
3405 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
3406 } else if (B == Op1) { // (A^B)&B -> B&(B^A)
3407 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)->swapOperands();
3408 I.swapOperands(); // Simplify below
3409 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
3410 }
3411 }
3412 if (Op1->hasOneUse() &&
3413 match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
3414 if (B == Op0) { // B&(A^B) -> B&(B^A)
3415 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)->swapOperands();
3416 std::swap(A, B);
3417 }
3418 if (A == Op0) { // A&(A^B) -> A & ~B
3419 Instruction *NotB = BinaryOperator::createNot(B, "tmp");
3420 InsertNewInstBefore(NotB, I);
3421 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(A, NotB);
3422 }
3423 }
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003424 }
3425
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003426 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Op1)) {
3427 // (icmp1 A, B) & (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
3428 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003429 return R;
3430
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003431 Value *LHSVal, *RHSVal;
3432 ConstantInt *LHSCst, *RHSCst;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003433 ICmpInst::Predicate LHSCC, RHSCC;
3434 if (match(Op0, m_ICmp(LHSCC, m_Value(LHSVal), m_ConstantInt(LHSCst))))
3435 if (match(RHS, m_ICmp(RHSCC, m_Value(RHSVal), m_ConstantInt(RHSCst))))
3436 if (LHSVal == RHSVal && // Found (X icmp C1) & (X icmp C2)
3437 // ICMP_[GL]E X, CST is folded to ICMP_[GL]T elsewhere.
3438 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
3439 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
3440 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE &&
3441 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE) {
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003442 // Ensure that the larger constant is on the RHS.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003443 ICmpInst::Predicate GT = ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(LHSCC) ?
3444 ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT : ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT;
3445 Constant *Cmp = ConstantExpr::getICmp(GT, LHSCst, RHSCst);
3446 ICmpInst *LHS = cast<ICmpInst>(Op0);
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00003447 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Cmp)->getZExtValue()) {
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003448 std::swap(LHS, RHS);
3449 std::swap(LHSCst, RHSCst);
3450 std::swap(LHSCC, RHSCC);
3451 }
3452
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003453 // At this point, we know we have have two icmp instructions
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003454 // comparing a value against two constants and and'ing the result
3455 // together. Because of the above check, we know that we only have
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003456 // icmp eq, icmp ne, icmp [su]lt, and icmp [SU]gt here. We also know
3457 // (from the FoldICmpLogical check above), that the two constants
3458 // are not equal and that the larger constant is on the RHS
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003459 assert(LHSCst != RHSCst && "Compares not folded above?");
3460
3461 switch (LHSCC) {
3462 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003463 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003464 switch (RHSCC) {
3465 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003466 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X == 13 & X == 15) -> false
3467 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X == 13 & X > 15) -> false
3468 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X == 13 & X > 15) -> false
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003469 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003470 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X == 13 & X != 15) -> X == 13
3471 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X == 13 & X < 15) -> X == 13
3472 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X == 13 & X < 15) -> X == 13
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003473 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3474 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003475 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003476 switch (RHSCC) {
3477 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003478 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
3479 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) // (X != 13 & X u< 14) -> X < 13
3480 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, LHSVal, LHSCst);
3481 break; // (X != 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3482 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
3483 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) // (X != 13 & X s< 14) -> X < 13
3484 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, LHSVal, LHSCst);
3485 break; // (X != 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3486 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X != 13 & X == 15) -> X == 15
3487 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X != 13 & X u> 15) -> X u> 15
3488 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X != 13 & X s> 15) -> X s> 15
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003489 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003490 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3491 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)){// (X != 13 & X != 14) -> X-13 >u 1
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003492 Constant *AddCST = ConstantExpr::getNeg(LHSCst);
3493 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::createAdd(LHSVal, AddCST,
3494 LHSVal->getName()+".off");
3495 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
Chris Lattner424db022007-01-27 23:08:34 +00003496 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Add,
3497 ConstantInt::get(Add->getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003498 }
3499 break; // (X != 13 & X != 15) -> no change
3500 }
3501 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003502 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003503 switch (RHSCC) {
3504 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003505 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u< 13 & X == 15) -> false
3506 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u< 13 & X u> 15) -> false
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003507 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003508 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u< 13 & X s> 15) -> no change
3509 break;
3510 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u< 13 & X != 15) -> X u< 13
3511 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u< 13 & X u< 15) -> X u< 13
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003512 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003513 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u< 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3514 break;
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003515 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003516 break;
3517 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003518 switch (RHSCC) {
3519 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003520 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s< 13 & X == 15) -> false
3521 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s< 13 & X s> 15) -> false
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003522 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003523 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s< 13 & X u> 15) -> no change
3524 break;
3525 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s< 13 & X != 15) -> X < 13
3526 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s< 13 & X s< 15) -> X < 13
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003527 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003528 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s< 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3529 break;
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003530 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003531 break;
3532 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
3533 switch (RHSCC) {
3534 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
3535 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u> 13 & X == 15) -> X > 13
3536 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3537 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u> 13 & X u> 15) -> X u> 15
3538 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3539 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u> 13 & X s> 15) -> no change
3540 break;
3541 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3542 if (RHSCst == AddOne(LHSCst)) // (X u> 13 & X != 14) -> X u> 14
3543 return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, LHSVal, RHSCst);
3544 break; // (X u> 13 & X != 15) -> no change
3545 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u> 13 & X u< 15) ->(X-14) <u 1
3546 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, AddOne(LHSCst), RHSCst, false,
3547 true, I);
3548 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u> 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3549 break;
3550 }
3551 break;
3552 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
3553 switch (RHSCC) {
3554 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
3555 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s> 13 & X == 15) -> X s> 13
3556 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3557 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s> 13 & X s> 15) -> X s> 15
3558 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3559 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s> 13 & X u> 15) -> no change
3560 break;
3561 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3562 if (RHSCst == AddOne(LHSCst)) // (X s> 13 & X != 14) -> X s> 14
3563 return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, LHSVal, RHSCst);
3564 break; // (X s> 13 & X != 15) -> no change
3565 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s> 13 & X s< 15) ->(X-14) s< 1
3566 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, AddOne(LHSCst), RHSCst, true,
3567 true, I);
3568 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s> 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3569 break;
3570 }
3571 break;
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003572 }
3573 }
3574 }
3575
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003576 // fold (and (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (and A, B))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003577 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0))
3578 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
3579 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) { // same cast kind ?
3580 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00003581 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003582 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be generated.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003583 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
3584 I.getType(), TD) &&
3585 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
3586 I.getType(), TD)) {
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003587 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0C->getOperand(0),
3588 Op1C->getOperand(0),
3589 I.getName());
3590 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
3591 return CastInst::create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
3592 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003593 }
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003594
3595 // (X >> Z) & (Y >> Z) -> (X&Y) >> Z for all shifts.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003596 if (BinaryOperator *SI1 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
3597 if (BinaryOperator *SI0 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
3598 if (SI0->isShift() && SI0->getOpcode() == SI1->getOpcode() &&
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003599 SI0->getOperand(1) == SI1->getOperand(1) &&
3600 (SI0->hasOneUse() || SI1->hasOneUse())) {
3601 Instruction *NewOp =
3602 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAnd(SI0->getOperand(0),
3603 SI1->getOperand(0),
3604 SI0->getName()), I);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003605 return BinaryOperator::create(SI1->getOpcode(), NewOp,
3606 SI1->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003607 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003608 }
3609
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003610 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003611}
3612
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003613/// CollectBSwapParts - Look to see if the specified value defines a single byte
3614/// in the result. If it does, and if the specified byte hasn't been filled in
3615/// yet, fill it in and return false.
Chris Lattner535014f2007-02-15 22:52:10 +00003616static bool CollectBSwapParts(Value *V, SmallVector<Value*, 8> &ByteValues) {
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003617 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
3618 if (I == 0) return true;
3619
3620 // If this is an or instruction, it is an inner node of the bswap.
3621 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or)
3622 return CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(0), ByteValues) ||
3623 CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(1), ByteValues);
3624
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003625 uint32_t BitWidth = I->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003626 // If this is a shift by a constant int, and it is "24", then its operand
3627 // defines a byte. We only handle unsigned types here.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003628 if (I->isShift() && isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003629 // Not shifting the entire input by N-1 bytes?
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003630 if (cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) !=
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003631 8*(ByteValues.size()-1))
3632 return true;
3633
3634 unsigned DestNo;
3635 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
3636 // X << 24 defines the top byte with the lowest of the input bytes.
3637 DestNo = ByteValues.size()-1;
3638 } else {
3639 // X >>u 24 defines the low byte with the highest of the input bytes.
3640 DestNo = 0;
3641 }
3642
3643 // If the destination byte value is already defined, the values are or'd
3644 // together, which isn't a bswap (unless it's an or of the same bits).
3645 if (ByteValues[DestNo] && ByteValues[DestNo] != I->getOperand(0))
3646 return true;
3647 ByteValues[DestNo] = I->getOperand(0);
3648 return false;
3649 }
3650
3651 // Otherwise, we can only handle and(shift X, imm), imm). Bail out of if we
3652 // don't have this.
3653 Value *Shift = 0, *ShiftLHS = 0;
3654 ConstantInt *AndAmt = 0, *ShiftAmt = 0;
3655 if (!match(I, m_And(m_Value(Shift), m_ConstantInt(AndAmt))) ||
3656 !match(Shift, m_Shift(m_Value(ShiftLHS), m_ConstantInt(ShiftAmt))))
3657 return true;
3658 Instruction *SI = cast<Instruction>(Shift);
3659
3660 // Make sure that the shift amount is by a multiple of 8 and isn't too big.
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003661 if (ShiftAmt->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) & 7 ||
3662 ShiftAmt->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) > 8*ByteValues.size())
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003663 return true;
3664
3665 // Turn 0xFF -> 0, 0xFF00 -> 1, 0xFF0000 -> 2, etc.
3666 unsigned DestByte;
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003667 if (AndAmt->getValue().getActiveBits() > 64)
3668 return true;
3669 uint64_t AndAmtVal = AndAmt->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003670 for (DestByte = 0; DestByte != ByteValues.size(); ++DestByte)
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003671 if (AndAmtVal == uint64_t(0xFF) << 8*DestByte)
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003672 break;
3673 // Unknown mask for bswap.
3674 if (DestByte == ByteValues.size()) return true;
3675
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00003676 unsigned ShiftBytes = ShiftAmt->getZExtValue()/8;
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003677 unsigned SrcByte;
3678 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
3679 SrcByte = DestByte - ShiftBytes;
3680 else
3681 SrcByte = DestByte + ShiftBytes;
3682
3683 // If the SrcByte isn't a bswapped value from the DestByte, reject it.
3684 if (SrcByte != ByteValues.size()-DestByte-1)
3685 return true;
3686
3687 // If the destination byte value is already defined, the values are or'd
3688 // together, which isn't a bswap (unless it's an or of the same bits).
3689 if (ByteValues[DestByte] && ByteValues[DestByte] != SI->getOperand(0))
3690 return true;
3691 ByteValues[DestByte] = SI->getOperand(0);
3692 return false;
3693}
3694
3695/// MatchBSwap - Given an OR instruction, check to see if this is a bswap idiom.
3696/// If so, insert the new bswap intrinsic and return it.
3697Instruction *InstCombiner::MatchBSwap(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner55fc8c42007-04-01 20:57:36 +00003698 const IntegerType *ITy = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(I.getType());
3699 if (!ITy || ITy->getBitWidth() % 16)
3700 return 0; // Can only bswap pairs of bytes. Can't do vectors.
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003701
3702 /// ByteValues - For each byte of the result, we keep track of which value
3703 /// defines each byte.
Chris Lattner535014f2007-02-15 22:52:10 +00003704 SmallVector<Value*, 8> ByteValues;
Chris Lattner55fc8c42007-04-01 20:57:36 +00003705 ByteValues.resize(ITy->getBitWidth()/8);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003706
3707 // Try to find all the pieces corresponding to the bswap.
3708 if (CollectBSwapParts(I.getOperand(0), ByteValues) ||
3709 CollectBSwapParts(I.getOperand(1), ByteValues))
3710 return 0;
3711
3712 // Check to see if all of the bytes come from the same value.
3713 Value *V = ByteValues[0];
3714 if (V == 0) return 0; // Didn't find a byte? Must be zero.
3715
3716 // Check to make sure that all of the bytes come from the same value.
3717 for (unsigned i = 1, e = ByteValues.size(); i != e; ++i)
3718 if (ByteValues[i] != V)
3719 return 0;
Chris Lattner55fc8c42007-04-01 20:57:36 +00003720 const Type *Tys[] = { ITy, ITy };
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003721 Module *M = I.getParent()->getParent()->getParent();
Chris Lattner55fc8c42007-04-01 20:57:36 +00003722 Function *F = Intrinsic::getDeclaration(M, Intrinsic::bswap, Tys, 2);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003723 return new CallInst(F, V);
3724}
3725
3726
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003727Instruction *InstCombiner::visitOr(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00003728 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003729 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003730
Chris Lattner42593e62007-03-24 23:56:43 +00003731 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X | undef -> -1
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00003732 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00003733
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00003734 // or X, X = X
3735 if (Op0 == Op1)
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00003736 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003737
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00003738 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
3739 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Chris Lattner42593e62007-03-24 23:56:43 +00003740 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
3741 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
3742 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
3743 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
3744 KnownZero, KnownOne))
3745 return &I;
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00003746 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1)) {
3747 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // X | <0,0> -> X
3748 } else if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
3749 if (CP->isAllOnesValue()) // X | <-1,-1> -> <-1,-1>
3750 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, I.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner42593e62007-03-24 23:56:43 +00003751 }
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00003752
3753
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00003754
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003755 // or X, -1 == -1
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003756 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00003757 ConstantInt *C1 = 0; Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003758 // (X & C1) | C2 --> (X | C2) & (C1|C2)
3759 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C1))) && isOnlyUse(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003760 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::createOr(X, RHS);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003761 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003762 Or->takeName(Op0);
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00003763 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Or,
3764 ConstantInt::get(RHS->getValue() | C1->getValue()));
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003765 }
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00003766
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003767 // (X ^ C1) | C2 --> (X | C2) ^ (C1&~C2)
3768 if (match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C1))) && isOnlyUse(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003769 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::createOr(X, RHS);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003770 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003771 Or->takeName(Op0);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003772 return BinaryOperator::createXor(Or,
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00003773 ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() & ~RHS->getValue()));
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00003774 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003775
3776 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
3777 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003778 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003779 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00003780 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
3781 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
3782 return NV;
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00003783 }
3784
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00003785 Value *A = 0, *B = 0;
3786 ConstantInt *C1 = 0, *C2 = 0;
Chris Lattnerf4d4c872005-05-07 23:49:08 +00003787
3788 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))
3789 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) // (A & ?) | A --> A
3790 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
3791 if (match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))
3792 if (A == Op0 || B == Op0) // A | (A & ?) --> A
3793 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
3794
Chris Lattner6423d4c2006-07-10 20:25:24 +00003795 // (A | B) | C and A | (B | C) -> bswap if possible.
3796 // (A >> B) | (C << D) and (A << B) | (B >> C) -> bswap if possible.
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003797 if (match(Op0, m_Or(m_Value(), m_Value())) ||
Chris Lattner6423d4c2006-07-10 20:25:24 +00003798 match(Op1, m_Or(m_Value(), m_Value())) ||
3799 (match(Op0, m_Shift(m_Value(), m_Value())) &&
3800 match(Op1, m_Shift(m_Value(), m_Value())))) {
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003801 if (Instruction *BSwap = MatchBSwap(I))
3802 return BSwap;
3803 }
3804
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00003805 // (X^C)|Y -> (X|Y)^C iff Y&C == 0
3806 if (Op0->hasOneUse() && match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00003807 MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, C1->getValue())) {
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003808 Instruction *NOr = BinaryOperator::createOr(A, Op1);
3809 InsertNewInstBefore(NOr, I);
3810 NOr->takeName(Op0);
3811 return BinaryOperator::createXor(NOr, C1);
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00003812 }
3813
3814 // Y|(X^C) -> (X|Y)^C iff Y&C == 0
3815 if (Op1->hasOneUse() && match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00003816 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, C1->getValue())) {
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003817 Instruction *NOr = BinaryOperator::createOr(A, Op0);
3818 InsertNewInstBefore(NOr, I);
3819 NOr->takeName(Op0);
3820 return BinaryOperator::createXor(NOr, C1);
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00003821 }
3822
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00003823 // (A & C)|(B & D)
Chris Lattner2384d7b2007-06-19 05:43:49 +00003824 Value *C = 0, *D = 0;
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00003825 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(C))) &&
3826 match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(B), m_Value(D)))) {
Chris Lattner6cae0e02007-04-08 07:55:22 +00003827 Value *V1 = 0, *V2 = 0, *V3 = 0;
3828 C1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(C);
3829 C2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(D);
3830 if (C1 && C2) { // (A & C1)|(B & C2)
3831 // If we have: ((V + N) & C1) | (V & C2)
3832 // .. and C2 = ~C1 and C2 is 0+1+ and (N & C2) == 0
3833 // replace with V+N.
3834 if (C1->getValue() == ~C2->getValue()) {
3835 if ((C2->getValue() & (C2->getValue()+1)) == 0 && // C2 == 0+1+
3836 match(A, m_Add(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)))) {
3837 // Add commutes, try both ways.
3838 if (V1 == B && MaskedValueIsZero(V2, C2->getValue()))
3839 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
3840 if (V2 == B && MaskedValueIsZero(V1, C2->getValue()))
3841 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
3842 }
3843 // Or commutes, try both ways.
3844 if ((C1->getValue() & (C1->getValue()+1)) == 0 &&
3845 match(B, m_Add(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)))) {
3846 // Add commutes, try both ways.
3847 if (V1 == A && MaskedValueIsZero(V2, C1->getValue()))
3848 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
3849 if (V2 == A && MaskedValueIsZero(V1, C1->getValue()))
3850 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
3851 }
3852 }
Chris Lattner044e5332007-04-08 08:01:49 +00003853 V1 = 0; V2 = 0; V3 = 0;
Chris Lattner6cae0e02007-04-08 07:55:22 +00003854 }
3855
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00003856 // Check to see if we have any common things being and'ed. If so, find the
3857 // terms for V1 & (V2|V3).
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00003858 if (isOnlyUse(Op0) || isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
3859 if (A == B) // (A & C)|(A & D) == A & (C|D)
3860 V1 = A, V2 = C, V3 = D;
3861 else if (A == D) // (A & C)|(B & A) == A & (B|C)
3862 V1 = A, V2 = B, V3 = C;
3863 else if (C == B) // (A & C)|(C & D) == C & (A|D)
3864 V1 = C, V2 = A, V3 = D;
3865 else if (C == D) // (A & C)|(B & C) == C & (A|B)
3866 V1 = C, V2 = A, V3 = B;
3867
3868 if (V1) {
3869 Value *Or =
3870 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createOr(V2, V3, "tmp"), I);
3871 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(V1, Or);
Chris Lattner0b7c0bf2005-09-18 06:02:59 +00003872 }
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00003873
3874 // (V1 & V3)|(V2 & ~V3) -> ((V1 ^ V2) & V3) ^ V2
Chris Lattner044e5332007-04-08 08:01:49 +00003875 if (isOnlyUse(Op0) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00003876 // Try all combination of terms to find V3 and ~V3.
3877 if (A->hasOneUse() && match(A, m_Not(m_Value(V3)))) {
3878 if (V3 == B)
3879 V1 = D, V2 = C;
3880 else if (V3 == D)
3881 V1 = B, V2 = C;
3882 }
3883 if (B->hasOneUse() && match(B, m_Not(m_Value(V3)))) {
3884 if (V3 == A)
3885 V1 = C, V2 = D;
3886 else if (V3 == C)
3887 V1 = A, V2 = D;
3888 }
3889 if (C->hasOneUse() && match(C, m_Not(m_Value(V3)))) {
3890 if (V3 == B)
3891 V1 = D, V2 = A;
3892 else if (V3 == D)
3893 V1 = B, V2 = A;
3894 }
3895 if (D->hasOneUse() && match(D, m_Not(m_Value(V3)))) {
3896 if (V3 == A)
3897 V1 = C, V2 = B;
3898 else if (V3 == C)
3899 V1 = A, V2 = B;
3900 }
3901 if (V1) {
3902 A = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createXor(V1, V2, "tmp"), I);
3903 A = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAnd(A, V3, "tmp"), I);
3904 return BinaryOperator::createXor(A, V2);
3905 }
3906 }
3907 }
Chris Lattnere9bed7d2005-09-18 03:42:07 +00003908 }
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003909
3910 // (X >> Z) | (Y >> Z) -> (X|Y) >> Z for all shifts.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003911 if (BinaryOperator *SI1 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
3912 if (BinaryOperator *SI0 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
3913 if (SI0->isShift() && SI0->getOpcode() == SI1->getOpcode() &&
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003914 SI0->getOperand(1) == SI1->getOperand(1) &&
3915 (SI0->hasOneUse() || SI1->hasOneUse())) {
3916 Instruction *NewOp =
3917 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createOr(SI0->getOperand(0),
3918 SI1->getOperand(0),
3919 SI0->getName()), I);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003920 return BinaryOperator::create(SI1->getOpcode(), NewOp,
3921 SI1->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003922 }
3923 }
Chris Lattner67ca7682003-08-12 19:11:07 +00003924
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003925 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_Value(A)))) { // ~A | Op1
3926 if (A == Op1) // ~A | A == -1
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00003927 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003928 } else {
3929 A = 0;
3930 }
Chris Lattnerf4d4c872005-05-07 23:49:08 +00003931 // Note, A is still live here!
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003932 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(B)))) { // Op0 | ~B
3933 if (Op0 == B)
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00003934 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera27231a2003-03-10 23:13:59 +00003935
Misha Brukmancb6267b2004-07-30 12:50:08 +00003936 // (~A | ~B) == (~(A & B)) - De Morgan's Law
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003937 if (A && isOnlyUse(Op0) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
3938 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAnd(A, B,
3939 I.getName()+".demorgan"), I);
3940 return BinaryOperator::createNot(And);
3941 }
Chris Lattnera27231a2003-03-10 23:13:59 +00003942 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003943
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003944 // (icmp1 A, B) | (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
3945 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(I.getOperand(1))) {
3946 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003947 return R;
3948
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003949 Value *LHSVal, *RHSVal;
3950 ConstantInt *LHSCst, *RHSCst;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003951 ICmpInst::Predicate LHSCC, RHSCC;
3952 if (match(Op0, m_ICmp(LHSCC, m_Value(LHSVal), m_ConstantInt(LHSCst))))
3953 if (match(RHS, m_ICmp(RHSCC, m_Value(RHSVal), m_ConstantInt(RHSCst))))
3954 if (LHSVal == RHSVal && // Found (X icmp C1) | (X icmp C2)
3955 // icmp [us][gl]e x, cst is folded to icmp [us][gl]t elsewhere.
3956 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
3957 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
3958 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE &&
Chris Lattner88858872007-05-11 05:55:56 +00003959 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE &&
3960 // We can't fold (ugt x, C) | (sgt x, C2).
3961 PredicatesFoldable(LHSCC, RHSCC)) {
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003962 // Ensure that the larger constant is on the RHS.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003963 ICmpInst *LHS = cast<ICmpInst>(Op0);
Chris Lattner88858872007-05-11 05:55:56 +00003964 bool NeedsSwap;
3965 if (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(LHSCC))
Chris Lattner3aea1bd2007-05-11 16:58:45 +00003966 NeedsSwap = LHSCst->getValue().sgt(RHSCst->getValue());
Chris Lattner88858872007-05-11 05:55:56 +00003967 else
Chris Lattner3aea1bd2007-05-11 16:58:45 +00003968 NeedsSwap = LHSCst->getValue().ugt(RHSCst->getValue());
Chris Lattner88858872007-05-11 05:55:56 +00003969
3970 if (NeedsSwap) {
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003971 std::swap(LHS, RHS);
3972 std::swap(LHSCst, RHSCst);
3973 std::swap(LHSCC, RHSCC);
3974 }
3975
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003976 // At this point, we know we have have two icmp instructions
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003977 // comparing a value against two constants and or'ing the result
3978 // together. Because of the above check, we know that we only have
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003979 // ICMP_EQ, ICMP_NE, ICMP_LT, and ICMP_GT here. We also know (from the
3980 // FoldICmpLogical check above), that the two constants are not
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003981 // equal.
3982 assert(LHSCst != RHSCst && "Compares not folded above?");
3983
3984 switch (LHSCC) {
3985 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003986 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003987 switch (RHSCC) {
3988 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003989 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003990 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) {// (X == 13 | X == 14) -> X-13 <u 2
3991 Constant *AddCST = ConstantExpr::getNeg(LHSCst);
3992 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::createAdd(LHSVal, AddCST,
3993 LHSVal->getName()+".off");
3994 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00003995 AddCST = Subtract(AddOne(RHSCst), LHSCst);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003996 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Add, AddCST);
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003997 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003998 break; // (X == 13 | X == 15) -> no change
3999 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X == 13 | X u> 14) -> no change
4000 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X == 13 | X s> 14) -> no change
Chris Lattner240d6f42005-04-19 06:04:18 +00004001 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004002 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X == 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
4003 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X == 13 | X u< 15) -> X u< 15
4004 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X == 13 | X s< 15) -> X s< 15
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004005 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
4006 }
4007 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004008 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004009 switch (RHSCC) {
4010 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004011 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X != 13 | X == 15) -> X != 13
4012 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X != 13 | X u> 15) -> X != 13
4013 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X != 13 | X s> 15) -> X != 13
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004014 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004015 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X != 13 | X != 15) -> true
4016 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X != 13 | X u< 15) -> true
4017 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X != 13 | X s< 15) -> true
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004018 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004019 }
4020 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004021 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004022 switch (RHSCC) {
4023 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004024 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u< 13 | X == 14) -> no change
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004025 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004026 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u< 13 | X u> 15) ->(X-13) u> 2
4027 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, LHSCst, AddOne(RHSCst), false,
4028 false, I);
4029 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u< 13 | X s> 15) -> no change
4030 break;
4031 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u< 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
4032 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u< 13 | X u< 15) -> X u< 15
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004033 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004034 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u< 13 | X s< 15) -> no change
4035 break;
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004036 }
4037 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004038 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004039 switch (RHSCC) {
4040 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004041 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s< 13 | X == 14) -> no change
4042 break;
4043 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s< 13 | X s> 15) ->(X-13) s> 2
4044 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, LHSCst, AddOne(RHSCst), true,
4045 false, I);
4046 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s< 13 | X u> 15) -> no change
4047 break;
4048 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s< 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
4049 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s< 13 | X s< 15) -> X s< 15
4050 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
4051 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s< 13 | X u< 15) -> no change
4052 break;
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004053 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004054 break;
4055 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
4056 switch (RHSCC) {
4057 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
4058 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u> 13 | X == 15) -> X u> 13
4059 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u> 13 | X u> 15) -> X u> 13
4060 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4061 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u> 13 | X s> 15) -> no change
4062 break;
4063 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u> 13 | X != 15) -> true
4064 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u> 13 | X u< 15) -> true
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004065 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004066 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u> 13 | X s< 15) -> no change
4067 break;
4068 }
4069 break;
4070 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
4071 switch (RHSCC) {
4072 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
4073 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s> 13 | X == 15) -> X > 13
4074 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s> 13 | X s> 15) -> X > 13
4075 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4076 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s> 13 | X u> 15) -> no change
4077 break;
4078 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s> 13 | X != 15) -> true
4079 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s> 13 | X s< 15) -> true
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004080 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004081 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s> 13 | X u< 15) -> no change
4082 break;
4083 }
4084 break;
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004085 }
4086 }
4087 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004088
4089 // fold (or (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (or A, B))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004090 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004091 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004092 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) {// same cast kind ?
4093 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00004094 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004095 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be generated.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004096 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
4097 I.getType(), TD) &&
4098 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
4099 I.getType(), TD)) {
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004100 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::createOr(Op0C->getOperand(0),
4101 Op1C->getOperand(0),
4102 I.getName());
4103 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
4104 return CastInst::create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
4105 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004106 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004107
Chris Lattnere9bed7d2005-09-18 03:42:07 +00004108
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004109 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004110}
4111
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00004112// XorSelf - Implements: X ^ X --> 0
4113struct XorSelf {
4114 Value *RHS;
4115 XorSelf(Value *rhs) : RHS(rhs) {}
4116 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const { return LHS == RHS; }
4117 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Xor) const {
4118 return &Xor;
4119 }
4120};
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004121
4122
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004123Instruction *InstCombiner::visitXor(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00004124 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004125 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004126
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004127 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
4128 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X ^ undef -> undef
4129
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00004130 // xor X, X = 0, even if X is nested in a sequence of Xor's.
4131 if (Instruction *Result = AssociativeOpt(I, XorSelf(Op1))) {
4132 assert(Result == &I && "AssociativeOpt didn't work?");
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00004133 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00004134 }
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004135
4136 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
4137 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004138 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
4139 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
4140 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
4141 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
4142 KnownZero, KnownOne))
4143 return &I;
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00004144 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1)) {
4145 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // X ^ <0,0> -> X
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004146 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004147
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004148 // Is this a ~ operation?
4149 if (Value *NotOp = dyn_castNotVal(&I)) {
4150 // ~(~X & Y) --> (X | ~Y) - De Morgan's Law
4151 // ~(~X | Y) === (X & ~Y) - De Morgan's Law
4152 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NotOp)) {
4153 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And ||
4154 Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
4155 if (dyn_castNotVal(Op0I->getOperand(1))) Op0I->swapOperands();
4156 if (Value *Op0NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op0I->getOperand(0))) {
4157 Instruction *NotY =
4158 BinaryOperator::createNot(Op0I->getOperand(1),
4159 Op0I->getOperand(1)->getName()+".not");
4160 InsertNewInstBefore(NotY, I);
4161 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And)
4162 return BinaryOperator::createOr(Op0NotVal, NotY);
4163 else
4164 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0NotVal, NotY);
4165 }
4166 }
4167 }
4168 }
4169
4170
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004171 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004172 // xor (icmp A, B), true = not (icmp A, B) = !icmp A, B
4173 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Op0))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004174 if (RHS == ConstantInt::getTrue() && ICI->hasOneUse())
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004175 return new ICmpInst(ICI->getInversePredicate(),
4176 ICI->getOperand(0), ICI->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnerad5b4fb2003-11-04 23:50:51 +00004177
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004178 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00004179 // ~(c-X) == X-c-1 == X+(-c-1)
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004180 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub && RHS->isAllOnesValue())
4181 if (Constant *Op0I0C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op0I->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004182 Constant *NegOp0I0C = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Op0I0C);
4183 Constant *ConstantRHS = ConstantExpr::getSub(NegOp0I0C,
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004184 ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004185 return BinaryOperator::createAdd(Op0I->getOperand(1), ConstantRHS);
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004186 }
Chris Lattner5c6e2db2007-04-02 05:36:22 +00004187
Chris Lattnereca0c5c2003-07-23 21:37:07 +00004188 if (ConstantInt *Op0CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004189 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
Chris Lattner689d24b2003-11-04 23:37:10 +00004190 // ~(X-c) --> (-c-1)-X
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004191 if (RHS->isAllOnesValue()) {
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004192 Constant *NegOp0CI = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Op0CI);
4193 return BinaryOperator::createSub(
4194 ConstantExpr::getSub(NegOp0CI,
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004195 ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1)),
Chris Lattner689d24b2003-11-04 23:37:10 +00004196 Op0I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattneracf4e072007-04-02 05:42:22 +00004197 } else if (RHS->getValue().isSignBit()) {
Chris Lattner5c6e2db2007-04-02 05:36:22 +00004198 // (X + C) ^ signbit -> (X + C + signbit)
4199 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(RHS->getValue() + Op0CI->getValue());
4200 return BinaryOperator::createAdd(Op0I->getOperand(0), C);
Chris Lattnercd1d6d52007-04-02 05:48:58 +00004201
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004202 }
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004203 } else if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
4204 // (X|C1)^C2 -> X^(C1|C2) iff X&~C1 == 0
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004205 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0I->getOperand(0), Op0CI->getValue())) {
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004206 Constant *NewRHS = ConstantExpr::getOr(Op0CI, RHS);
4207 // Anything in both C1 and C2 is known to be zero, remove it from
4208 // NewRHS.
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00004209 Constant *CommonBits = And(Op0CI, RHS);
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004210 NewRHS = ConstantExpr::getAnd(NewRHS,
4211 ConstantExpr::getNot(CommonBits));
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00004212 AddToWorkList(Op0I);
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004213 I.setOperand(0, Op0I->getOperand(0));
4214 I.setOperand(1, NewRHS);
4215 return &I;
4216 }
Chris Lattnereca0c5c2003-07-23 21:37:07 +00004217 }
Chris Lattner05bd1b22002-08-20 18:24:26 +00004218 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004219
4220 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
4221 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004222 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004223 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00004224 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
4225 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
4226 return NV;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004227 }
4228
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00004229 if (Value *X = dyn_castNotVal(Op0)) // ~A ^ A == -1
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004230 if (X == Op1)
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004231 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004232
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00004233 if (Value *X = dyn_castNotVal(Op1)) // A ^ ~A == -1
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004234 if (X == Op0)
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004235 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004236
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004237
4238 BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1);
4239 if (Op1I) {
4240 Value *A, *B;
4241 if (match(Op1I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
4242 if (A == Op0) { // B^(B|A) == (A|B)^B
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004243 Op1I->swapOperands();
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004244 I.swapOperands();
4245 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004246 } else if (B == Op0) { // B^(A|B) == (A|B)^B
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004247 I.swapOperands(); // Simplified below.
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004248 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004249 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004250 } else if (match(Op1I, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
4251 if (Op0 == A) // A^(A^B) == B
4252 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4253 else if (Op0 == B) // A^(B^A) == B
4254 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4255 } else if (match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && Op1I->hasOneUse()){
Chris Lattner6abbdf92007-04-01 05:36:37 +00004256 if (A == Op0) { // A^(A&B) -> A^(B&A)
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004257 Op1I->swapOperands();
Chris Lattner6abbdf92007-04-01 05:36:37 +00004258 std::swap(A, B);
4259 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004260 if (B == Op0) { // A^(B&A) -> (B&A)^A
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004261 I.swapOperands(); // Simplified below.
4262 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
4263 }
Chris Lattner26ca7e12004-02-16 03:54:20 +00004264 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004265 }
4266
4267 BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0);
4268 if (Op0I) {
4269 Value *A, *B;
4270 if (match(Op0I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
4271 if (A == Op1) // (B|A)^B == (A|B)^B
4272 std::swap(A, B);
4273 if (B == Op1) { // (A|B)^B == A & ~B
4274 Instruction *NotB =
4275 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createNot(Op1, "tmp"), I);
4276 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(A, NotB);
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004277 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004278 } else if (match(Op0I, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
4279 if (Op1 == A) // (A^B)^A == B
4280 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4281 else if (Op1 == B) // (B^A)^A == B
4282 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4283 } else if (match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && Op0I->hasOneUse()){
4284 if (A == Op1) // (A&B)^A -> (B&A)^A
4285 std::swap(A, B);
4286 if (B == Op1 && // (B&A)^A == ~B & A
Chris Lattnerae1ab392006-04-01 22:05:01 +00004287 !isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) { // Canonical form is (B&C)^C
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004288 Instruction *N =
4289 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createNot(A, "tmp"), I);
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004290 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(N, Op1);
4291 }
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004292 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004293 }
4294
4295 // (X >> Z) ^ (Y >> Z) -> (X^Y) >> Z for all shifts.
4296 if (Op0I && Op1I && Op0I->isShift() &&
4297 Op0I->getOpcode() == Op1I->getOpcode() &&
4298 Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1I->getOperand(1) &&
4299 (Op1I->hasOneUse() || Op1I->hasOneUse())) {
4300 Instruction *NewOp =
4301 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createXor(Op0I->getOperand(0),
4302 Op1I->getOperand(0),
4303 Op0I->getName()), I);
4304 return BinaryOperator::create(Op1I->getOpcode(), NewOp,
4305 Op1I->getOperand(1));
4306 }
4307
4308 if (Op0I && Op1I) {
4309 Value *A, *B, *C, *D;
4310 // (A & B)^(A | B) -> A ^ B
4311 if (match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
4312 match(Op1I, m_Or(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
4313 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
4314 return BinaryOperator::createXor(A, B);
4315 }
4316 // (A | B)^(A & B) -> A ^ B
4317 if (match(Op0I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
4318 match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
4319 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
4320 return BinaryOperator::createXor(A, B);
4321 }
4322
4323 // (A & B)^(C & D)
4324 if ((Op0I->hasOneUse() || Op1I->hasOneUse()) &&
4325 match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
4326 match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
4327 // (X & Y)^(X & Y) -> (Y^Z) & X
4328 Value *X = 0, *Y = 0, *Z = 0;
4329 if (A == C)
4330 X = A, Y = B, Z = D;
4331 else if (A == D)
4332 X = A, Y = B, Z = C;
4333 else if (B == C)
4334 X = B, Y = A, Z = D;
4335 else if (B == D)
4336 X = B, Y = A, Z = C;
4337
4338 if (X) {
4339 Instruction *NewOp =
4340 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createXor(Y, Z, Op0->getName()), I);
4341 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(NewOp, X);
4342 }
4343 }
4344 }
4345
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004346 // (icmp1 A, B) ^ (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
4347 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(I.getOperand(1)))
4348 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00004349 return R;
4350
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004351 // fold (xor (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (xor A, B))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004352 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004353 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004354 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) { // same cast kind?
4355 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00004356 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004357 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be generated.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004358 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
4359 I.getType(), TD) &&
4360 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
4361 I.getType(), TD)) {
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004362 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::createXor(Op0C->getOperand(0),
4363 Op1C->getOperand(0),
4364 I.getName());
4365 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
4366 return CastInst::create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
4367 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004368 }
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004369
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004370 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004371}
4372
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004373/// AddWithOverflow - Compute Result = In1+In2, returning true if the result
4374/// overflowed for this type.
4375static bool AddWithOverflow(ConstantInt *&Result, ConstantInt *In1,
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00004376 ConstantInt *In2, bool IsSigned = false) {
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00004377 Result = cast<ConstantInt>(Add(In1, In2));
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004378
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00004379 if (IsSigned)
4380 if (In2->getValue().isNegative())
4381 return Result->getValue().sgt(In1->getValue());
4382 else
4383 return Result->getValue().slt(In1->getValue());
4384 else
4385 return Result->getValue().ult(In1->getValue());
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004386}
4387
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004388/// EmitGEPOffset - Given a getelementptr instruction/constantexpr, emit the
4389/// code necessary to compute the offset from the base pointer (without adding
4390/// in the base pointer). Return the result as a signed integer of intptr size.
4391static Value *EmitGEPOffset(User *GEP, Instruction &I, InstCombiner &IC) {
4392 TargetData &TD = IC.getTargetData();
4393 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004394 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD.getIntPtrType();
4395 Value *Result = Constant::getNullValue(IntPtrTy);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004396
4397 // Build a mask for high order bits.
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004398 unsigned IntPtrWidth = TD.getPointerSize()*8;
4399 uint64_t PtrSizeMask = ~0ULL >> (64-IntPtrWidth);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004400
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004401 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEP->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
4402 Value *Op = GEP->getOperand(i);
Chris Lattner0b84c802005-01-13 23:26:48 +00004403 uint64_t Size = TD.getTypeSize(GTI.getIndexedType()) & PtrSizeMask;
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004404 if (ConstantInt *OpC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op)) {
4405 if (OpC->isZero()) continue;
4406
4407 // Handle a struct index, which adds its field offset to the pointer.
4408 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(*GTI)) {
4409 Size = TD.getStructLayout(STy)->getElementOffset(OpC->getZExtValue());
4410
4411 if (ConstantInt *RC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Result))
4412 Result = ConstantInt::get(RC->getValue() + APInt(IntPtrWidth, Size));
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00004413 else
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004414 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
4415 BinaryOperator::createAdd(Result,
4416 ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size),
4417 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
4418 continue;
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00004419 }
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004420
4421 Constant *Scale = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size);
4422 Constant *OC = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(OpC, IntPtrTy, true /*SExt*/);
4423 Scale = ConstantExpr::getMul(OC, Scale);
4424 if (Constant *RC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Result))
4425 Result = ConstantExpr::getAdd(RC, Scale);
4426 else {
4427 // Emit an add instruction.
4428 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
4429 BinaryOperator::createAdd(Result, Scale,
4430 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00004431 }
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004432 continue;
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004433 }
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004434 // Convert to correct type.
4435 if (Op->getType() != IntPtrTy) {
4436 if (Constant *OpC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op))
4437 Op = ConstantExpr::getSExt(OpC, IntPtrTy);
4438 else
4439 Op = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(new SExtInst(Op, IntPtrTy,
4440 Op->getName()+".c"), I);
4441 }
4442 if (Size != 1) {
4443 Constant *Scale = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size);
4444 if (Constant *OpC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op))
4445 Op = ConstantExpr::getMul(OpC, Scale);
4446 else // We'll let instcombine(mul) convert this to a shl if possible.
4447 Op = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createMul(Op, Scale,
4448 GEP->getName()+".idx"), I);
4449 }
4450
4451 // Emit an add instruction.
4452 if (isa<Constant>(Op) && isa<Constant>(Result))
4453 Result = ConstantExpr::getAdd(cast<Constant>(Op),
4454 cast<Constant>(Result));
4455 else
4456 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAdd(Op, Result,
4457 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004458 }
4459 return Result;
4460}
4461
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004462/// FoldGEPICmp - Fold comparisons between a GEP instruction and something
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004463/// else. At this point we know that the GEP is on the LHS of the comparison.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004464Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldGEPICmp(User *GEPLHS, Value *RHS,
4465 ICmpInst::Predicate Cond,
4466 Instruction &I) {
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004467 assert(dyn_castGetElementPtr(GEPLHS) && "LHS is not a getelementptr!");
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004468
4469 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(RHS))
4470 if (isa<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType()))
4471 RHS = CI->getOperand(0);
4472
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004473 Value *PtrBase = GEPLHS->getOperand(0);
4474 if (PtrBase == RHS) {
4475 // As an optimization, we don't actually have to compute the actual value of
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004476 // OFFSET if this is a icmp_eq or icmp_ne comparison, just return whether
4477 // each index is zero or not.
4478 if (Cond == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ || Cond == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE) {
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004479 Instruction *InVal = 0;
Chris Lattnerad5fec12005-01-28 19:32:01 +00004480 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEPLHS);
4481 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPLHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004482 bool EmitIt = true;
4483 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(GEPLHS->getOperand(i))) {
4484 if (isa<UndefValue>(C)) // undef index -> undef.
4485 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(I.getType()));
4486 if (C->isNullValue())
4487 EmitIt = false;
Chris Lattnerad5fec12005-01-28 19:32:01 +00004488 else if (TD->getTypeSize(GTI.getIndexedType()) == 0) {
4489 EmitIt = false; // This is indexing into a zero sized array?
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004490 } else if (isa<ConstantInt>(C))
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004491 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, // No comparison is needed here.
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00004492 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
4493 Cond == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE));
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004494 }
4495
4496 if (EmitIt) {
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004497 Instruction *Comp =
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004498 new ICmpInst(Cond, GEPLHS->getOperand(i),
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004499 Constant::getNullValue(GEPLHS->getOperand(i)->getType()));
4500 if (InVal == 0)
4501 InVal = Comp;
4502 else {
4503 InVal = InsertNewInstBefore(InVal, I);
4504 InsertNewInstBefore(Comp, I);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004505 if (Cond == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE) // True if any are unequal
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004506 InVal = BinaryOperator::createOr(InVal, Comp);
4507 else // True if all are equal
4508 InVal = BinaryOperator::createAnd(InVal, Comp);
4509 }
4510 }
4511 }
4512
4513 if (InVal)
4514 return InVal;
4515 else
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004516 // No comparison is needed here, all indexes = 0
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00004517 ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
4518 Cond == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ));
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004519 }
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004520
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004521 // Only lower this if the icmp is the only user of the GEP or if we expect
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004522 // the result to fold to a constant!
4523 if (isa<ConstantExpr>(GEPLHS) || GEPLHS->hasOneUse()) {
4524 // ((gep Ptr, OFFSET) cmp Ptr) ---> (OFFSET cmp 0).
4525 Value *Offset = EmitGEPOffset(GEPLHS, I, *this);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004526 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), Offset,
4527 Constant::getNullValue(Offset->getType()));
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004528 }
4529 } else if (User *GEPRHS = dyn_castGetElementPtr(RHS)) {
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00004530 // If the base pointers are different, but the indices are the same, just
4531 // compare the base pointer.
4532 if (PtrBase != GEPRHS->getOperand(0)) {
4533 bool IndicesTheSame = GEPLHS->getNumOperands()==GEPRHS->getNumOperands();
Jeff Cohen00b168892005-07-27 06:12:32 +00004534 IndicesTheSame &= GEPLHS->getOperand(0)->getType() ==
Chris Lattner93b94a62005-04-26 14:40:41 +00004535 GEPRHS->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00004536 if (IndicesTheSame)
4537 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPLHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
4538 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i) != GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) {
4539 IndicesTheSame = false;
4540 break;
4541 }
4542
4543 // If all indices are the same, just compare the base pointers.
4544 if (IndicesTheSame)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004545 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond),
4546 GEPLHS->getOperand(0), GEPRHS->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00004547
4548 // Otherwise, the base pointers are different and the indices are
4549 // different, bail out.
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004550 return 0;
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00004551 }
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004552
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004553 // If one of the GEPs has all zero indices, recurse.
4554 bool AllZeros = true;
4555 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPLHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
4556 if (!isa<Constant>(GEPLHS->getOperand(i)) ||
4557 !cast<Constant>(GEPLHS->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
4558 AllZeros = false;
4559 break;
4560 }
4561 if (AllZeros)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004562 return FoldGEPICmp(GEPRHS, GEPLHS->getOperand(0),
4563 ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Cond), I);
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004564
4565 // If the other GEP has all zero indices, recurse.
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004566 AllZeros = true;
4567 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPRHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
4568 if (!isa<Constant>(GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) ||
4569 !cast<Constant>(GEPRHS->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
4570 AllZeros = false;
4571 break;
4572 }
4573 if (AllZeros)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004574 return FoldGEPICmp(GEPLHS, GEPRHS->getOperand(0), Cond, I);
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004575
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004576 if (GEPLHS->getNumOperands() == GEPRHS->getNumOperands()) {
4577 // If the GEPs only differ by one index, compare it.
4578 unsigned NumDifferences = 0; // Keep track of # differences.
4579 unsigned DiffOperand = 0; // The operand that differs.
4580 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPRHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
4581 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i) != GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) {
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00004582 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() !=
4583 GEPRHS->getOperand(i)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) {
Chris Lattner45f57b82005-01-21 23:06:49 +00004584 // Irreconcilable differences.
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004585 NumDifferences = 2;
4586 break;
4587 } else {
4588 if (NumDifferences++) break;
4589 DiffOperand = i;
4590 }
4591 }
4592
4593 if (NumDifferences == 0) // SAME GEP?
4594 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, // No comparison is needed here.
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00004595 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
4596 Cond == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ));
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004597 else if (NumDifferences == 1) {
Chris Lattner45f57b82005-01-21 23:06:49 +00004598 Value *LHSV = GEPLHS->getOperand(DiffOperand);
4599 Value *RHSV = GEPRHS->getOperand(DiffOperand);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004600 // Make sure we do a signed comparison here.
4601 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), LHSV, RHSV);
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004602 }
4603 }
4604
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004605 // Only lower this if the icmp is the only user of the GEP or if we expect
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004606 // the result to fold to a constant!
4607 if ((isa<ConstantExpr>(GEPLHS) || GEPLHS->hasOneUse()) &&
4608 (isa<ConstantExpr>(GEPRHS) || GEPRHS->hasOneUse())) {
4609 // ((gep Ptr, OFFSET1) cmp (gep Ptr, OFFSET2) ---> (OFFSET1 cmp OFFSET2)
4610 Value *L = EmitGEPOffset(GEPLHS, I, *this);
4611 Value *R = EmitGEPOffset(GEPRHS, I, *this);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004612 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), L, R);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004613 }
4614 }
4615 return 0;
4616}
4617
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004618Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFCmpInst(FCmpInst &I) {
4619 bool Changed = SimplifyCompare(I);
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00004620 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004621
Chris Lattner58e97462007-01-14 19:42:17 +00004622 // Fold trivial predicates.
4623 if (I.getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE)
4624 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int1Ty));
4625 if (I.getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE)
4626 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
4627
4628 // Simplify 'fcmp pred X, X'
4629 if (Op0 == Op1) {
4630 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
4631 default: assert(0 && "Unknown predicate!");
4632 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ: // True if unordered or equal
4633 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE: // True if unordered, greater than, or equal
4634 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE: // True if unordered, less than, or equal
4635 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
4636 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT: // True if ordered and greater than
4637 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT: // True if ordered and less than
4638 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE: // True if ordered and operands are unequal
4639 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
4640
4641 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO: // True if unordered: isnan(X) | isnan(Y)
4642 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT: // True if unordered or less than
4643 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT: // True if unordered or greater than
4644 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE: // True if unordered or not equal
4645 // Canonicalize these to be 'fcmp uno %X, 0.0'.
4646 I.setPredicate(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO);
4647 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
4648 return &I;
4649
4650 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD: // True if ordered (no nans)
4651 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ: // True if ordered and equal
4652 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE: // True if ordered and greater than or equal
4653 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE: // True if ordered and less than or equal
4654 // Canonicalize these to be 'fcmp ord %X, 0.0'.
4655 I.setPredicate(FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD);
4656 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
4657 return &I;
4658 }
4659 }
4660
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004661 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // fcmp pred X, undef -> undef
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00004662 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(Type::Int1Ty));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004663
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004664 // Handle fcmp with constant RHS
4665 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
4666 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
4667 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
4668 case Instruction::PHI:
4669 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
4670 return NV;
4671 break;
4672 case Instruction::Select:
4673 // If either operand of the select is a constant, we can fold the
4674 // comparison into the select arms, which will cause one to be
4675 // constant folded and the select turned into a bitwise or.
4676 Value *Op1 = 0, *Op2 = 0;
4677 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
4678 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
4679 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
4680 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getCompare(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
4681 // Insert a new FCmp of the other select operand.
4682 Op2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new FCmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
4683 LHSI->getOperand(2), RHSC,
4684 I.getName()), I);
4685 } else if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(2))) {
4686 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
4687 Op2 = ConstantExpr::getCompare(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
4688 // Insert a new FCmp of the other select operand.
4689 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new FCmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
4690 LHSI->getOperand(1), RHSC,
4691 I.getName()), I);
4692 }
4693 }
4694
4695 if (Op1)
4696 return new SelectInst(LHSI->getOperand(0), Op1, Op2);
4697 break;
4698 }
4699 }
4700
4701 return Changed ? &I : 0;
4702}
4703
4704Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInst(ICmpInst &I) {
4705 bool Changed = SimplifyCompare(I);
4706 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
4707 const Type *Ty = Op0->getType();
4708
4709 // icmp X, X
4710 if (Op0 == Op1)
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00004711 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
4712 isTrueWhenEqual(I)));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004713
4714 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X icmp undef -> undef
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00004715 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(Type::Int1Ty));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004716
4717 // icmp of GlobalValues can never equal each other as long as they aren't
4718 // external weak linkage type.
4719 if (GlobalValue *GV0 = dyn_cast<GlobalValue>(Op0))
4720 if (GlobalValue *GV1 = dyn_cast<GlobalValue>(Op1))
4721 if (!GV0->hasExternalWeakLinkage() || !GV1->hasExternalWeakLinkage())
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00004722 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
4723 !isTrueWhenEqual(I)));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004724
4725 // icmp <global/alloca*/null>, <global/alloca*/null> - Global/Stack value
Chris Lattner711b3402004-11-14 07:33:16 +00004726 // addresses never equal each other! We already know that Op0 != Op1.
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004727 if ((isa<GlobalValue>(Op0) || isa<AllocaInst>(Op0) ||
4728 isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op0)) &&
4729 (isa<GlobalValue>(Op1) || isa<AllocaInst>(Op1) ||
Chris Lattner711b3402004-11-14 07:33:16 +00004730 isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op1)))
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00004731 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
4732 !isTrueWhenEqual(I)));
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00004733
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004734 // icmp's with boolean values can always be turned into bitwise operations
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00004735 if (Ty == Type::Int1Ty) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004736 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
4737 default: assert(0 && "Invalid icmp instruction!");
4738 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: { // icmp eq bool %A, %B -> ~(A^B)
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004739 Instruction *Xor = BinaryOperator::createXor(Op0, Op1, I.getName()+"tmp");
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00004740 InsertNewInstBefore(Xor, I);
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00004741 return BinaryOperator::createNot(Xor);
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00004742 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004743 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // icmp eq bool %A, %B -> A^B
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00004744 return BinaryOperator::createXor(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00004745
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004746 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
4747 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
4748 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp gt -> icmp lt
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00004749 // FALL THROUGH
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004750 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
4751 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: { // icmp lt bool A, B -> ~X & Y
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00004752 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::createNot(Op0, I.getName()+"tmp");
4753 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
4754 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Not, Op1);
4755 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004756 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
4757 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
4758 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp ge -> icmp le
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00004759 // FALL THROUGH
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004760 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
4761 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: { // icmp le bool %A, %B -> ~A | B
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00004762 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::createNot(Op0, I.getName()+"tmp");
4763 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
4764 return BinaryOperator::createOr(Not, Op1);
4765 }
4766 }
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00004767 }
4768
Chris Lattner2be51ae2004-06-09 04:24:29 +00004769 // See if we are doing a comparison between a constant and an instruction that
4770 // can be folded into the comparison.
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00004771 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004772 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
4773 default: break;
4774 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // A <u MIN -> FALSE
4775 if (CI->isMinValue(false))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004776 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004777 if (CI->isMaxValue(false)) // A <u MAX -> A != MAX
4778 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0,Op1);
4779 if (isMinValuePlusOne(CI,false)) // A <u MIN+1 -> A == MIN
4780 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, SubOne(CI));
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00004781 // (x <u 2147483648) -> (x >s -1) -> true if sign bit clear
4782 if (CI->isMinValue(true))
4783 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, Op0,
4784 ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(Op0->getType()));
4785
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004786 break;
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004787
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004788 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
4789 if (CI->isMinValue(true)) // A <s MIN -> FALSE
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004790 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004791 if (CI->isMaxValue(true)) // A <s MAX -> A != MAX
4792 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
4793 if (isMinValuePlusOne(CI,true)) // A <s MIN+1 -> A == MIN
4794 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, SubOne(CI));
4795 break;
4796
4797 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
4798 if (CI->isMaxValue(false)) // A >u MAX -> FALSE
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004799 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004800 if (CI->isMinValue(false)) // A >u MIN -> A != MIN
4801 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
4802 if (isMaxValueMinusOne(CI, false)) // A >u MAX-1 -> A == MAX
4803 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, AddOne(CI));
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00004804
4805 // (x >u 2147483647) -> (x <s 0) -> true if sign bit set
4806 if (CI->isMaxValue(true))
4807 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, Op0,
4808 ConstantInt::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004809 break;
4810
4811 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
4812 if (CI->isMaxValue(true)) // A >s MAX -> FALSE
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004813 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004814 if (CI->isMinValue(true)) // A >s MIN -> A != MIN
4815 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
4816 if (isMaxValueMinusOne(CI, true)) // A >s MAX-1 -> A == MAX
4817 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, AddOne(CI));
4818 break;
4819
4820 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
4821 if (CI->isMaxValue(false)) // A <=u MAX -> TRUE
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004822 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004823 if (CI->isMinValue(false)) // A <=u MIN -> A == MIN
4824 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, Op1);
4825 if (isMaxValueMinusOne(CI,false)) // A <=u MAX-1 -> A != MAX
4826 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, AddOne(CI));
4827 break;
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004828
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004829 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
4830 if (CI->isMaxValue(true)) // A <=s MAX -> TRUE
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004831 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004832 if (CI->isMinValue(true)) // A <=s MIN -> A == MIN
4833 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, Op1);
4834 if (isMaxValueMinusOne(CI,true)) // A <=s MAX-1 -> A != MAX
4835 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, AddOne(CI));
4836 break;
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004837
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004838 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
4839 if (CI->isMinValue(false)) // A >=u MIN -> TRUE
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004840 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004841 if (CI->isMaxValue(false)) // A >=u MAX -> A == MAX
4842 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, Op1);
4843 if (isMinValuePlusOne(CI,false)) // A >=u MIN-1 -> A != MIN
4844 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, SubOne(CI));
4845 break;
4846
4847 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
4848 if (CI->isMinValue(true)) // A >=s MIN -> TRUE
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004849 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004850 if (CI->isMaxValue(true)) // A >=s MAX -> A == MAX
4851 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, Op1);
4852 if (isMinValuePlusOne(CI,true)) // A >=s MIN-1 -> A != MIN
4853 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, SubOne(CI));
4854 break;
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004855 }
4856
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004857 // If we still have a icmp le or icmp ge instruction, turn it into the
4858 // appropriate icmp lt or icmp gt instruction. Since the border cases have
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004859 // already been handled above, this requires little checking.
4860 //
Reid Spencer2149a9d2007-03-25 19:55:33 +00004861 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00004862 default: break;
4863 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
4864 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Op0, AddOne(CI));
4865 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
4866 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, Op0, AddOne(CI));
4867 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
4868 return new ICmpInst( ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Op0, SubOne(CI));
4869 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
4870 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, Op0, SubOne(CI));
Reid Spencer2149a9d2007-03-25 19:55:33 +00004871 }
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +00004872
4873 // See if we can fold the comparison based on bits known to be zero or one
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00004874 // in the input. If this comparison is a normal comparison, it demands all
4875 // bits, if it is a sign bit comparison, it only demands the sign bit.
4876
4877 bool UnusedBit;
4878 bool isSignBit = isSignBitCheck(I.getPredicate(), CI, UnusedBit);
4879
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004880 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Ty)->getBitWidth();
4881 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00004882 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(Op0,
4883 isSignBit ? APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth)
4884 : APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +00004885 KnownZero, KnownOne, 0))
4886 return &I;
4887
4888 // Given the known and unknown bits, compute a range that the LHS could be
4889 // in.
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004890 if ((KnownOne | KnownZero) != 0) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004891 // Compute the Min, Max and RHS values based on the known bits. For the
4892 // EQ and NE we use unsigned values.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00004893 APInt Min(BitWidth, 0), Max(BitWidth, 0);
4894 const APInt& RHSVal = CI->getValue();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004895 if (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(I.getPredicate())) {
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004896 ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne, Min,
4897 Max);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004898 } else {
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004899 ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne, Min,
4900 Max);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004901 }
4902 switch (I.getPredicate()) { // LE/GE have been folded already.
4903 default: assert(0 && "Unknown icmp opcode!");
4904 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004905 if (Max.ult(RHSVal) || Min.ugt(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004906 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004907 break;
4908 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004909 if (Max.ult(RHSVal) || Min.ugt(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004910 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004911 break;
4912 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004913 if (Max.ult(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004914 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattner81973ef2007-04-09 23:52:13 +00004915 if (Min.uge(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004916 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004917 break;
4918 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004919 if (Min.ugt(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004920 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattner81973ef2007-04-09 23:52:13 +00004921 if (Max.ule(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004922 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004923 break;
4924 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004925 if (Max.slt(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004926 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004927 if (Min.sgt(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004928 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004929 break;
4930 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004931 if (Min.sgt(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004932 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattner81973ef2007-04-09 23:52:13 +00004933 if (Max.sle(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004934 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004935 break;
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +00004936 }
4937 }
4938
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004939 // Since the RHS is a ConstantInt (CI), if the left hand side is an
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00004940 // instruction, see if that instruction also has constants so that the
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004941 // instruction can be folded into the icmp
Chris Lattner3c6a0d42004-05-25 06:32:08 +00004942 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00004943 if (Instruction *Res = visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(I, LHSI, CI))
4944 return Res;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004945 }
4946
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00004947 // Handle icmp with constant (but not simple integer constant) RHS
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00004948 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
4949 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
4950 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattner9fb25db2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00004951 case Instruction::GetElementPtr:
4952 if (RHSC->isNullValue()) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004953 // icmp pred GEP (P, int 0, int 0, int 0), null -> icmp pred P, null
Chris Lattner9fb25db2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00004954 bool isAllZeros = true;
4955 for (unsigned i = 1, e = LHSI->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
4956 if (!isa<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(i)) ||
4957 !cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
4958 isAllZeros = false;
4959 break;
4960 }
4961 if (isAllZeros)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004962 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner9fb25db2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00004963 Constant::getNullValue(LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType()));
4964 }
4965 break;
4966
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00004967 case Instruction::PHI:
4968 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
4969 return NV;
4970 break;
Chris Lattner4802d902007-04-06 18:57:34 +00004971 case Instruction::Select: {
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00004972 // If either operand of the select is a constant, we can fold the
4973 // comparison into the select arms, which will cause one to be
4974 // constant folded and the select turned into a bitwise or.
4975 Value *Op1 = 0, *Op2 = 0;
4976 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
4977 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
4978 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004979 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getICmp(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
4980 // Insert a new ICmp of the other select operand.
4981 Op2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
4982 LHSI->getOperand(2), RHSC,
4983 I.getName()), I);
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00004984 } else if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(2))) {
4985 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004986 Op2 = ConstantExpr::getICmp(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
4987 // Insert a new ICmp of the other select operand.
4988 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
4989 LHSI->getOperand(1), RHSC,
4990 I.getName()), I);
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00004991 }
4992 }
Jeff Cohen9d809302005-04-23 21:38:35 +00004993
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00004994 if (Op1)
4995 return new SelectInst(LHSI->getOperand(0), Op1, Op2);
4996 break;
4997 }
Chris Lattner4802d902007-04-06 18:57:34 +00004998 case Instruction::Malloc:
4999 // If we have (malloc != null), and if the malloc has a single use, we
5000 // can assume it is successful and remove the malloc.
5001 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() && isa<ConstantPointerNull>(RHSC)) {
5002 AddToWorkList(LHSI);
5003 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
5004 !isTrueWhenEqual(I)));
5005 }
5006 break;
5007 }
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005008 }
5009
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005010 // If we can optimize a 'icmp GEP, P' or 'icmp P, GEP', do so now.
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005011 if (User *GEP = dyn_castGetElementPtr(Op0))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005012 if (Instruction *NI = FoldGEPICmp(GEP, Op1, I.getPredicate(), I))
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005013 return NI;
5014 if (User *GEP = dyn_castGetElementPtr(Op1))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005015 if (Instruction *NI = FoldGEPICmp(GEP, Op0,
5016 ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(I.getPredicate()), I))
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005017 return NI;
5018
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005019 // Test to see if the operands of the icmp are casted versions of other
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005020 // values. If the ptr->ptr cast can be stripped off both arguments, we do so
5021 // now.
5022 if (BitCastInst *CI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op0)) {
5023 if (isa<PointerType>(Op0->getType()) &&
5024 (isa<Constant>(Op1) || isa<BitCastInst>(Op1))) {
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005025 // We keep moving the cast from the left operand over to the right
5026 // operand, where it can often be eliminated completely.
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005027 Op0 = CI->getOperand(0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005028
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005029 // If operand #1 is a bitcast instruction, it must also be a ptr->ptr cast
5030 // so eliminate it as well.
5031 if (BitCastInst *CI2 = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op1))
5032 Op1 = CI2->getOperand(0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005033
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005034 // If Op1 is a constant, we can fold the cast into the constant.
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005035 if (Op0->getType() != Op1->getType())
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005036 if (Constant *Op1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00005037 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getBitCast(Op1C, Op0->getType());
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005038 } else {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005039 // Otherwise, cast the RHS right before the icmp
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00005040 Op1 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, Op1, Op0->getType(), I);
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005041 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005042 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005043 }
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005044 }
5045
5046 if (isa<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005047 // Handle the special case of: icmp (cast bool to X), <cst>
Chris Lattner68708052003-11-03 05:17:03 +00005048 // This comes up when you have code like
5049 // int X = A < B;
5050 // if (X) ...
5051 // For generality, we handle any zero-extension of any operand comparison
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005052 // with a constant or another cast from the same type.
5053 if (isa<ConstantInt>(Op1) || isa<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005054 if (Instruction *R = visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(I))
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005055 return R;
Chris Lattner68708052003-11-03 05:17:03 +00005056 }
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005057
Chris Lattner65b72ba2006-09-18 04:22:48 +00005058 if (I.isEquality()) {
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005059 Value *A, *B, *C, *D;
5060 if (match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
5061 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) { // (A^B) == A -> B == 0
5062 Value *OtherVal = A == Op1 ? B : A;
5063 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), OtherVal,
5064 Constant::getNullValue(A->getType()));
5065 }
5066
5067 if (match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
5068 // A^c1 == C^c2 --> A == C^(c1^c2)
5069 if (ConstantInt *C1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(B))
5070 if (ConstantInt *C2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(D))
5071 if (Op1->hasOneUse()) {
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00005072 Constant *NC = ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() ^ C2->getValue());
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005073 Instruction *Xor = BinaryOperator::createXor(C, NC, "tmp");
5074 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A,
5075 InsertNewInstBefore(Xor, I));
5076 }
5077
5078 // A^B == A^D -> B == D
5079 if (A == C) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B, D);
5080 if (A == D) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B, C);
5081 if (B == C) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, D);
5082 if (B == D) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, C);
5083 }
5084 }
5085
5086 if (match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
5087 (A == Op0 || B == Op0)) {
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005088 // A == (A^B) -> B == 0
5089 Value *OtherVal = A == Op0 ? B : A;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005090 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), OtherVal,
5091 Constant::getNullValue(A->getType()));
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005092 }
5093 if (match(Op0, m_Sub(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && A == Op1) {
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005094 // (A-B) == A -> B == 0
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005095 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B,
5096 Constant::getNullValue(B->getType()));
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005097 }
5098 if (match(Op1, m_Sub(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && A == Op0) {
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005099 // A == (A-B) -> B == 0
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005100 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B,
5101 Constant::getNullValue(B->getType()));
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005102 }
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00005103
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00005104 // (X&Z) == (Y&Z) -> (X^Y) & Z == 0
5105 if (Op0->hasOneUse() && Op1->hasOneUse() &&
5106 match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
5107 match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
5108 Value *X = 0, *Y = 0, *Z = 0;
5109
5110 if (A == C) {
5111 X = B; Y = D; Z = A;
5112 } else if (A == D) {
5113 X = B; Y = C; Z = A;
5114 } else if (B == C) {
5115 X = A; Y = D; Z = B;
5116 } else if (B == D) {
5117 X = A; Y = C; Z = B;
5118 }
5119
5120 if (X) { // Build (X^Y) & Z
5121 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createXor(X, Y, "tmp"), I);
5122 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op1, Z, "tmp"), I);
5123 I.setOperand(0, Op1);
5124 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op1->getType()));
5125 return &I;
5126 }
5127 }
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005128 }
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00005129 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005130}
5131
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005132
5133/// FoldICmpDivCst - Fold "icmp pred, ([su]div X, DivRHS), CmpRHS" where DivRHS
5134/// and CmpRHS are both known to be integer constants.
5135Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldICmpDivCst(ICmpInst &ICI, BinaryOperator *DivI,
5136 ConstantInt *DivRHS) {
5137 ConstantInt *CmpRHS = cast<ConstantInt>(ICI.getOperand(1));
5138 const APInt &CmpRHSV = CmpRHS->getValue();
5139
5140 // FIXME: If the operand types don't match the type of the divide
5141 // then don't attempt this transform. The code below doesn't have the
5142 // logic to deal with a signed divide and an unsigned compare (and
5143 // vice versa). This is because (x /s C1) <s C2 produces different
5144 // results than (x /s C1) <u C2 or (x /u C1) <s C2 or even
5145 // (x /u C1) <u C2. Simply casting the operands and result won't
5146 // work. :( The if statement below tests that condition and bails
5147 // if it finds it.
5148 bool DivIsSigned = DivI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv;
5149 if (!ICI.isEquality() && DivIsSigned != ICI.isSignedPredicate())
5150 return 0;
5151 if (DivRHS->isZero())
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005152 return 0; // The ProdOV computation fails on divide by zero.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005153
5154 // Compute Prod = CI * DivRHS. We are essentially solving an equation
5155 // of form X/C1=C2. We solve for X by multiplying C1 (DivRHS) and
5156 // C2 (CI). By solving for X we can turn this into a range check
5157 // instead of computing a divide.
5158 ConstantInt *Prod = Multiply(CmpRHS, DivRHS);
5159
5160 // Determine if the product overflows by seeing if the product is
5161 // not equal to the divide. Make sure we do the same kind of divide
5162 // as in the LHS instruction that we're folding.
5163 bool ProdOV = (DivIsSigned ? ConstantExpr::getSDiv(Prod, DivRHS) :
5164 ConstantExpr::getUDiv(Prod, DivRHS)) != CmpRHS;
5165
5166 // Get the ICmp opcode
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005167 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = ICI.getPredicate();
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005168
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005169 // Figure out the interval that is being checked. For example, a comparison
5170 // like "X /u 5 == 0" is really checking that X is in the interval [0, 5).
5171 // Compute this interval based on the constants involved and the signedness of
5172 // the compare/divide. This computes a half-open interval, keeping track of
5173 // whether either value in the interval overflows. After analysis each
5174 // overflow variable is set to 0 if it's corresponding bound variable is valid
5175 // -1 if overflowed off the bottom end, or +1 if overflowed off the top end.
5176 int LoOverflow = 0, HiOverflow = 0;
5177 ConstantInt *LoBound = 0, *HiBound = 0;
5178
5179
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005180 if (!DivIsSigned) { // udiv
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005181 // e.g. X/5 op 3 --> [15, 20)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005182 LoBound = Prod;
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005183 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV;
5184 if (!HiOverflow)
5185 HiOverflow = AddWithOverflow(HiBound, LoBound, DivRHS, false);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005186 } else if (DivRHS->getValue().isPositive()) { // Divisor is > 0.
5187 if (CmpRHSV == 0) { // (X / pos) op 0
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005188 // Can't overflow. e.g. X/2 op 0 --> [-1, 2)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005189 LoBound = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(SubOne(DivRHS)));
5190 HiBound = DivRHS;
5191 } else if (CmpRHSV.isPositive()) { // (X / pos) op pos
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005192 LoBound = Prod; // e.g. X/5 op 3 --> [15, 20)
5193 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV;
5194 if (!HiOverflow)
5195 HiOverflow = AddWithOverflow(HiBound, Prod, DivRHS, true);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005196 } else { // (X / pos) op neg
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005197 // e.g. X/5 op -3 --> [-15-4, -15+1) --> [-19, -14)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005198 Constant *DivRHSH = ConstantExpr::getNeg(SubOne(DivRHS));
5199 LoOverflow = AddWithOverflow(LoBound, Prod,
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005200 cast<ConstantInt>(DivRHSH), true) ? -1 : 0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005201 HiBound = AddOne(Prod);
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005202 HiOverflow = ProdOV ? -1 : 0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005203 }
5204 } else { // Divisor is < 0.
5205 if (CmpRHSV == 0) { // (X / neg) op 0
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005206 // e.g. X/-5 op 0 --> [-4, 5)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005207 LoBound = AddOne(DivRHS);
5208 HiBound = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(DivRHS));
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005209 if (HiBound == DivRHS) { // -INTMIN = INTMIN
5210 HiOverflow = 1; // [INTMIN+1, overflow)
5211 HiBound = 0; // e.g. X/INTMIN = 0 --> X > INTMIN
5212 }
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005213 } else if (CmpRHSV.isPositive()) { // (X / neg) op pos
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005214 // e.g. X/-5 op 3 --> [-19, -14)
5215 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV ? -1 : 0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005216 if (!LoOverflow)
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005217 LoOverflow = AddWithOverflow(LoBound, Prod, AddOne(DivRHS), true) ?-1:0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005218 HiBound = AddOne(Prod);
5219 } else { // (X / neg) op neg
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005220 // e.g. X/-5 op -3 --> [15, 20)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005221 LoBound = Prod;
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005222 LoOverflow = HiOverflow = ProdOV ? 1 : 0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005223 HiBound = Subtract(Prod, DivRHS);
5224 }
5225
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005226 // Dividing by a negative swaps the condition. LT <-> GT
5227 Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005228 }
5229
5230 Value *X = DivI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005231 switch (Pred) {
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005232 default: assert(0 && "Unhandled icmp opcode!");
5233 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
5234 if (LoOverflow && HiOverflow)
5235 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
5236 else if (HiOverflow)
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005237 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE :
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005238 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, LoBound);
5239 else if (LoOverflow)
5240 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT :
5241 ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, X, HiBound);
5242 else
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005243 return InsertRangeTest(X, LoBound, HiBound, DivIsSigned, true, ICI);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005244 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
5245 if (LoOverflow && HiOverflow)
5246 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5247 else if (HiOverflow)
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005248 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT :
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005249 ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, X, LoBound);
5250 else if (LoOverflow)
5251 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE :
5252 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, HiBound);
5253 else
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005254 return InsertRangeTest(X, LoBound, HiBound, DivIsSigned, false, ICI);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005255 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
5256 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005257 if (LoOverflow == +1) // Low bound is greater than input range.
5258 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5259 if (LoOverflow == -1) // Low bound is less than input range.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005260 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005261 return new ICmpInst(Pred, X, LoBound);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005262 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
5263 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005264 if (HiOverflow == +1) // High bound greater than input range.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005265 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005266 else if (HiOverflow == -1) // High bound less than input range.
5267 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5268 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005269 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, HiBound);
5270 else
5271 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, X, HiBound);
5272 }
5273}
5274
5275
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005276/// visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst - Handle "icmp (instr, intcst)".
5277///
5278Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(ICmpInst &ICI,
5279 Instruction *LHSI,
5280 ConstantInt *RHS) {
5281 const APInt &RHSV = RHS->getValue();
5282
5283 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
Duncan Sands0091bf22007-04-04 06:42:45 +00005284 case Instruction::Xor: // (icmp pred (xor X, XorCST), CI)
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005285 if (ConstantInt *XorCST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
5286 // If this is a comparison that tests the signbit (X < 0) or (x > -1),
5287 // fold the xor.
5288 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && RHSV == 0 ||
5289 ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT && RHSV.isAllOnesValue()) {
5290 Value *CompareVal = LHSI->getOperand(0);
5291
5292 // If the sign bit of the XorCST is not set, there is no change to
5293 // the operation, just stop using the Xor.
5294 if (!XorCST->getValue().isNegative()) {
5295 ICI.setOperand(0, CompareVal);
5296 AddToWorkList(LHSI);
5297 return &ICI;
5298 }
5299
5300 // Was the old condition true if the operand is positive?
5301 bool isTrueIfPositive = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
5302
5303 // If so, the new one isn't.
5304 isTrueIfPositive ^= true;
5305
5306 if (isTrueIfPositive)
5307 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, CompareVal, SubOne(RHS));
5308 else
5309 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, CompareVal, AddOne(RHS));
5310 }
5311 }
5312 break;
5313 case Instruction::And: // (icmp pred (and X, AndCST), RHS)
5314 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() && isa<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1)) &&
5315 LHSI->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
5316 ConstantInt *AndCST = cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
5317
5318 // If the LHS is an AND of a truncating cast, we can widen the
5319 // and/compare to be the input width without changing the value
5320 // produced, eliminating a cast.
5321 if (TruncInst *Cast = dyn_cast<TruncInst>(LHSI->getOperand(0))) {
5322 // We can do this transformation if either the AND constant does not
5323 // have its sign bit set or if it is an equality comparison.
5324 // Extending a relational comparison when we're checking the sign
5325 // bit would not work.
5326 if (Cast->hasOneUse() &&
5327 (ICI.isEquality() || AndCST->getValue().isPositive() &&
5328 RHSV.isPositive())) {
5329 uint32_t BitWidth =
5330 cast<IntegerType>(Cast->getOperand(0)->getType())->getBitWidth();
5331 APInt NewCST = AndCST->getValue();
5332 NewCST.zext(BitWidth);
5333 APInt NewCI = RHSV;
5334 NewCI.zext(BitWidth);
5335 Instruction *NewAnd =
5336 BinaryOperator::createAnd(Cast->getOperand(0),
5337 ConstantInt::get(NewCST),LHSI->getName());
5338 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, ICI);
5339 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NewAnd,
5340 ConstantInt::get(NewCI));
5341 }
5342 }
5343
5344 // If this is: (X >> C1) & C2 != C3 (where any shift and any compare
5345 // could exist), turn it into (X & (C2 << C1)) != (C3 << C1). This
5346 // happens a LOT in code produced by the C front-end, for bitfield
5347 // access.
5348 BinaryOperator *Shift = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI->getOperand(0));
5349 if (Shift && !Shift->isShift())
5350 Shift = 0;
5351
5352 ConstantInt *ShAmt;
5353 ShAmt = Shift ? dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Shift->getOperand(1)) : 0;
5354 const Type *Ty = Shift ? Shift->getType() : 0; // Type of the shift.
5355 const Type *AndTy = AndCST->getType(); // Type of the and.
5356
5357 // We can fold this as long as we can't shift unknown bits
5358 // into the mask. This can only happen with signed shift
5359 // rights, as they sign-extend.
5360 if (ShAmt) {
5361 bool CanFold = Shift->isLogicalShift();
5362 if (!CanFold) {
5363 // To test for the bad case of the signed shr, see if any
5364 // of the bits shifted in could be tested after the mask.
5365 uint32_t TyBits = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
5366 int ShAmtVal = TyBits - ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TyBits);
5367
5368 uint32_t BitWidth = AndTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
5369 if ((APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-ShAmtVal) &
5370 AndCST->getValue()) == 0)
5371 CanFold = true;
5372 }
5373
5374 if (CanFold) {
5375 Constant *NewCst;
5376 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
5377 NewCst = ConstantExpr::getLShr(RHS, ShAmt);
5378 else
5379 NewCst = ConstantExpr::getShl(RHS, ShAmt);
5380
5381 // Check to see if we are shifting out any of the bits being
5382 // compared.
5383 if (ConstantExpr::get(Shift->getOpcode(), NewCst, ShAmt) != RHS) {
5384 // If we shifted bits out, the fold is not going to work out.
5385 // As a special case, check to see if this means that the
5386 // result is always true or false now.
5387 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
5388 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
5389 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
5390 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5391 } else {
5392 ICI.setOperand(1, NewCst);
5393 Constant *NewAndCST;
5394 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
5395 NewAndCST = ConstantExpr::getLShr(AndCST, ShAmt);
5396 else
5397 NewAndCST = ConstantExpr::getShl(AndCST, ShAmt);
5398 LHSI->setOperand(1, NewAndCST);
5399 LHSI->setOperand(0, Shift->getOperand(0));
5400 AddToWorkList(Shift); // Shift is dead.
5401 AddUsesToWorkList(ICI);
5402 return &ICI;
5403 }
5404 }
5405 }
5406
5407 // Turn ((X >> Y) & C) == 0 into (X & (C << Y)) == 0. The later is
5408 // preferable because it allows the C<<Y expression to be hoisted out
5409 // of a loop if Y is invariant and X is not.
5410 if (Shift && Shift->hasOneUse() && RHSV == 0 &&
5411 ICI.isEquality() && !Shift->isArithmeticShift() &&
5412 isa<Instruction>(Shift->getOperand(0))) {
5413 // Compute C << Y.
5414 Value *NS;
5415 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
5416 NS = BinaryOperator::createShl(AndCST,
5417 Shift->getOperand(1), "tmp");
5418 } else {
5419 // Insert a logical shift.
5420 NS = BinaryOperator::createLShr(AndCST,
5421 Shift->getOperand(1), "tmp");
5422 }
5423 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(NS), ICI);
5424
5425 // Compute X & (C << Y).
5426 Instruction *NewAnd =
5427 BinaryOperator::createAnd(Shift->getOperand(0), NS, LHSI->getName());
5428 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, ICI);
5429
5430 ICI.setOperand(0, NewAnd);
5431 return &ICI;
5432 }
5433 }
5434 break;
5435
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005436 case Instruction::Shl: { // (icmp pred (shl X, ShAmt), CI)
5437 ConstantInt *ShAmt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
5438 if (!ShAmt) break;
5439
5440 uint32_t TypeBits = RHSV.getBitWidth();
5441
5442 // Check that the shift amount is in range. If not, don't perform
5443 // undefined shifts. When the shift is visited it will be
5444 // simplified.
5445 if (ShAmt->uge(TypeBits))
5446 break;
5447
5448 if (ICI.isEquality()) {
5449 // If we are comparing against bits always shifted out, the
5450 // comparison cannot succeed.
5451 Constant *Comp =
5452 ConstantExpr::getShl(ConstantExpr::getLShr(RHS, ShAmt), ShAmt);
5453 if (Comp != RHS) {// Comparing against a bit that we know is zero.
5454 bool IsICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
5455 Constant *Cst = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, IsICMP_NE);
5456 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Cst);
5457 }
5458
5459 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
5460 // Otherwise strength reduce the shift into an and.
5461 uint32_t ShAmtVal = (uint32_t)ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
5462 Constant *Mask =
5463 ConstantInt::get(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-ShAmtVal));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005464
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005465 Instruction *AndI =
5466 BinaryOperator::createAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
5467 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
5468 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, ICI);
5469 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), And,
5470 ConstantInt::get(RHSV.lshr(ShAmtVal)));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005471 }
5472 }
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005473
5474 // Otherwise, if this is a comparison of the sign bit, simplify to and/test.
5475 bool TrueIfSigned = false;
5476 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() &&
5477 isSignBitCheck(ICI.getPredicate(), RHS, TrueIfSigned)) {
5478 // (X << 31) <s 0 --> (X&1) != 0
5479 Constant *Mask = ConstantInt::get(APInt(TypeBits, 1) <<
5480 (TypeBits-ShAmt->getZExtValue()-1));
5481 Instruction *AndI =
5482 BinaryOperator::createAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
5483 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
5484 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, ICI);
5485
5486 return new ICmpInst(TrueIfSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_NE : ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ,
5487 And, Constant::getNullValue(And->getType()));
5488 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005489 break;
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005490 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005491
5492 case Instruction::LShr: // (icmp pred (shr X, ShAmt), CI)
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005493 case Instruction::AShr: {
5494 ConstantInt *ShAmt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
5495 if (!ShAmt) break;
5496
5497 if (ICI.isEquality()) {
5498 // Check that the shift amount is in range. If not, don't perform
5499 // undefined shifts. When the shift is visited it will be
5500 // simplified.
5501 uint32_t TypeBits = RHSV.getBitWidth();
5502 if (ShAmt->uge(TypeBits))
5503 break;
5504 uint32_t ShAmtVal = (uint32_t)ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
5505
5506 // If we are comparing against bits always shifted out, the
5507 // comparison cannot succeed.
5508 APInt Comp = RHSV << ShAmtVal;
5509 if (LHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr)
5510 Comp = Comp.lshr(ShAmtVal);
5511 else
5512 Comp = Comp.ashr(ShAmtVal);
5513
5514 if (Comp != RHSV) { // Comparing against a bit that we know is zero.
5515 bool IsICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
5516 Constant *Cst = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, IsICMP_NE);
5517 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Cst);
5518 }
5519
5520 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() || RHSV == 0) {
5521 // Otherwise strength reduce the shift into an and.
5522 APInt Val(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShAmtVal));
5523 Constant *Mask = ConstantInt::get(Val);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005524
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005525 Instruction *AndI =
5526 BinaryOperator::createAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
5527 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
5528 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, ICI);
5529 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), And,
5530 ConstantExpr::getShl(RHS, ShAmt));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005531 }
5532 }
5533 break;
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005534 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005535
5536 case Instruction::SDiv:
5537 case Instruction::UDiv:
5538 // Fold: icmp pred ([us]div X, C1), C2 -> range test
5539 // Fold this div into the comparison, producing a range check.
5540 // Determine, based on the divide type, what the range is being
5541 // checked. If there is an overflow on the low or high side, remember
5542 // it, otherwise compute the range [low, hi) bounding the new value.
5543 // See: InsertRangeTest above for the kinds of replacements possible.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005544 if (ConstantInt *DivRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1)))
5545 if (Instruction *R = FoldICmpDivCst(ICI, cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI),
5546 DivRHS))
5547 return R;
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005548 break;
5549 }
5550
5551 // Simplify icmp_eq and icmp_ne instructions with integer constant RHS.
5552 if (ICI.isEquality()) {
5553 bool isICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
5554
5555 // If the first operand is (add|sub|and|or|xor|rem) with a constant, and
5556 // the second operand is a constant, simplify a bit.
5557 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI)) {
5558 switch (BO->getOpcode()) {
5559 case Instruction::SRem:
5560 // If we have a signed (X % (2^c)) == 0, turn it into an unsigned one.
5561 if (RHSV == 0 && isa<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1)) &&BO->hasOneUse()){
5562 const APInt &V = cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))->getValue();
5563 if (V.sgt(APInt(V.getBitWidth(), 1)) && V.isPowerOf2()) {
5564 Instruction *NewRem =
5565 BinaryOperator::createURem(BO->getOperand(0), BO->getOperand(1),
5566 BO->getName());
5567 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRem, ICI);
5568 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NewRem,
5569 Constant::getNullValue(BO->getType()));
5570 }
5571 }
5572 break;
5573 case Instruction::Add:
5574 // Replace ((add A, B) != C) with (A != C-B) if B & C are constants.
5575 if (ConstantInt *BOp1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
5576 if (BO->hasOneUse())
5577 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
5578 Subtract(RHS, BOp1C));
5579 } else if (RHSV == 0) {
5580 // Replace ((add A, B) != 0) with (A != -B) if A or B is
5581 // efficiently invertible, or if the add has just this one use.
5582 Value *BOp0 = BO->getOperand(0), *BOp1 = BO->getOperand(1);
5583
5584 if (Value *NegVal = dyn_castNegVal(BOp1))
5585 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BOp0, NegVal);
5586 else if (Value *NegVal = dyn_castNegVal(BOp0))
5587 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NegVal, BOp1);
5588 else if (BO->hasOneUse()) {
5589 Instruction *Neg = BinaryOperator::createNeg(BOp1);
5590 InsertNewInstBefore(Neg, ICI);
5591 Neg->takeName(BO);
5592 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BOp0, Neg);
5593 }
5594 }
5595 break;
5596 case Instruction::Xor:
5597 // For the xor case, we can xor two constants together, eliminating
5598 // the explicit xor.
5599 if (Constant *BOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1)))
5600 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
5601 ConstantExpr::getXor(RHS, BOC));
5602
5603 // FALLTHROUGH
5604 case Instruction::Sub:
5605 // Replace (([sub|xor] A, B) != 0) with (A != B)
5606 if (RHSV == 0)
5607 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
5608 BO->getOperand(1));
5609 break;
5610
5611 case Instruction::Or:
5612 // If bits are being or'd in that are not present in the constant we
5613 // are comparing against, then the comparison could never succeed!
5614 if (Constant *BOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
5615 Constant *NotCI = ConstantExpr::getNot(RHS);
5616 if (!ConstantExpr::getAnd(BOC, NotCI)->isNullValue())
5617 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
5618 isICMP_NE));
5619 }
5620 break;
5621
5622 case Instruction::And:
5623 if (ConstantInt *BOC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
5624 // If bits are being compared against that are and'd out, then the
5625 // comparison can never succeed!
5626 if ((RHSV & ~BOC->getValue()) != 0)
5627 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
5628 isICMP_NE));
5629
5630 // If we have ((X & C) == C), turn it into ((X & C) != 0).
5631 if (RHS == BOC && RHSV.isPowerOf2())
5632 return new ICmpInst(isICMP_NE ? ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ :
5633 ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, LHSI,
5634 Constant::getNullValue(RHS->getType()));
5635
5636 // Replace (and X, (1 << size(X)-1) != 0) with x s< 0
5637 if (isSignBit(BOC)) {
5638 Value *X = BO->getOperand(0);
5639 Constant *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(X->getType());
5640 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = isICMP_NE ?
5641 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT : ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE;
5642 return new ICmpInst(pred, X, Zero);
5643 }
5644
5645 // ((X & ~7) == 0) --> X < 8
5646 if (RHSV == 0 && isHighOnes(BOC)) {
5647 Value *X = BO->getOperand(0);
5648 Constant *NegX = ConstantExpr::getNeg(BOC);
5649 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = isICMP_NE ?
5650 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE : ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT;
5651 return new ICmpInst(pred, X, NegX);
5652 }
5653 }
5654 default: break;
5655 }
5656 } else if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(LHSI)) {
5657 // Handle icmp {eq|ne} <intrinsic>, intcst.
5658 if (II->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::bswap) {
5659 AddToWorkList(II);
5660 ICI.setOperand(0, II->getOperand(1));
5661 ICI.setOperand(1, ConstantInt::get(RHSV.byteSwap()));
5662 return &ICI;
5663 }
5664 }
5665 } else { // Not a ICMP_EQ/ICMP_NE
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +00005666 // If the LHS is a cast from an integral value of the same size,
5667 // then since we know the RHS is a constant, try to simlify.
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005668 if (CastInst *Cast = dyn_cast<CastInst>(LHSI)) {
5669 Value *CastOp = Cast->getOperand(0);
5670 const Type *SrcTy = CastOp->getType();
5671 uint32_t SrcTySize = SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
5672 if (SrcTy->isInteger() &&
5673 SrcTySize == Cast->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) {
5674 // If this is an unsigned comparison, try to make the comparison use
5675 // smaller constant values.
5676 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT && RHSV.isSignBit()) {
5677 // X u< 128 => X s> -1
5678 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, CastOp,
5679 ConstantInt::get(APInt::getAllOnesValue(SrcTySize)));
5680 } else if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT &&
5681 RHSV == APInt::getSignedMaxValue(SrcTySize)) {
5682 // X u> 127 => X s< 0
5683 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, CastOp,
5684 Constant::getNullValue(SrcTy));
5685 }
5686 }
5687 }
5688 }
5689 return 0;
5690}
5691
5692/// visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast - Handle icmp (cast x to y), (cast/cst).
5693/// We only handle extending casts so far.
5694///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005695Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(ICmpInst &ICI) {
5696 const CastInst *LHSCI = cast<CastInst>(ICI.getOperand(0));
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00005697 Value *LHSCIOp = LHSCI->getOperand(0);
5698 const Type *SrcTy = LHSCIOp->getType();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005699 const Type *DestTy = LHSCI->getType();
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005700 Value *RHSCIOp;
5701
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00005702 // Turn icmp (ptrtoint x), (ptrtoint/c) into a compare of the input if the
5703 // integer type is the same size as the pointer type.
5704 if (LHSCI->getOpcode() == Instruction::PtrToInt &&
5705 getTargetData().getPointerSizeInBits() ==
5706 cast<IntegerType>(DestTy)->getBitWidth()) {
5707 Value *RHSOp = 0;
5708 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner6f6f5122007-05-06 07:24:03 +00005709 RHSOp = ConstantExpr::getIntToPtr(RHSC, SrcTy);
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00005710 } else if (PtrToIntInst *RHSC = dyn_cast<PtrToIntInst>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
5711 RHSOp = RHSC->getOperand(0);
5712 // If the pointer types don't match, insert a bitcast.
5713 if (LHSCIOp->getType() != RHSOp->getType())
5714 RHSOp = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, RHSOp,
5715 LHSCIOp->getType(), ICI);
5716 }
5717
5718 if (RHSOp)
5719 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSOp);
5720 }
5721
5722 // The code below only handles extension cast instructions, so far.
5723 // Enforce this.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005724 if (LHSCI->getOpcode() != Instruction::ZExt &&
5725 LHSCI->getOpcode() != Instruction::SExt)
Chris Lattnerb352fa52005-01-17 03:20:02 +00005726 return 0;
5727
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005728 bool isSignedExt = LHSCI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt;
5729 bool isSignedCmp = ICI.isSignedPredicate();
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005730
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005731 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005732 // Not an extension from the same type?
5733 RHSCIOp = CI->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005734 if (RHSCIOp->getType() != LHSCIOp->getType())
5735 return 0;
Chris Lattnera5c5e772007-01-13 23:11:38 +00005736
5737 // If the signedness of the two compares doesn't agree (i.e. one is a sext
5738 // and the other is a zext), then we can't handle this.
5739 if (CI->getOpcode() != LHSCI->getOpcode())
5740 return 0;
5741
5742 // Likewise, if the signedness of the [sz]exts and the compare don't match,
5743 // then we can't handle this.
5744 if (isSignedExt != isSignedCmp && !ICI.isEquality())
5745 return 0;
5746
5747 // Okay, just insert a compare of the reduced operands now!
5748 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSCIOp);
Reid Spencer6731d5c2004-11-28 21:31:15 +00005749 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005750
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005751 // If we aren't dealing with a constant on the RHS, exit early
5752 ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ICI.getOperand(1));
5753 if (!CI)
5754 return 0;
5755
5756 // Compute the constant that would happen if we truncated to SrcTy then
5757 // reextended to DestTy.
5758 Constant *Res1 = ConstantExpr::getTrunc(CI, SrcTy);
5759 Constant *Res2 = ConstantExpr::getCast(LHSCI->getOpcode(), Res1, DestTy);
5760
5761 // If the re-extended constant didn't change...
5762 if (Res2 == CI) {
5763 // Make sure that sign of the Cmp and the sign of the Cast are the same.
5764 // For example, we might have:
5765 // %A = sext short %X to uint
5766 // %B = icmp ugt uint %A, 1330
5767 // It is incorrect to transform this into
5768 // %B = icmp ugt short %X, 1330
5769 // because %A may have negative value.
5770 //
5771 // However, it is OK if SrcTy is bool (See cast-set.ll testcase)
5772 // OR operation is EQ/NE.
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00005773 if (isSignedExt == isSignedCmp || SrcTy == Type::Int1Ty || ICI.isEquality())
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005774 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, Res1);
5775 else
5776 return 0;
5777 }
5778
5779 // The re-extended constant changed so the constant cannot be represented
5780 // in the shorter type. Consequently, we cannot emit a simple comparison.
5781
5782 // First, handle some easy cases. We know the result cannot be equal at this
5783 // point so handle the ICI.isEquality() cases
5784 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005785 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005786 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005787 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005788
5789 // Evaluate the comparison for LT (we invert for GT below). LE and GE cases
5790 // should have been folded away previously and not enter in here.
5791 Value *Result;
5792 if (isSignedCmp) {
5793 // We're performing a signed comparison.
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00005794 if (cast<ConstantInt>(CI)->getValue().isNegative())
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005795 Result = ConstantInt::getFalse(); // X < (small) --> false
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005796 else
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005797 Result = ConstantInt::getTrue(); // X < (large) --> true
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005798 } else {
5799 // We're performing an unsigned comparison.
5800 if (isSignedExt) {
5801 // We're performing an unsigned comp with a sign extended value.
5802 // This is true if the input is >= 0. [aka >s -1]
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005803 Constant *NegOne = ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(SrcTy);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005804 Result = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, LHSCIOp,
5805 NegOne, ICI.getName()), ICI);
5806 } else {
5807 // Unsigned extend & unsigned compare -> always true.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005808 Result = ConstantInt::getTrue();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005809 }
5810 }
5811
5812 // Finally, return the value computed.
5813 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT ||
5814 ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT) {
5815 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Result);
5816 } else {
5817 assert((ICI.getPredicate()==ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT ||
5818 ICI.getPredicate()==ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT) &&
5819 "ICmp should be folded!");
5820 if (Constant *CI = dyn_cast<Constant>(Result))
5821 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantExpr::getNot(CI));
5822 else
5823 return BinaryOperator::createNot(Result);
5824 }
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005825}
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005826
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00005827Instruction *InstCombiner::visitShl(BinaryOperator &I) {
5828 return commonShiftTransforms(I);
5829}
5830
5831Instruction *InstCombiner::visitLShr(BinaryOperator &I) {
5832 return commonShiftTransforms(I);
5833}
5834
5835Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAShr(BinaryOperator &I) {
5836 return commonShiftTransforms(I);
5837}
5838
5839Instruction *InstCombiner::commonShiftTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
5840 assert(I.getOperand(1)->getType() == I.getOperand(0)->getType());
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00005841 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005842
5843 // shl X, 0 == X and shr X, 0 == X
5844 // shl 0, X == 0 and shr 0, X == 0
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00005845 if (Op1 == Constant::getNullValue(Op1->getType()) ||
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00005846 Op0 == Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()))
5847 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00005848
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005849 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) {
5850 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) // undef >>s X -> undef
Chris Lattner79a564c2004-10-16 23:28:04 +00005851 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005852 else // undef << X -> 0, undef >>u X -> 0
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00005853 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
5854 }
5855 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005856 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) // X >>s undef -> X
5857 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
5858 else // X << undef, X >>u undef -> 0
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00005859 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00005860 }
5861
Chris Lattnerde2b6602006-11-10 23:38:52 +00005862 // ashr int -1, X = -1 (for any arithmetic shift rights of ~0)
5863 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr)
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00005864 if (ConstantInt *CSI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
Chris Lattnerde2b6602006-11-10 23:38:52 +00005865 if (CSI->isAllOnesValue())
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +00005866 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, CSI);
5867
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00005868 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
5869 if (isa<Constant>(Op0))
5870 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00005871 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00005872 return R;
5873
Chris Lattner120347e2005-05-08 17:34:56 +00005874 // See if we can turn a signed shr into an unsigned shr.
Chris Lattner65b72ba2006-09-18 04:22:48 +00005875 if (I.isArithmeticShift()) {
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00005876 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0,
5877 APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()))) {
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00005878 return BinaryOperator::createLShr(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
Chris Lattner120347e2005-05-08 17:34:56 +00005879 }
5880 }
Jeff Cohen00b168892005-07-27 06:12:32 +00005881
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00005882 if (ConstantInt *CUI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1))
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00005883 if (Instruction *Res = FoldShiftByConstant(Op0, CUI, I))
5884 return Res;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005885 return 0;
5886}
5887
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00005888Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldShiftByConstant(Value *Op0, ConstantInt *Op1,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00005889 BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005890 bool isLeftShift = I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005891
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00005892 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
5893 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00005894 uint32_t TypeBits = Op0->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
5895 APInt KnownZero(TypeBits, 0), KnownOne(TypeBits, 0);
5896 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(TypeBits),
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00005897 KnownZero, KnownOne))
5898 return &I;
5899
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005900 // shl uint X, 32 = 0 and shr ubyte Y, 9 = 0, ... just don't eliminate shr
5901 // of a signed value.
5902 //
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00005903 if (Op1->uge(TypeBits)) {
Chris Lattner0737c242007-02-02 05:29:55 +00005904 if (I.getOpcode() != Instruction::AShr)
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005905 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
5906 else {
Chris Lattner0737c242007-02-02 05:29:55 +00005907 I.setOperand(1, ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), TypeBits-1));
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005908 return &I;
Chris Lattner8adac752004-02-23 20:30:06 +00005909 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005910 }
5911
5912 // ((X*C1) << C2) == (X * (C1 << C2))
5913 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
5914 if (BO->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul && isLeftShift)
5915 if (Constant *BOOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1)))
5916 return BinaryOperator::createMul(BO->getOperand(0),
5917 ConstantExpr::getShl(BOOp, Op1));
5918
5919 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
5920 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
5921 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
5922 return R;
5923 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
5924 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
5925 return NV;
5926
5927 if (Op0->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005928 if (BinaryOperator *Op0BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
5929 // Turn ((X >> C) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
5930 Value *V1, *V2;
5931 ConstantInt *CC;
5932 switch (Op0BO->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00005933 default: break;
5934 case Instruction::Add:
5935 case Instruction::And:
5936 case Instruction::Or:
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00005937 case Instruction::Xor: {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00005938 // These operators commute.
5939 // Turn (Y + (X >> C)) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005940 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(1)->hasOneUse() &&
5941 match(Op0BO->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005942 m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_ConstantInt(CC))) && CC == Op1) {
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00005943 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::createShl(
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005944 Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1,
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005945 Op0BO->getName());
5946 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00005947 Instruction *X =
5948 BinaryOperator::create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), YS, V1,
5949 Op0BO->getOperand(1)->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005950 InsertNewInstBefore(X, I); // (X + (Y << C))
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00005951 uint32_t Op1Val = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Zhou Sheng90b96812007-03-30 05:45:18 +00005952 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(
5953 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-Op1Val)));
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005954 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005955
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005956 // Turn (Y + ((X >> C) & CC)) << C -> ((X & (CC << C)) + (Y << C))
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00005957 Value *Op0BOOp1 = Op0BO->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3c698492007-03-05 00:11:19 +00005958 if (isLeftShift && Op0BOOp1->hasOneUse() &&
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00005959 match(Op0BOOp1,
5960 m_And(m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)),m_ConstantInt(CC))) &&
Chris Lattner3c698492007-03-05 00:11:19 +00005961 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0BOOp1)->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
5962 V2 == Op1) {
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00005963 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::createShl(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00005964 Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1,
5965 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005966 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
5967 Instruction *XM =
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005968 BinaryOperator::createAnd(V1, ConstantExpr::getShl(CC, Op1),
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005969 V1->getName()+".mask");
5970 InsertNewInstBefore(XM, I); // X & (CC << C)
5971
5972 return BinaryOperator::create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), YS, XM);
5973 }
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00005974 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005975
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00005976 // FALL THROUGH.
5977 case Instruction::Sub: {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00005978 // Turn ((X >> C) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005979 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
5980 match(Op0BO->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005981 m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_ConstantInt(CC))) && CC == Op1) {
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00005982 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::createShl(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00005983 Op0BO->getOperand(1), Op1,
5984 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005985 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00005986 Instruction *X =
Chris Lattner13d4ab42006-05-31 21:14:00 +00005987 BinaryOperator::create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), V1, YS,
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00005988 Op0BO->getOperand(0)->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005989 InsertNewInstBefore(X, I); // (X + (Y << C))
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00005990 uint32_t Op1Val = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Zhou Sheng90b96812007-03-30 05:45:18 +00005991 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(
5992 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-Op1Val)));
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005993 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005994
Chris Lattner13d4ab42006-05-31 21:14:00 +00005995 // Turn (((X >> C)&CC) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (CC << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005996 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
5997 match(Op0BO->getOperand(0),
5998 m_And(m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)),
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005999 m_ConstantInt(CC))) && V2 == Op1 &&
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00006000 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0BO->getOperand(0))
6001 ->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00006002 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::createShl(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006003 Op0BO->getOperand(1), Op1,
6004 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006005 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
6006 Instruction *XM =
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006007 BinaryOperator::createAnd(V1, ConstantExpr::getShl(CC, Op1),
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006008 V1->getName()+".mask");
6009 InsertNewInstBefore(XM, I); // X & (CC << C)
6010
Chris Lattner13d4ab42006-05-31 21:14:00 +00006011 return BinaryOperator::create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), XM, YS);
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006012 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006013
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00006014 break;
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006015 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006016 }
6017
6018
6019 // If the operand is an bitwise operator with a constant RHS, and the
6020 // shift is the only use, we can pull it out of the shift.
6021 if (ConstantInt *Op0C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0BO->getOperand(1))) {
6022 bool isValid = true; // Valid only for And, Or, Xor
6023 bool highBitSet = false; // Transform if high bit of constant set?
6024
6025 switch (Op0BO->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +00006026 default: isValid = false; break; // Do not perform transform!
Chris Lattner1f7e1602004-10-08 03:46:20 +00006027 case Instruction::Add:
6028 isValid = isLeftShift;
6029 break;
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +00006030 case Instruction::Or:
6031 case Instruction::Xor:
6032 highBitSet = false;
6033 break;
6034 case Instruction::And:
6035 highBitSet = true;
6036 break;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006037 }
6038
6039 // If this is a signed shift right, and the high bit is modified
6040 // by the logical operation, do not perform the transformation.
6041 // The highBitSet boolean indicates the value of the high bit of
6042 // the constant which would cause it to be modified for this
6043 // operation.
6044 //
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006045 if (isValid && !isLeftShift && I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) {
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00006046 isValid = Op0C->getValue()[TypeBits-1] == highBitSet;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006047 }
6048
6049 if (isValid) {
6050 Constant *NewRHS = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), Op0C, Op1);
6051
6052 Instruction *NewShift =
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00006053 BinaryOperator::create(I.getOpcode(), Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1);
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006054 InsertNewInstBefore(NewShift, I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00006055 NewShift->takeName(Op0BO);
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006056
6057 return BinaryOperator::create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), NewShift,
6058 NewRHS);
6059 }
6060 }
6061 }
6062 }
6063
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006064 // Find out if this is a shift of a shift by a constant.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006065 BinaryOperator *ShiftOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0);
6066 if (ShiftOp && !ShiftOp->isShift())
6067 ShiftOp = 0;
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006068
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006069 if (ShiftOp && isa<ConstantInt>(ShiftOp->getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006070 ConstantInt *ShiftAmt1C = cast<ConstantInt>(ShiftOp->getOperand(1));
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00006071 uint32_t ShiftAmt1 = ShiftAmt1C->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
6072 uint32_t ShiftAmt2 = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006073 assert(ShiftAmt2 != 0 && "Should have been simplified earlier");
6074 if (ShiftAmt1 == 0) return 0; // Will be simplified in the future.
6075 Value *X = ShiftOp->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006076
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00006077 uint32_t AmtSum = ShiftAmt1+ShiftAmt2; // Fold into one big shift.
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00006078 if (AmtSum > TypeBits)
6079 AmtSum = TypeBits;
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006080
6081 const IntegerType *Ty = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType());
6082
6083 // Check for (X << c1) << c2 and (X >> c1) >> c2
Chris Lattner7f3da2d2007-02-03 23:28:07 +00006084 if (I.getOpcode() == ShiftOp->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006085 return BinaryOperator::create(I.getOpcode(), X,
6086 ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
6087 } else if (ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr &&
6088 I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) {
6089 // ((X >>u C1) >>s C2) -> (X >>u (C1+C2)) since C1 != 0.
6090 return BinaryOperator::createLShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
6091 } else if (ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr &&
6092 I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
6093 // ((X >>s C1) >>u C2) -> ((X >>s (C1+C2)) & mask) since C1 != 0.
6094 Instruction *Shift =
6095 BinaryOperator::createAShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
6096 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
6097
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00006098 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00006099 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006100 }
6101
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006102 // Okay, if we get here, one shift must be left, and the other shift must be
6103 // right. See if the amounts are equal.
6104 if (ShiftAmt1 == ShiftAmt2) {
6105 // If we have ((X >>? C) << C), turn this into X & (-1 << C).
6106 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00006107 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt1));
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00006108 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006109 }
6110 // If we have ((X << C) >>u C), turn this into X & (-1 >>u C).
6111 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00006112 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt1));
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00006113 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006114 }
6115 // We can simplify ((X << C) >>s C) into a trunc + sext.
6116 // NOTE: we could do this for any C, but that would make 'unusual' integer
6117 // types. For now, just stick to ones well-supported by the code
6118 // generators.
6119 const Type *SExtType = 0;
6120 switch (Ty->getBitWidth() - ShiftAmt1) {
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00006121 case 1 :
6122 case 8 :
6123 case 16 :
6124 case 32 :
6125 case 64 :
6126 case 128:
6127 SExtType = IntegerType::get(Ty->getBitWidth() - ShiftAmt1);
6128 break;
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006129 default: break;
6130 }
6131 if (SExtType) {
6132 Instruction *NewTrunc = new TruncInst(X, SExtType, "sext");
6133 InsertNewInstBefore(NewTrunc, I);
6134 return new SExtInst(NewTrunc, Ty);
6135 }
6136 // Otherwise, we can't handle it yet.
6137 } else if (ShiftAmt1 < ShiftAmt2) {
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00006138 uint32_t ShiftDiff = ShiftAmt2-ShiftAmt1;
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006139
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00006140 // (X >>? C1) << C2 --> X << (C2-C1) & (-1 << C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006141 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
6142 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr ||
6143 ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr);
Chris Lattnere8d56c52006-01-07 01:32:28 +00006144 Instruction *Shift =
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006145 BinaryOperator::createShl(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Chris Lattnere8d56c52006-01-07 01:32:28 +00006146 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
6147
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00006148 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
6149 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006150 }
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006151
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00006152 // (X << C1) >>u C2 --> X >>u (C2-C1) & (-1 >> C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006153 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
6154 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl);
6155 Instruction *Shift =
6156 BinaryOperator::createLShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
6157 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006158
Reid Spencerd5e30f02007-03-26 17:18:58 +00006159 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00006160 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00006161 }
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006162
6163 // We can't handle (X << C1) >>s C2, it shifts arbitrary bits in.
6164 } else {
6165 assert(ShiftAmt2 < ShiftAmt1);
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00006166 uint32_t ShiftDiff = ShiftAmt1-ShiftAmt2;
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006167
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00006168 // (X >>? C1) << C2 --> X >>? (C1-C2) & (-1 << C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006169 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
6170 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr ||
6171 ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr);
6172 Instruction *Shift =
6173 BinaryOperator::create(ShiftOp->getOpcode(), X,
6174 ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
6175 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
6176
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00006177 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00006178 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006179 }
6180
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00006181 // (X << C1) >>u C2 --> X << (C1-C2) & (-1 >> C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006182 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
6183 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl);
6184 Instruction *Shift =
6185 BinaryOperator::createShl(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
6186 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
6187
Reid Spencer68d27cf2007-03-26 23:45:51 +00006188 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00006189 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006190 }
6191
6192 // We can't handle (X << C1) >>a C2, it shifts arbitrary bits in.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00006193 }
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006194 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00006195 return 0;
6196}
6197
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +00006198
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00006199/// DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr - Analyze 'Val', seeing if it is a simple linear
6200/// expression. If so, decompose it, returning some value X, such that Val is
6201/// X*Scale+Offset.
6202///
6203static Value *DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(Value *Val, unsigned &Scale,
Jeff Cohen86796be2007-04-04 16:58:57 +00006204 int &Offset) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00006205 assert(Val->getType() == Type::Int32Ty && "Unexpected allocation size type!");
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006206 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Val)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00006207 Offset = CI->getZExtValue();
6208 Scale = 1;
6209 return ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, 0);
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00006210 } else if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Val)) {
6211 if (I->getNumOperands() == 2) {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006212 if (ConstantInt *CUI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00006213 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
6214 // This is a value scaled by '1 << the shift amt'.
6215 Scale = 1U << CUI->getZExtValue();
6216 Offset = 0;
6217 return I->getOperand(0);
6218 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul) {
6219 // This value is scaled by 'CUI'.
6220 Scale = CUI->getZExtValue();
6221 Offset = 0;
6222 return I->getOperand(0);
6223 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
6224 // We have X+C. Check to see if we really have (X*C2)+C1,
6225 // where C1 is divisible by C2.
6226 unsigned SubScale;
6227 Value *SubVal =
6228 DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(I->getOperand(0), SubScale, Offset);
6229 Offset += CUI->getZExtValue();
6230 if (SubScale > 1 && (Offset % SubScale == 0)) {
6231 Scale = SubScale;
6232 return SubVal;
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00006233 }
6234 }
6235 }
6236 }
6237 }
6238
6239 // Otherwise, we can't look past this.
6240 Scale = 1;
6241 Offset = 0;
6242 return Val;
6243}
6244
6245
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006246/// PromoteCastOfAllocation - If we find a cast of an allocation instruction,
6247/// try to eliminate the cast by moving the type information into the alloc.
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00006248Instruction *InstCombiner::PromoteCastOfAllocation(BitCastInst &CI,
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006249 AllocationInst &AI) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00006250 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(CI.getType());
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006251
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00006252 // Remove any uses of AI that are dead.
6253 assert(!CI.use_empty() && "Dead instructions should be removed earlier!");
Chris Lattner535014f2007-02-15 22:52:10 +00006254
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00006255 for (Value::use_iterator UI = AI.use_begin(), E = AI.use_end(); UI != E; ) {
6256 Instruction *User = cast<Instruction>(*UI++);
6257 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(User)) {
6258 while (UI != E && *UI == User)
6259 ++UI; // If this instruction uses AI more than once, don't break UI.
6260
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00006261 ++NumDeadInst;
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +00006262 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *User;
Chris Lattnerf22a5c62007-03-02 19:59:19 +00006263 EraseInstFromFunction(*User);
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00006264 }
6265 }
6266
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006267 // Get the type really allocated and the type casted to.
6268 const Type *AllocElTy = AI.getAllocatedType();
6269 const Type *CastElTy = PTy->getElementType();
6270 if (!AllocElTy->isSized() || !CastElTy->isSized()) return 0;
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00006271
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +00006272 unsigned AllocElTyAlign = TD->getABITypeAlignment(AllocElTy);
6273 unsigned CastElTyAlign = TD->getABITypeAlignment(CastElTy);
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00006274 if (CastElTyAlign < AllocElTyAlign) return 0;
6275
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00006276 // If the allocation has multiple uses, only promote it if we are strictly
6277 // increasing the alignment of the resultant allocation. If we keep it the
6278 // same, we open the door to infinite loops of various kinds.
6279 if (!AI.hasOneUse() && CastElTyAlign == AllocElTyAlign) return 0;
6280
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006281 uint64_t AllocElTySize = TD->getTypeSize(AllocElTy);
6282 uint64_t CastElTySize = TD->getTypeSize(CastElTy);
Chris Lattner0ddac2a2005-10-27 05:53:56 +00006283 if (CastElTySize == 0 || AllocElTySize == 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00006284
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00006285 // See if we can satisfy the modulus by pulling a scale out of the array
6286 // size argument.
Jeff Cohen86796be2007-04-04 16:58:57 +00006287 unsigned ArraySizeScale;
6288 int ArrayOffset;
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00006289 Value *NumElements = // See if the array size is a decomposable linear expr.
6290 DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(AI.getOperand(0), ArraySizeScale, ArrayOffset);
6291
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00006292 // If we can now satisfy the modulus, by using a non-1 scale, we really can
6293 // do the xform.
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00006294 if ((AllocElTySize*ArraySizeScale) % CastElTySize != 0 ||
6295 (AllocElTySize*ArrayOffset ) % CastElTySize != 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner8142b0a2005-10-27 06:12:00 +00006296
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00006297 unsigned Scale = (AllocElTySize*ArraySizeScale)/CastElTySize;
6298 Value *Amt = 0;
6299 if (Scale == 1) {
6300 Amt = NumElements;
6301 } else {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006302 // If the allocation size is constant, form a constant mul expression
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00006303 Amt = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Scale);
6304 if (isa<ConstantInt>(NumElements))
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00006305 Amt = Multiply(cast<ConstantInt>(NumElements), cast<ConstantInt>(Amt));
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006306 // otherwise multiply the amount and the number of elements
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00006307 else if (Scale != 1) {
6308 Instruction *Tmp = BinaryOperator::createMul(Amt, NumElements, "tmp");
6309 Amt = InsertNewInstBefore(Tmp, AI);
Chris Lattner8142b0a2005-10-27 06:12:00 +00006310 }
Chris Lattner0ddac2a2005-10-27 05:53:56 +00006311 }
6312
Jeff Cohen86796be2007-04-04 16:58:57 +00006313 if (int Offset = (AllocElTySize*ArrayOffset)/CastElTySize) {
6314 Value *Off = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Offset, true);
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00006315 Instruction *Tmp = BinaryOperator::createAdd(Amt, Off, "tmp");
6316 Amt = InsertNewInstBefore(Tmp, AI);
6317 }
6318
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006319 AllocationInst *New;
6320 if (isa<MallocInst>(AI))
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00006321 New = new MallocInst(CastElTy, Amt, AI.getAlignment());
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006322 else
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00006323 New = new AllocaInst(CastElTy, Amt, AI.getAlignment());
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006324 InsertNewInstBefore(New, AI);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00006325 New->takeName(&AI);
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00006326
6327 // If the allocation has multiple uses, insert a cast and change all things
6328 // that used it to use the new cast. This will also hack on CI, but it will
6329 // die soon.
6330 if (!AI.hasOneUse()) {
6331 AddUsesToWorkList(AI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006332 // New is the allocation instruction, pointer typed. AI is the original
6333 // allocation instruction, also pointer typed. Thus, cast to use is BitCast.
6334 CastInst *NewCast = new BitCastInst(New, AI.getType(), "tmpcast");
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00006335 InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, AI);
6336 AI.replaceAllUsesWith(NewCast);
6337 }
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006338 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, New);
6339}
6340
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006341/// CanEvaluateInDifferentType - Return true if we can take the specified value
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006342/// and return it as type Ty without inserting any new casts and without
6343/// changing the computed value. This is used by code that tries to decide
6344/// whether promoting or shrinking integer operations to wider or smaller types
6345/// will allow us to eliminate a truncate or extend.
6346///
6347/// This is a truncation operation if Ty is smaller than V->getType(), or an
6348/// extension operation if Ty is larger.
6349static bool CanEvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const IntegerType *Ty,
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006350 int &NumCastsRemoved) {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006351 // We can always evaluate constants in another type.
6352 if (isa<ConstantInt>(V))
6353 return true;
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006354
6355 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006356 if (!I) return false;
6357
6358 const IntegerType *OrigTy = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType());
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006359
6360 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006361 case Instruction::Add:
6362 case Instruction::Sub:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006363 case Instruction::And:
6364 case Instruction::Or:
6365 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006366 if (!I->hasOneUse()) return false;
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006367 // These operators can all arbitrarily be extended or truncated.
6368 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, NumCastsRemoved) &&
6369 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006370
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00006371 case Instruction::Shl:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006372 if (!I->hasOneUse()) return false;
6373 // If we are truncating the result of this SHL, and if it's a shift of a
6374 // constant amount, we can always perform a SHL in a smaller type.
6375 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006376 uint32_t BitWidth = Ty->getBitWidth();
6377 if (BitWidth < OrigTy->getBitWidth() &&
6378 CI->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) < BitWidth)
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006379 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty,NumCastsRemoved);
6380 }
6381 break;
6382 case Instruction::LShr:
6383 if (!I->hasOneUse()) return false;
6384 // If this is a truncate of a logical shr, we can truncate it to a smaller
6385 // lshr iff we know that the bits we would otherwise be shifting in are
6386 // already zeros.
6387 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006388 uint32_t OrigBitWidth = OrigTy->getBitWidth();
6389 uint32_t BitWidth = Ty->getBitWidth();
6390 if (BitWidth < OrigBitWidth &&
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006391 MaskedValueIsZero(I->getOperand(0),
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006392 APInt::getHighBitsSet(OrigBitWidth, OrigBitWidth-BitWidth)) &&
6393 CI->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) < BitWidth) {
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +00006394 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty,NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006395 }
6396 }
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00006397 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006398 case Instruction::Trunc:
6399 case Instruction::ZExt:
6400 case Instruction::SExt:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006401 // If this is a cast from the destination type, we can trivially eliminate
6402 // it, and this will remove a cast overall.
6403 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() == Ty) {
Chris Lattnerd2280182006-06-28 17:34:50 +00006404 // If the first operand is itself a cast, and is eliminable, do not count
6405 // this as an eliminable cast. We would prefer to eliminate those two
6406 // casts first.
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +00006407 if (isa<CastInst>(I->getOperand(0)))
Chris Lattnerd2280182006-06-28 17:34:50 +00006408 return true;
6409
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006410 ++NumCastsRemoved;
6411 return true;
6412 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006413 break;
6414 default:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006415 // TODO: Can handle more cases here.
6416 break;
6417 }
6418
6419 return false;
6420}
6421
6422/// EvaluateInDifferentType - Given an expression that
6423/// CanEvaluateInDifferentType returns true for, actually insert the code to
6424/// evaluate the expression.
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00006425Value *InstCombiner::EvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const Type *Ty,
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006426 bool isSigned) {
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006427 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00006428 return ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(C, Ty, isSigned /*Sext or ZExt*/);
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006429
6430 // Otherwise, it must be an instruction.
6431 Instruction *I = cast<Instruction>(V);
Chris Lattner01859e82006-05-20 23:14:03 +00006432 Instruction *Res = 0;
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006433 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006434 case Instruction::Add:
6435 case Instruction::Sub:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006436 case Instruction::And:
6437 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006438 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00006439 case Instruction::AShr:
6440 case Instruction::LShr:
6441 case Instruction::Shl: {
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00006442 Value *LHS = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, isSigned);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006443 Value *RHS = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, isSigned);
6444 Res = BinaryOperator::create((Instruction::BinaryOps)I->getOpcode(),
6445 LHS, RHS, I->getName());
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00006446 break;
6447 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006448 case Instruction::Trunc:
6449 case Instruction::ZExt:
6450 case Instruction::SExt:
6451 case Instruction::BitCast:
6452 // If the source type of the cast is the type we're trying for then we can
6453 // just return the source. There's no need to insert it because its not new.
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006454 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() == Ty)
6455 return I->getOperand(0);
6456
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006457 // Some other kind of cast, which shouldn't happen, so just ..
6458 // FALL THROUGH
6459 default:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006460 // TODO: Can handle more cases here.
6461 assert(0 && "Unreachable!");
6462 break;
6463 }
6464
6465 return InsertNewInstBefore(Res, *I);
6466}
6467
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006468/// @brief Implement the transforms common to all CastInst visitors.
6469Instruction *InstCombiner::commonCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner79d35b32003-06-23 21:59:52 +00006470 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
6471
Dan Gohman23d9d272007-05-11 21:10:54 +00006472 // Many cases of "cast of a cast" are eliminable. If it's eliminable we just
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006473 // eliminate it now.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00006474 if (CastInst *CSrc = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Src)) { // A->B->C cast
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006475 if (Instruction::CastOps opc =
6476 isEliminableCastPair(CSrc, CI.getOpcode(), CI.getType(), TD)) {
6477 // The first cast (CSrc) is eliminable so we need to fix up or replace
6478 // the second cast (CI). CSrc will then have a good chance of being dead.
6479 return CastInst::create(opc, CSrc->getOperand(0), CI.getType());
Chris Lattner8fd217c2002-08-02 20:00:25 +00006480 }
6481 }
Chris Lattnera710ddc2004-05-25 04:29:21 +00006482
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006483 // If we are casting a select then fold the cast into the select
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00006484 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Src))
6485 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoSelect(CI, SI, this))
6486 return NV;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006487
6488 // If we are casting a PHI then fold the cast into the PHI
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00006489 if (isa<PHINode>(Src))
6490 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(CI))
6491 return NV;
Chris Lattner9fb92132006-04-12 18:09:35 +00006492
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006493 return 0;
6494}
6495
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00006496/// @brief Implement the transforms for cast of pointer (bitcast/ptrtoint)
6497Instruction *InstCombiner::commonPointerCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
6498 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
6499
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00006500 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Src)) {
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00006501 // If casting the result of a getelementptr instruction with no offset, turn
6502 // this into a cast of the original pointer!
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00006503 if (GEP->hasAllZeroIndices()) {
6504 // Changing the cast operand is usually not a good idea but it is safe
6505 // here because the pointer operand is being replaced with another
6506 // pointer operand so the opcode doesn't need to change.
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00006507 AddToWorkList(GEP);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00006508 CI.setOperand(0, GEP->getOperand(0));
6509 return &CI;
6510 }
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00006511
6512 // If the GEP has a single use, and the base pointer is a bitcast, and the
6513 // GEP computes a constant offset, see if we can convert these three
6514 // instructions into fewer. This typically happens with unions and other
6515 // non-type-safe code.
6516 if (GEP->hasOneUse() && isa<BitCastInst>(GEP->getOperand(0))) {
6517 if (GEP->hasAllConstantIndices()) {
6518 // We are guaranteed to get a constant from EmitGEPOffset.
6519 ConstantInt *OffsetV = cast<ConstantInt>(EmitGEPOffset(GEP, CI, *this));
6520 int64_t Offset = OffsetV->getSExtValue();
6521
6522 // Get the base pointer input of the bitcast, and the type it points to.
6523 Value *OrigBase = cast<BitCastInst>(GEP->getOperand(0))->getOperand(0);
6524 const Type *GEPIdxTy =
6525 cast<PointerType>(OrigBase->getType())->getElementType();
6526 if (GEPIdxTy->isSized()) {
6527 SmallVector<Value*, 8> NewIndices;
6528
Chris Lattnerc42e2262007-05-05 01:59:31 +00006529 // Start with the index over the outer type. Note that the type size
6530 // might be zero (even if the offset isn't zero) if the indexed type
6531 // is something like [0 x {int, int}]
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00006532 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD->getIntPtrType();
Chris Lattnerc42e2262007-05-05 01:59:31 +00006533 int64_t FirstIdx = 0;
6534 if (int64_t TySize = TD->getTypeSize(GEPIdxTy)) {
6535 FirstIdx = Offset/TySize;
6536 Offset %= TySize;
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00006537
Chris Lattnerc42e2262007-05-05 01:59:31 +00006538 // Handle silly modulus not returning values values [0..TySize).
6539 if (Offset < 0) {
6540 --FirstIdx;
6541 Offset += TySize;
6542 assert(Offset >= 0);
6543 }
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +00006544 assert((uint64_t)Offset < (uint64_t)TySize &&"Out of range offset");
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00006545 }
6546
6547 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, FirstIdx));
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00006548
6549 // Index into the types. If we fail, set OrigBase to null.
6550 while (Offset) {
6551 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(GEPIdxTy)) {
6552 const StructLayout *SL = TD->getStructLayout(STy);
Chris Lattner6b6aef82007-05-15 00:16:00 +00006553 if (Offset < (int64_t)SL->getSizeInBytes()) {
6554 unsigned Elt = SL->getElementContainingOffset(Offset);
6555 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Elt));
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00006556
Chris Lattner6b6aef82007-05-15 00:16:00 +00006557 Offset -= SL->getElementOffset(Elt);
6558 GEPIdxTy = STy->getElementType(Elt);
6559 } else {
6560 // Otherwise, we can't index into this, bail out.
6561 Offset = 0;
6562 OrigBase = 0;
6563 }
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00006564 } else if (isa<ArrayType>(GEPIdxTy) || isa<VectorType>(GEPIdxTy)) {
6565 const SequentialType *STy = cast<SequentialType>(GEPIdxTy);
Chris Lattner6b6aef82007-05-15 00:16:00 +00006566 if (uint64_t EltSize = TD->getTypeSize(STy->getElementType())) {
6567 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy,Offset/EltSize));
6568 Offset %= EltSize;
6569 } else {
6570 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, 0));
6571 }
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00006572 GEPIdxTy = STy->getElementType();
6573 } else {
6574 // Otherwise, we can't index into this, bail out.
6575 Offset = 0;
6576 OrigBase = 0;
6577 }
6578 }
6579 if (OrigBase) {
6580 // If we were able to index down into an element, create the GEP
6581 // and bitcast the result. This eliminates one bitcast, potentially
6582 // two.
6583 Instruction *NGEP = new GetElementPtrInst(OrigBase, &NewIndices[0],
6584 NewIndices.size(), "");
6585 InsertNewInstBefore(NGEP, CI);
6586 NGEP->takeName(GEP);
6587
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00006588 if (isa<BitCastInst>(CI))
6589 return new BitCastInst(NGEP, CI.getType());
6590 assert(isa<PtrToIntInst>(CI));
6591 return new PtrToIntInst(NGEP, CI.getType());
6592 }
6593 }
6594 }
6595 }
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00006596 }
6597
6598 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
6599}
6600
6601
6602
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006603/// Only the TRUNC, ZEXT, SEXT, and BITCAST can both operand and result as
6604/// integer types. This function implements the common transforms for all those
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006605/// cases.
6606/// @brief Implement the transforms common to CastInst with integer operands
6607Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIntCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
6608 if (Instruction *Result = commonCastTransforms(CI))
6609 return Result;
6610
6611 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
6612 const Type *SrcTy = Src->getType();
6613 const Type *DestTy = CI.getType();
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00006614 uint32_t SrcBitSize = SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6615 uint32_t DestBitSize = DestTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006616
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006617 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the LHS whose sole
6618 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencerad6676e2007-03-22 20:56:53 +00006619 APInt KnownZero(DestBitSize, 0), KnownOne(DestBitSize, 0);
6620 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&CI, APInt::getAllOnesValue(DestBitSize),
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006621 KnownZero, KnownOne))
6622 return &CI;
6623
6624 // If the source isn't an instruction or has more than one use then we
6625 // can't do anything more.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006626 Instruction *SrcI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Src);
6627 if (!SrcI || !Src->hasOneUse())
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006628 return 0;
6629
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006630 // Attempt to propagate the cast into the instruction for int->int casts.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006631 int NumCastsRemoved = 0;
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006632 if (!isa<BitCastInst>(CI) &&
6633 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(SrcI, cast<IntegerType>(DestTy),
6634 NumCastsRemoved)) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006635 // If this cast is a truncate, evaluting in a different type always
6636 // eliminates the cast, so it is always a win. If this is a noop-cast
6637 // this just removes a noop cast which isn't pointful, but simplifies
6638 // the code. If this is a zero-extension, we need to do an AND to
6639 // maintain the clear top-part of the computation, so we require that
6640 // the input have eliminated at least one cast. If this is a sign
6641 // extension, we insert two new casts (to do the extension) so we
6642 // require that two casts have been eliminated.
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006643 bool DoXForm;
6644 switch (CI.getOpcode()) {
6645 default:
6646 // All the others use floating point so we shouldn't actually
6647 // get here because of the check above.
6648 assert(0 && "Unknown cast type");
6649 case Instruction::Trunc:
6650 DoXForm = true;
6651 break;
6652 case Instruction::ZExt:
6653 DoXForm = NumCastsRemoved >= 1;
6654 break;
6655 case Instruction::SExt:
6656 DoXForm = NumCastsRemoved >= 2;
6657 break;
6658 case Instruction::BitCast:
6659 DoXForm = false;
6660 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006661 }
6662
6663 if (DoXForm) {
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00006664 Value *Res = EvaluateInDifferentType(SrcI, DestTy,
6665 CI.getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006666 assert(Res->getType() == DestTy);
6667 switch (CI.getOpcode()) {
6668 default: assert(0 && "Unknown cast type!");
6669 case Instruction::Trunc:
6670 case Instruction::BitCast:
6671 // Just replace this cast with the result.
6672 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
6673 case Instruction::ZExt: {
6674 // We need to emit an AND to clear the high bits.
6675 assert(SrcBitSize < DestBitSize && "Not a zext?");
Chris Lattnercd1d6d52007-04-02 05:48:58 +00006676 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(APInt::getLowBitsSet(DestBitSize,
6677 SrcBitSize));
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006678 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Res, C);
6679 }
6680 case Instruction::SExt:
6681 // We need to emit a cast to truncate, then a cast to sext.
6682 return CastInst::create(Instruction::SExt,
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00006683 InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, Res, Src->getType(),
6684 CI), DestTy);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006685 }
6686 }
6687 }
6688
6689 Value *Op0 = SrcI->getNumOperands() > 0 ? SrcI->getOperand(0) : 0;
6690 Value *Op1 = SrcI->getNumOperands() > 1 ? SrcI->getOperand(1) : 0;
6691
6692 switch (SrcI->getOpcode()) {
6693 case Instruction::Add:
6694 case Instruction::Mul:
6695 case Instruction::And:
6696 case Instruction::Or:
6697 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006698 // If we are discarding information, rewrite.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006699 if (DestBitSize <= SrcBitSize && DestBitSize != 1) {
6700 // Don't insert two casts if they cannot be eliminated. We allow
6701 // two casts to be inserted if the sizes are the same. This could
6702 // only be converting signedness, which is a noop.
6703 if (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize ||
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006704 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op1, DestTy,TD) ||
6705 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op0, DestTy, TD)) {
Reid Spencer7eb76382006-12-13 17:19:09 +00006706 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CI.getOpcode();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00006707 Value *Op0c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op0, DestTy, SrcI);
6708 Value *Op1c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op1, DestTy, SrcI);
6709 return BinaryOperator::create(
6710 cast<BinaryOperator>(SrcI)->getOpcode(), Op0c, Op1c);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006711 }
6712 }
6713
6714 // cast (xor bool X, true) to int --> xor (cast bool X to int), 1
6715 if (isa<ZExtInst>(CI) && SrcBitSize == 1 &&
6716 SrcI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Xor &&
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006717 Op1 == ConstantInt::getTrue() &&
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006718 (!Op0->hasOneUse() || !isa<CmpInst>(Op0))) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00006719 Value *New = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::ZExt, Op0, DestTy, &CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006720 return BinaryOperator::createXor(New, ConstantInt::get(CI.getType(), 1));
6721 }
6722 break;
6723 case Instruction::SDiv:
6724 case Instruction::UDiv:
6725 case Instruction::SRem:
6726 case Instruction::URem:
6727 // If we are just changing the sign, rewrite.
6728 if (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize) {
6729 // Don't insert two casts if they cannot be eliminated. We allow
6730 // two casts to be inserted if the sizes are the same. This could
6731 // only be converting signedness, which is a noop.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006732 if (!ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op1, DestTy, TD) ||
6733 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op0, DestTy, TD)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00006734 Value *Op0c = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
6735 Op0, DestTy, SrcI);
6736 Value *Op1c = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
6737 Op1, DestTy, SrcI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006738 return BinaryOperator::create(
6739 cast<BinaryOperator>(SrcI)->getOpcode(), Op0c, Op1c);
6740 }
6741 }
6742 break;
6743
6744 case Instruction::Shl:
6745 // Allow changing the sign of the source operand. Do not allow
6746 // changing the size of the shift, UNLESS the shift amount is a
6747 // constant. We must not change variable sized shifts to a smaller
6748 // size, because it is undefined to shift more bits out than exist
6749 // in the value.
6750 if (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize ||
6751 (DestBitSize < SrcBitSize && isa<Constant>(Op1))) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00006752 Instruction::CastOps opcode = (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize ?
6753 Instruction::BitCast : Instruction::Trunc);
6754 Value *Op0c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op0, DestTy, SrcI);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006755 Value *Op1c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op1, DestTy, SrcI);
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00006756 return BinaryOperator::createShl(Op0c, Op1c);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006757 }
6758 break;
6759 case Instruction::AShr:
6760 // If this is a signed shr, and if all bits shifted in are about to be
6761 // truncated off, turn it into an unsigned shr to allow greater
6762 // simplifications.
6763 if (DestBitSize < SrcBitSize &&
6764 isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006765 uint32_t ShiftAmt = cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)->getLimitedValue(SrcBitSize);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006766 if (SrcBitSize > ShiftAmt && SrcBitSize-ShiftAmt >= DestBitSize) {
6767 // Insert the new logical shift right.
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00006768 return BinaryOperator::createLShr(Op0, Op1);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006769 }
6770 }
6771 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006772 }
6773 return 0;
6774}
6775
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00006776Instruction *InstCombiner::visitTrunc(TruncInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00006777 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
6778 return Result;
6779
6780 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
6781 const Type *Ty = CI.getType();
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00006782 uint32_t DestBitWidth = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6783 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Src->getType())->getBitWidth();
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00006784
6785 if (Instruction *SrcI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Src)) {
6786 switch (SrcI->getOpcode()) {
6787 default: break;
6788 case Instruction::LShr:
6789 // We can shrink lshr to something smaller if we know the bits shifted in
6790 // are already zeros.
6791 if (ConstantInt *ShAmtV = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SrcI->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006792 uint32_t ShAmt = ShAmtV->getLimitedValue(SrcBitWidth);
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00006793
6794 // Get a mask for the bits shifting in.
Zhou Shenge82fca02007-03-28 09:19:01 +00006795 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcBitWidth, ShAmt).shl(DestBitWidth));
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00006796 Value* SrcIOp0 = SrcI->getOperand(0);
6797 if (SrcI->hasOneUse() && MaskedValueIsZero(SrcIOp0, Mask)) {
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00006798 if (ShAmt >= DestBitWidth) // All zeros.
6799 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Constant::getNullValue(Ty));
6800
6801 // Okay, we can shrink this. Truncate the input, then return a new
6802 // shift.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006803 Value *V1 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, SrcIOp0, Ty, CI);
6804 Value *V2 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, SrcI->getOperand(1),
6805 Ty, CI);
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00006806 return BinaryOperator::createLShr(V1, V2);
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00006807 }
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00006808 } else { // This is a variable shr.
6809
6810 // Turn 'trunc (lshr X, Y) to bool' into '(X & (1 << Y)) != 0'. This is
6811 // more LLVM instructions, but allows '1 << Y' to be hoisted if
6812 // loop-invariant and CSE'd.
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00006813 if (CI.getType() == Type::Int1Ty && SrcI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00006814 Value *One = ConstantInt::get(SrcI->getType(), 1);
6815
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006816 Value *V = InsertNewInstBefore(
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00006817 BinaryOperator::createShl(One, SrcI->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006818 "tmp"), CI);
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00006819 V = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAnd(V,
6820 SrcI->getOperand(0),
6821 "tmp"), CI);
6822 Value *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(V->getType());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006823 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, V, Zero);
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00006824 }
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00006825 }
6826 break;
6827 }
6828 }
6829
6830 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006831}
6832
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00006833Instruction *InstCombiner::visitZExt(ZExtInst &CI) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006834 // If one of the common conversion will work ..
6835 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
6836 return Result;
6837
6838 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
6839
6840 // If this is a cast of a cast
6841 if (CastInst *CSrc = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Src)) { // A->B->C cast
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006842 // If this is a TRUNC followed by a ZEXT then we are dealing with integral
6843 // types and if the sizes are just right we can convert this into a logical
6844 // 'and' which will be much cheaper than the pair of casts.
6845 if (isa<TruncInst>(CSrc)) {
6846 // Get the sizes of the types involved
6847 Value *A = CSrc->getOperand(0);
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00006848 uint32_t SrcSize = A->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6849 uint32_t MidSize = CSrc->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6850 uint32_t DstSize = CI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006851 // If we're actually extending zero bits and the trunc is a no-op
6852 if (MidSize < DstSize && SrcSize == DstSize) {
6853 // Replace both of the casts with an And of the type mask.
Zhou Shenge82fca02007-03-28 09:19:01 +00006854 APInt AndValue(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcSize, MidSize));
Reid Spencerad6676e2007-03-22 20:56:53 +00006855 Constant *AndConst = ConstantInt::get(AndValue);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006856 Instruction *And =
6857 BinaryOperator::createAnd(CSrc->getOperand(0), AndConst);
6858 // Unfortunately, if the type changed, we need to cast it back.
6859 if (And->getType() != CI.getType()) {
6860 And->setName(CSrc->getName()+".mask");
6861 InsertNewInstBefore(And, CI);
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00006862 And = CastInst::createIntegerCast(And, CI.getType(), false/*ZExt*/);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006863 }
6864 return And;
6865 }
6866 }
6867 }
6868
Chris Lattner66bc3252007-04-11 05:45:39 +00006869 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Src)) {
6870 // If we are just checking for a icmp eq of a single bit and zext'ing it
6871 // to an integer, then shift the bit to the appropriate place and then
6872 // cast to integer to avoid the comparison.
6873 if (ConstantInt *Op1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ICI->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00006874 const APInt &Op1CV = Op1C->getValue();
Chris Lattnera2e2c9b2007-04-11 06:53:04 +00006875
6876 // zext (x <s 0) to i32 --> x>>u31 true if signbit set.
6877 // zext (x >s -1) to i32 --> (x>>u31)^1 true if signbit clear.
6878 if ((ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && Op1CV == 0) ||
6879 (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT &&Op1CV.isAllOnesValue())){
6880 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
6881 Value *Sh = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(),
6882 In->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
6883 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createLShr(In, Sh,
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +00006884 In->getName()+".lobit"),
Chris Lattnera2e2c9b2007-04-11 06:53:04 +00006885 CI);
6886 if (In->getType() != CI.getType())
6887 In = CastInst::createIntegerCast(In, CI.getType(),
6888 false/*ZExt*/, "tmp", &CI);
6889
6890 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT) {
6891 Constant *One = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), 1);
6892 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createXor(In, One,
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +00006893 In->getName()+".not"),
Chris Lattnera2e2c9b2007-04-11 06:53:04 +00006894 CI);
6895 }
6896
6897 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, In);
6898 }
6899
6900
6901
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00006902 // zext (X == 0) to i32 --> X^1 iff X has only the low bit set.
6903 // zext (X == 0) to i32 --> (X>>1)^1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
6904 // zext (X == 1) to i32 --> X iff X has only the low bit set.
6905 // zext (X == 2) to i32 --> X>>1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
6906 // zext (X != 0) to i32 --> X iff X has only the low bit set.
6907 // zext (X != 0) to i32 --> X>>1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
6908 // zext (X != 1) to i32 --> X^1 iff X has only the low bit set.
6909 // zext (X != 2) to i32 --> (X>>1)^1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
Chris Lattner66bc3252007-04-11 05:45:39 +00006910 if ((Op1CV == 0 || Op1CV.isPowerOf2()) &&
6911 // This only works for EQ and NE
6912 ICI->isEquality()) {
6913 // If Op1C some other power of two, convert:
6914 uint32_t BitWidth = Op1C->getType()->getBitWidth();
6915 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
6916 APInt TypeMask(APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth));
6917 ComputeMaskedBits(ICI->getOperand(0), TypeMask, KnownZero, KnownOne);
6918
6919 APInt KnownZeroMask(~KnownZero);
6920 if (KnownZeroMask.isPowerOf2()) { // Exactly 1 possible 1?
6921 bool isNE = ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
6922 if (Op1CV != 0 && (Op1CV != KnownZeroMask)) {
6923 // (X&4) == 2 --> false
6924 // (X&4) != 2 --> true
6925 Constant *Res = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, isNE);
6926 Res = ConstantExpr::getZExt(Res, CI.getType());
6927 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
6928 }
6929
6930 uint32_t ShiftAmt = KnownZeroMask.logBase2();
6931 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
6932 if (ShiftAmt) {
6933 // Perform a logical shr by shiftamt.
6934 // Insert the shift to put the result in the low bit.
6935 In = InsertNewInstBefore(
6936 BinaryOperator::createLShr(In,
6937 ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), ShiftAmt),
6938 In->getName()+".lobit"), CI);
6939 }
6940
6941 if ((Op1CV != 0) == isNE) { // Toggle the low bit.
6942 Constant *One = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), 1);
6943 In = BinaryOperator::createXor(In, One, "tmp");
6944 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(In), CI);
6945 }
6946
6947 if (CI.getType() == In->getType())
6948 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, In);
6949 else
6950 return CastInst::createIntegerCast(In, CI.getType(), false/*ZExt*/);
6951 }
6952 }
6953 }
6954 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006955 return 0;
6956}
6957
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00006958Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSExt(SExtInst &CI) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00006959 if (Instruction *I = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
6960 return I;
6961
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00006962 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
6963
6964 // sext (x <s 0) -> ashr x, 31 -> all ones if signed
6965 // sext (x >s -1) -> ashr x, 31 -> all ones if not signed
6966 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Src)) {
6967 // If we are just checking for a icmp eq of a single bit and zext'ing it
6968 // to an integer, then shift the bit to the appropriate place and then
6969 // cast to integer to avoid the comparison.
6970 if (ConstantInt *Op1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ICI->getOperand(1))) {
6971 const APInt &Op1CV = Op1C->getValue();
6972
6973 // sext (x <s 0) to i32 --> x>>s31 true if signbit set.
6974 // sext (x >s -1) to i32 --> (x>>s31)^-1 true if signbit clear.
6975 if ((ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && Op1CV == 0) ||
6976 (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT &&Op1CV.isAllOnesValue())){
6977 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
6978 Value *Sh = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(),
6979 In->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
6980 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAShr(In, Sh,
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +00006981 In->getName()+".lobit"),
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00006982 CI);
6983 if (In->getType() != CI.getType())
6984 In = CastInst::createIntegerCast(In, CI.getType(),
6985 true/*SExt*/, "tmp", &CI);
6986
6987 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT)
6988 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createNot(In,
6989 In->getName()+".not"), CI);
6990
6991 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, In);
6992 }
6993 }
6994 }
6995
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00006996 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006997}
6998
6999Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPTrunc(CastInst &CI) {
7000 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
7001}
7002
7003Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPExt(CastInst &CI) {
7004 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
7005}
7006
7007Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPToUI(CastInst &CI) {
Reid Spencer44c030a2006-11-30 23:13:36 +00007008 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007009}
7010
7011Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPToSI(CastInst &CI) {
Reid Spencer44c030a2006-11-30 23:13:36 +00007012 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007013}
7014
7015Instruction *InstCombiner::visitUIToFP(CastInst &CI) {
7016 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
7017}
7018
7019Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSIToFP(CastInst &CI) {
7020 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
7021}
7022
7023Instruction *InstCombiner::visitPtrToInt(CastInst &CI) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007024 return commonPointerCastTransforms(CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007025}
7026
7027Instruction *InstCombiner::visitIntToPtr(CastInst &CI) {
7028 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
7029}
7030
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007031Instruction *InstCombiner::visitBitCast(BitCastInst &CI) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007032 // If the operands are integer typed then apply the integer transforms,
7033 // otherwise just apply the common ones.
7034 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7035 const Type *SrcTy = Src->getType();
7036 const Type *DestTy = CI.getType();
7037
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00007038 if (SrcTy->isInteger() && DestTy->isInteger()) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007039 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
7040 return Result;
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007041 } else if (isa<PointerType>(SrcTy)) {
7042 if (Instruction *I = commonPointerCastTransforms(CI))
7043 return I;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007044 } else {
7045 if (Instruction *Result = commonCastTransforms(CI))
7046 return Result;
7047 }
7048
7049
7050 // Get rid of casts from one type to the same type. These are useless and can
7051 // be replaced by the operand.
7052 if (DestTy == Src->getType())
7053 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Src);
7054
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007055 if (const PointerType *DstPTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(DestTy)) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007056 const PointerType *SrcPTy = cast<PointerType>(SrcTy);
7057 const Type *DstElTy = DstPTy->getElementType();
7058 const Type *SrcElTy = SrcPTy->getElementType();
7059
7060 // If we are casting a malloc or alloca to a pointer to a type of the same
7061 // size, rewrite the allocation instruction to allocate the "right" type.
7062 if (AllocationInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocationInst>(Src))
7063 if (Instruction *V = PromoteCastOfAllocation(CI, *AI))
7064 return V;
7065
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +00007066 // If the source and destination are pointers, and this cast is equivalent
7067 // to a getelementptr X, 0, 0, 0... turn it into the appropriate gep.
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007068 // This can enhance SROA and other transforms that want type-safe pointers.
7069 Constant *ZeroUInt = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
7070 unsigned NumZeros = 0;
7071 while (SrcElTy != DstElTy &&
7072 isa<CompositeType>(SrcElTy) && !isa<PointerType>(SrcElTy) &&
7073 SrcElTy->getNumContainedTypes() /* not "{}" */) {
7074 SrcElTy = cast<CompositeType>(SrcElTy)->getTypeAtIndex(ZeroUInt);
7075 ++NumZeros;
7076 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00007077
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007078 // If we found a path from the src to dest, create the getelementptr now.
7079 if (SrcElTy == DstElTy) {
7080 SmallVector<Value*, 8> Idxs(NumZeros+1, ZeroUInt);
7081 return new GetElementPtrInst(Src, &Idxs[0], Idxs.size());
Chris Lattner9fb92132006-04-12 18:09:35 +00007082 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007083 }
Chris Lattner24c8e382003-07-24 17:35:25 +00007084
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007085 if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(Src)) {
7086 if (SVI->hasOneUse()) {
7087 // Okay, we have (bitconvert (shuffle ..)). Check to see if this is
7088 // a bitconvert to a vector with the same # elts.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00007089 if (isa<VectorType>(DestTy) &&
7090 cast<VectorType>(DestTy)->getNumElements() ==
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007091 SVI->getType()->getNumElements()) {
7092 CastInst *Tmp;
7093 // If either of the operands is a cast from CI.getType(), then
7094 // evaluating the shuffle in the casted destination's type will allow
7095 // us to eliminate at least one cast.
7096 if (((Tmp = dyn_cast<CastInst>(SVI->getOperand(0))) &&
7097 Tmp->getOperand(0)->getType() == DestTy) ||
7098 ((Tmp = dyn_cast<CastInst>(SVI->getOperand(1))) &&
7099 Tmp->getOperand(0)->getType() == DestTy)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007100 Value *LHS = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
7101 SVI->getOperand(0), DestTy, &CI);
7102 Value *RHS = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
7103 SVI->getOperand(1), DestTy, &CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007104 // Return a new shuffle vector. Use the same element ID's, as we
7105 // know the vector types match #elts.
7106 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHS, RHS, SVI->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner01575b72006-05-25 23:24:33 +00007107 }
7108 }
7109 }
7110 }
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00007111 return 0;
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00007112}
7113
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007114/// GetSelectFoldableOperands - We want to turn code that looks like this:
7115/// %C = or %A, %B
7116/// %D = select %cond, %C, %A
7117/// into:
7118/// %C = select %cond, %B, 0
7119/// %D = or %A, %C
7120///
7121/// Assuming that the specified instruction is an operand to the select, return
7122/// a bitmask indicating which operands of this instruction are foldable if they
7123/// equal the other incoming value of the select.
7124///
7125static unsigned GetSelectFoldableOperands(Instruction *I) {
7126 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
7127 case Instruction::Add:
7128 case Instruction::Mul:
7129 case Instruction::And:
7130 case Instruction::Or:
7131 case Instruction::Xor:
7132 return 3; // Can fold through either operand.
7133 case Instruction::Sub: // Can only fold on the amount subtracted.
7134 case Instruction::Shl: // Can only fold on the shift amount.
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00007135 case Instruction::LShr:
7136 case Instruction::AShr:
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007137 return 1;
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007138 default:
7139 return 0; // Cannot fold
7140 }
7141}
7142
7143/// GetSelectFoldableConstant - For the same transformation as the previous
7144/// function, return the identity constant that goes into the select.
7145static Constant *GetSelectFoldableConstant(Instruction *I) {
7146 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
7147 default: assert(0 && "This cannot happen!"); abort();
7148 case Instruction::Add:
7149 case Instruction::Sub:
7150 case Instruction::Or:
7151 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007152 case Instruction::Shl:
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00007153 case Instruction::LShr:
7154 case Instruction::AShr:
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007155 return Constant::getNullValue(I->getType());
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007156 case Instruction::And:
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00007157 return Constant::getAllOnesValue(I->getType());
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007158 case Instruction::Mul:
7159 return ConstantInt::get(I->getType(), 1);
7160 }
7161}
7162
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00007163/// FoldSelectOpOp - Here we have (select c, TI, FI), and we know that TI and FI
7164/// have the same opcode and only one use each. Try to simplify this.
7165Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldSelectOpOp(SelectInst &SI, Instruction *TI,
7166 Instruction *FI) {
7167 if (TI->getNumOperands() == 1) {
7168 // If this is a non-volatile load or a cast from the same type,
7169 // merge.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007170 if (TI->isCast()) {
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00007171 if (TI->getOperand(0)->getType() != FI->getOperand(0)->getType())
7172 return 0;
7173 } else {
7174 return 0; // unknown unary op.
7175 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007176
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00007177 // Fold this by inserting a select from the input values.
7178 SelectInst *NewSI = new SelectInst(SI.getCondition(), TI->getOperand(0),
7179 FI->getOperand(0), SI.getName()+".v");
7180 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSI, SI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007181 return CastInst::create(Instruction::CastOps(TI->getOpcode()), NewSI,
7182 TI->getType());
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00007183 }
7184
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007185 // Only handle binary operators here.
7186 if (!isa<BinaryOperator>(TI))
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00007187 return 0;
7188
7189 // Figure out if the operations have any operands in common.
7190 Value *MatchOp, *OtherOpT, *OtherOpF;
7191 bool MatchIsOpZero;
7192 if (TI->getOperand(0) == FI->getOperand(0)) {
7193 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(0);
7194 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(1);
7195 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(1);
7196 MatchIsOpZero = true;
7197 } else if (TI->getOperand(1) == FI->getOperand(1)) {
7198 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(1);
7199 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(0);
7200 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(0);
7201 MatchIsOpZero = false;
7202 } else if (!TI->isCommutative()) {
7203 return 0;
7204 } else if (TI->getOperand(0) == FI->getOperand(1)) {
7205 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(0);
7206 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(1);
7207 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(0);
7208 MatchIsOpZero = true;
7209 } else if (TI->getOperand(1) == FI->getOperand(0)) {
7210 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(1);
7211 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(0);
7212 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(1);
7213 MatchIsOpZero = true;
7214 } else {
7215 return 0;
7216 }
7217
7218 // If we reach here, they do have operations in common.
7219 SelectInst *NewSI = new SelectInst(SI.getCondition(), OtherOpT,
7220 OtherOpF, SI.getName()+".v");
7221 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSI, SI);
7222
7223 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(TI)) {
7224 if (MatchIsOpZero)
7225 return BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(), MatchOp, NewSI);
7226 else
7227 return BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(), NewSI, MatchOp);
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00007228 }
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00007229 assert(0 && "Shouldn't get here");
7230 return 0;
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00007231}
7232
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +00007233Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSelectInst(SelectInst &SI) {
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00007234 Value *CondVal = SI.getCondition();
7235 Value *TrueVal = SI.getTrueValue();
7236 Value *FalseVal = SI.getFalseValue();
7237
7238 // select true, X, Y -> X
7239 // select false, X, Y -> Y
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00007240 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CondVal))
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00007241 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, C->getZExtValue() ? TrueVal : FalseVal);
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00007242
7243 // select C, X, X -> X
7244 if (TrueVal == FalseVal)
7245 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
7246
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00007247 if (isa<UndefValue>(TrueVal)) // select C, undef, X -> X
7248 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
7249 if (isa<UndefValue>(FalseVal)) // select C, X, undef -> X
7250 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
7251 if (isa<UndefValue>(CondVal)) { // select undef, X, Y -> X or Y
7252 if (isa<Constant>(TrueVal))
7253 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
7254 else
7255 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
7256 }
7257
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00007258 if (SI.getType() == Type::Int1Ty) {
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00007259 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(TrueVal)) {
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00007260 if (C->getZExtValue()) {
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00007261 // Change: A = select B, true, C --> A = or B, C
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00007262 return BinaryOperator::createOr(CondVal, FalseVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00007263 } else {
7264 // Change: A = select B, false, C --> A = and !B, C
7265 Value *NotCond =
7266 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createNot(CondVal,
7267 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00007268 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(NotCond, FalseVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00007269 }
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00007270 } else if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(FalseVal)) {
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00007271 if (C->getZExtValue() == false) {
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00007272 // Change: A = select B, C, false --> A = and B, C
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00007273 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(CondVal, TrueVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00007274 } else {
7275 // Change: A = select B, C, true --> A = or !B, C
7276 Value *NotCond =
7277 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createNot(CondVal,
7278 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00007279 return BinaryOperator::createOr(NotCond, TrueVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00007280 }
7281 }
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00007282 }
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00007283
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00007284 // Selecting between two integer constants?
7285 if (ConstantInt *TrueValC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(TrueVal))
7286 if (ConstantInt *FalseValC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(FalseVal)) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00007287 // select C, 1, 0 -> zext C to int
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00007288 if (FalseValC->isZero() && TrueValC->getValue() == 1) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007289 return CastInst::create(Instruction::ZExt, CondVal, SI.getType());
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00007290 } else if (TrueValC->isZero() && FalseValC->getValue() == 1) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00007291 // select C, 0, 1 -> zext !C to int
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00007292 Value *NotCond =
7293 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createNot(CondVal,
Chris Lattner82e14fe2004-04-09 18:19:44 +00007294 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007295 return CastInst::create(Instruction::ZExt, NotCond, SI.getType());
Chris Lattner82e14fe2004-04-09 18:19:44 +00007296 }
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00007297
7298 // FIXME: Turn select 0/-1 and -1/0 into sext from condition!
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00007299
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007300 if (ICmpInst *IC = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(SI.getCondition())) {
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00007301
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007302 // (x <s 0) ? -1 : 0 -> ashr x, 31
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00007303 if (TrueValC->isAllOnesValue() && FalseValC->isZero())
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00007304 if (ConstantInt *CmpCst = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(IC->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00007305 if (IC->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && CmpCst->isZero()) {
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00007306 // The comparison constant and the result are not neccessarily the
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007307 // same width. Make an all-ones value by inserting a AShr.
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00007308 Value *X = IC->getOperand(0);
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007309 uint32_t Bits = X->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007310 Constant *ShAmt = ConstantInt::get(X->getType(), Bits-1);
7311 Instruction *SRA = BinaryOperator::create(Instruction::AShr, X,
7312 ShAmt, "ones");
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00007313 InsertNewInstBefore(SRA, SI);
7314
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007315 // Finally, convert to the type of the select RHS. We figure out
7316 // if this requires a SExt, Trunc or BitCast based on the sizes.
7317 Instruction::CastOps opc = Instruction::BitCast;
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007318 uint32_t SRASize = SRA->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
7319 uint32_t SISize = SI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007320 if (SRASize < SISize)
7321 opc = Instruction::SExt;
7322 else if (SRASize > SISize)
7323 opc = Instruction::Trunc;
7324 return CastInst::create(opc, SRA, SI.getType());
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00007325 }
7326 }
7327
7328
7329 // If one of the constants is zero (we know they can't both be) and we
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00007330 // have an icmp instruction with zero, and we have an 'and' with the
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00007331 // non-constant value, eliminate this whole mess. This corresponds to
7332 // cases like this: ((X & 27) ? 27 : 0)
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00007333 if (TrueValC->isZero() || FalseValC->isZero())
Chris Lattner65b72ba2006-09-18 04:22:48 +00007334 if (IC->isEquality() && isa<ConstantInt>(IC->getOperand(1)) &&
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00007335 cast<Constant>(IC->getOperand(1))->isNullValue())
7336 if (Instruction *ICA = dyn_cast<Instruction>(IC->getOperand(0)))
7337 if (ICA->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007338 isa<ConstantInt>(ICA->getOperand(1)) &&
7339 (ICA->getOperand(1) == TrueValC ||
7340 ICA->getOperand(1) == FalseValC) &&
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00007341 isOneBitSet(cast<ConstantInt>(ICA->getOperand(1)))) {
7342 // Okay, now we know that everything is set up, we just don't
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007343 // know whether we have a icmp_ne or icmp_eq and whether the
7344 // true or false val is the zero.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00007345 bool ShouldNotVal = !TrueValC->isZero();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007346 ShouldNotVal ^= IC->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00007347 Value *V = ICA;
7348 if (ShouldNotVal)
7349 V = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::create(
7350 Instruction::Xor, V, ICA->getOperand(1)), SI);
7351 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, V);
7352 }
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00007353 }
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00007354 }
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00007355
7356 // See if we are selecting two values based on a comparison of the two values.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007357 if (FCmpInst *FCI = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(CondVal)) {
7358 if (FCI->getOperand(0) == TrueVal && FCI->getOperand(1) == FalseVal) {
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00007359 // Transform (X == Y) ? X : Y -> Y
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007360 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ)
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00007361 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
7362 // Transform (X != Y) ? X : Y -> X
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007363 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE)
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00007364 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
7365 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX/ABS/etc.
7366
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007367 } else if (FCI->getOperand(0) == FalseVal && FCI->getOperand(1) == TrueVal){
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00007368 // Transform (X == Y) ? Y : X -> X
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007369 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ)
Chris Lattnerfbede522004-04-11 01:39:19 +00007370 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00007371 // Transform (X != Y) ? Y : X -> Y
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007372 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE)
7373 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
7374 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX/ABS/etc.
7375 }
7376 }
7377
7378 // See if we are selecting two values based on a comparison of the two values.
7379 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(CondVal)) {
7380 if (ICI->getOperand(0) == TrueVal && ICI->getOperand(1) == FalseVal) {
7381 // Transform (X == Y) ? X : Y -> Y
7382 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
7383 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
7384 // Transform (X != Y) ? X : Y -> X
7385 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
7386 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
7387 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX/ABS/etc.
7388
7389 } else if (ICI->getOperand(0) == FalseVal && ICI->getOperand(1) == TrueVal){
7390 // Transform (X == Y) ? Y : X -> X
7391 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
7392 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
7393 // Transform (X != Y) ? Y : X -> Y
7394 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
Chris Lattnerfbede522004-04-11 01:39:19 +00007395 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00007396 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX/ABS/etc.
7397 }
7398 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007399
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00007400 if (Instruction *TI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TrueVal))
7401 if (Instruction *FI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FalseVal))
7402 if (TI->hasOneUse() && FI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00007403 Instruction *AddOp = 0, *SubOp = 0;
7404
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00007405 // Turn (select C, (op X, Y), (op X, Z)) -> (op X, (select C, Y, Z))
7406 if (TI->getOpcode() == FI->getOpcode())
7407 if (Instruction *IV = FoldSelectOpOp(SI, TI, FI))
7408 return IV;
7409
7410 // Turn select C, (X+Y), (X-Y) --> (X+(select C, Y, (-Y))). This is
7411 // even legal for FP.
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00007412 if (TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
7413 FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
7414 AddOp = FI; SubOp = TI;
7415 } else if (FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
7416 TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
7417 AddOp = TI; SubOp = FI;
7418 }
7419
7420 if (AddOp) {
7421 Value *OtherAddOp = 0;
7422 if (SubOp->getOperand(0) == AddOp->getOperand(0)) {
7423 OtherAddOp = AddOp->getOperand(1);
7424 } else if (SubOp->getOperand(0) == AddOp->getOperand(1)) {
7425 OtherAddOp = AddOp->getOperand(0);
7426 }
7427
7428 if (OtherAddOp) {
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00007429 // So at this point we know we have (Y -> OtherAddOp):
7430 // select C, (add X, Y), (sub X, Z)
7431 Value *NegVal; // Compute -Z
7432 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SubOp->getOperand(1))) {
7433 NegVal = ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
7434 } else {
7435 NegVal = InsertNewInstBefore(
7436 BinaryOperator::createNeg(SubOp->getOperand(1), "tmp"), SI);
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00007437 }
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00007438
7439 Value *NewTrueOp = OtherAddOp;
7440 Value *NewFalseOp = NegVal;
7441 if (AddOp != TI)
7442 std::swap(NewTrueOp, NewFalseOp);
7443 Instruction *NewSel =
7444 new SelectInst(CondVal, NewTrueOp,NewFalseOp,SI.getName()+".p");
7445
7446 NewSel = InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
7447 return BinaryOperator::createAdd(SubOp->getOperand(0), NewSel);
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00007448 }
7449 }
7450 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007451
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007452 // See if we can fold the select into one of our operands.
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00007453 if (SI.getType()->isInteger()) {
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007454 // See the comment above GetSelectFoldableOperands for a description of the
7455 // transformation we are doing here.
7456 if (Instruction *TVI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TrueVal))
7457 if (TVI->hasOneUse() && TVI->getNumOperands() == 2 &&
7458 !isa<Constant>(FalseVal))
7459 if (unsigned SFO = GetSelectFoldableOperands(TVI)) {
7460 unsigned OpToFold = 0;
7461 if ((SFO & 1) && FalseVal == TVI->getOperand(0)) {
7462 OpToFold = 1;
7463 } else if ((SFO & 2) && FalseVal == TVI->getOperand(1)) {
7464 OpToFold = 2;
7465 }
7466
7467 if (OpToFold) {
7468 Constant *C = GetSelectFoldableConstant(TVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007469 Instruction *NewSel =
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007470 new SelectInst(SI.getCondition(), TVI->getOperand(2-OpToFold), C);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007471 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007472 NewSel->takeName(TVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007473 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(TVI))
7474 return BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(), FalseVal, NewSel);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007475 else {
7476 assert(0 && "Unknown instruction!!");
7477 }
7478 }
7479 }
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00007480
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007481 if (Instruction *FVI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FalseVal))
7482 if (FVI->hasOneUse() && FVI->getNumOperands() == 2 &&
7483 !isa<Constant>(TrueVal))
7484 if (unsigned SFO = GetSelectFoldableOperands(FVI)) {
7485 unsigned OpToFold = 0;
7486 if ((SFO & 1) && TrueVal == FVI->getOperand(0)) {
7487 OpToFold = 1;
7488 } else if ((SFO & 2) && TrueVal == FVI->getOperand(1)) {
7489 OpToFold = 2;
7490 }
7491
7492 if (OpToFold) {
7493 Constant *C = GetSelectFoldableConstant(FVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007494 Instruction *NewSel =
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007495 new SelectInst(SI.getCondition(), C, FVI->getOperand(2-OpToFold));
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007496 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007497 NewSel->takeName(FVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007498 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FVI))
7499 return BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(), TrueVal, NewSel);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007500 else
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007501 assert(0 && "Unknown instruction!!");
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007502 }
7503 }
7504 }
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +00007505
7506 if (BinaryOperator::isNot(CondVal)) {
7507 SI.setOperand(0, BinaryOperator::getNotArgument(CondVal));
7508 SI.setOperand(1, FalseVal);
7509 SI.setOperand(2, TrueVal);
7510 return &SI;
7511 }
7512
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +00007513 return 0;
7514}
7515
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007516/// GetKnownAlignment - If the specified pointer has an alignment that we can
7517/// determine, return it, otherwise return 0.
7518static unsigned GetKnownAlignment(Value *V, TargetData *TD) {
7519 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(V)) {
7520 unsigned Align = GV->getAlignment();
7521 if (Align == 0 && TD)
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +00007522 Align = TD->getPrefTypeAlignment(GV->getType()->getElementType());
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007523 return Align;
7524 } else if (AllocationInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocationInst>(V)) {
7525 unsigned Align = AI->getAlignment();
7526 if (Align == 0 && TD) {
7527 if (isa<AllocaInst>(AI))
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +00007528 Align = TD->getPrefTypeAlignment(AI->getType()->getElementType());
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007529 else if (isa<MallocInst>(AI)) {
7530 // Malloc returns maximally aligned memory.
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +00007531 Align = TD->getABITypeAlignment(AI->getType()->getElementType());
Chris Lattner58092e32007-01-20 22:35:55 +00007532 Align =
7533 std::max(Align,
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +00007534 (unsigned)TD->getABITypeAlignment(Type::DoubleTy));
Chris Lattner58092e32007-01-20 22:35:55 +00007535 Align =
7536 std::max(Align,
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +00007537 (unsigned)TD->getABITypeAlignment(Type::Int64Ty));
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007538 }
7539 }
7540 return Align;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007541 } else if (isa<BitCastInst>(V) ||
Chris Lattner51c26e92006-03-07 01:28:57 +00007542 (isa<ConstantExpr>(V) &&
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007543 cast<ConstantExpr>(V)->getOpcode() == Instruction::BitCast)) {
Chris Lattner51c26e92006-03-07 01:28:57 +00007544 User *CI = cast<User>(V);
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007545 if (isa<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType()))
7546 return GetKnownAlignment(CI->getOperand(0), TD);
7547 return 0;
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007548 } else if (User *GEPI = dyn_castGetElementPtr(V)) {
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007549 unsigned BaseAlignment = GetKnownAlignment(GEPI->getOperand(0), TD);
7550 if (BaseAlignment == 0) return 0;
7551
7552 // If all indexes are zero, it is just the alignment of the base pointer.
7553 bool AllZeroOperands = true;
7554 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPI->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
7555 if (!isa<Constant>(GEPI->getOperand(i)) ||
7556 !cast<Constant>(GEPI->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
7557 AllZeroOperands = false;
7558 break;
7559 }
7560 if (AllZeroOperands)
7561 return BaseAlignment;
7562
7563 // Otherwise, if the base alignment is >= the alignment we expect for the
7564 // base pointer type, then we know that the resultant pointer is aligned at
7565 // least as much as its type requires.
7566 if (!TD) return 0;
7567
7568 const Type *BasePtrTy = GEPI->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner58092e32007-01-20 22:35:55 +00007569 const PointerType *PtrTy = cast<PointerType>(BasePtrTy);
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +00007570 if (TD->getABITypeAlignment(PtrTy->getElementType())
Chris Lattner51c26e92006-03-07 01:28:57 +00007571 <= BaseAlignment) {
7572 const Type *GEPTy = GEPI->getType();
Chris Lattner58092e32007-01-20 22:35:55 +00007573 const PointerType *GEPPtrTy = cast<PointerType>(GEPTy);
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +00007574 return TD->getABITypeAlignment(GEPPtrTy->getElementType());
Chris Lattner51c26e92006-03-07 01:28:57 +00007575 }
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007576 return 0;
7577 }
7578 return 0;
7579}
7580
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +00007581
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00007582/// visitCallInst - CallInst simplification. This mostly only handles folding
7583/// of intrinsic instructions. For normal calls, it allows visitCallSite to do
7584/// the heavy lifting.
7585///
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007586Instruction *InstCombiner::visitCallInst(CallInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00007587 IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(&CI);
7588 if (!II) return visitCallSite(&CI);
7589
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00007590 // Intrinsics cannot occur in an invoke, so handle them here instead of in
7591 // visitCallSite.
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00007592 if (MemIntrinsic *MI = dyn_cast<MemIntrinsic>(II)) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007593 bool Changed = false;
7594
7595 // memmove/cpy/set of zero bytes is a noop.
7596 if (Constant *NumBytes = dyn_cast<Constant>(MI->getLength())) {
7597 if (NumBytes->isNullValue()) return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
7598
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007599 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(NumBytes))
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007600 if (CI->getZExtValue() == 1) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007601 // Replace the instruction with just byte operations. We would
7602 // transform other cases to loads/stores, but we don't know if
7603 // alignment is sufficient.
7604 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00007605 }
7606
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007607 // If we have a memmove and the source operation is a constant global,
7608 // then the source and dest pointers can't alias, so we can change this
7609 // into a call to memcpy.
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007610 if (MemMoveInst *MMI = dyn_cast<MemMoveInst>(II)) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007611 if (GlobalVariable *GVSrc = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(MMI->getSource()))
7612 if (GVSrc->isConstant()) {
7613 Module *M = CI.getParent()->getParent()->getParent();
Chris Lattner21959392006-03-03 01:34:17 +00007614 const char *Name;
Andrew Lenharth8ed4c472006-11-03 22:45:50 +00007615 if (CI.getCalledFunction()->getFunctionType()->getParamType(2) ==
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007616 Type::Int32Ty)
Chris Lattner21959392006-03-03 01:34:17 +00007617 Name = "llvm.memcpy.i32";
7618 else
7619 Name = "llvm.memcpy.i64";
Chris Lattner92141962007-01-07 06:58:05 +00007620 Constant *MemCpy = M->getOrInsertFunction(Name,
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007621 CI.getCalledFunction()->getFunctionType());
7622 CI.setOperand(0, MemCpy);
7623 Changed = true;
7624 }
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007625 }
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007626
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007627 // If we can determine a pointer alignment that is bigger than currently
7628 // set, update the alignment.
7629 if (isa<MemCpyInst>(MI) || isa<MemMoveInst>(MI)) {
7630 unsigned Alignment1 = GetKnownAlignment(MI->getOperand(1), TD);
7631 unsigned Alignment2 = GetKnownAlignment(MI->getOperand(2), TD);
7632 unsigned Align = std::min(Alignment1, Alignment2);
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007633 if (MI->getAlignment()->getZExtValue() < Align) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007634 MI->setAlignment(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Align));
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007635 Changed = true;
7636 }
7637 } else if (isa<MemSetInst>(MI)) {
7638 unsigned Alignment = GetKnownAlignment(MI->getDest(), TD);
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007639 if (MI->getAlignment()->getZExtValue() < Alignment) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007640 MI->setAlignment(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Alignment));
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007641 Changed = true;
7642 }
7643 }
7644
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00007645 if (Changed) return II;
Chris Lattnera728ddc2006-01-13 21:28:09 +00007646 } else {
7647 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
7648 default: break;
Chris Lattner82ed58f2006-04-02 05:30:25 +00007649 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_lvx:
7650 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_lvxl:
Chris Lattnerfd6bdf02006-04-17 22:26:56 +00007651 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_loadu_ps:
7652 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_loadu_pd:
7653 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_loadu_dq:
7654 // Turn PPC lvx -> load if the pointer is known aligned.
7655 // Turn X86 loadups -> load if the pointer is known aligned.
Chris Lattner82ed58f2006-04-02 05:30:25 +00007656 if (GetKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(1), TD) >= 16) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007657 Value *Ptr = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, II->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007658 PointerType::get(II->getType()), CI);
Chris Lattner82ed58f2006-04-02 05:30:25 +00007659 return new LoadInst(Ptr);
7660 }
7661 break;
7662 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_stvx:
7663 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_stvxl:
7664 // Turn stvx -> store if the pointer is known aligned.
7665 if (GetKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(2), TD) >= 16) {
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007666 const Type *OpPtrTy = PointerType::get(II->getOperand(1)->getType());
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007667 Value *Ptr = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, II->getOperand(2),
7668 OpPtrTy, CI);
Chris Lattner82ed58f2006-04-02 05:30:25 +00007669 return new StoreInst(II->getOperand(1), Ptr);
7670 }
7671 break;
Chris Lattnerfd6bdf02006-04-17 22:26:56 +00007672 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_storeu_ps:
7673 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_storeu_pd:
7674 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_storeu_dq:
7675 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_storel_dq:
7676 // Turn X86 storeu -> store if the pointer is known aligned.
7677 if (GetKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(1), TD) >= 16) {
7678 const Type *OpPtrTy = PointerType::get(II->getOperand(2)->getType());
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007679 Value *Ptr = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, II->getOperand(1),
7680 OpPtrTy, CI);
Chris Lattnerfd6bdf02006-04-17 22:26:56 +00007681 return new StoreInst(II->getOperand(2), Ptr);
7682 }
7683 break;
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00007684
7685 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_cvttss2si: {
7686 // These intrinsics only demands the 0th element of its input vector. If
7687 // we can simplify the input based on that, do so now.
7688 uint64_t UndefElts;
7689 if (Value *V = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(1), 1,
7690 UndefElts)) {
7691 II->setOperand(1, V);
7692 return II;
7693 }
7694 break;
7695 }
7696
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007697 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_vperm:
7698 // Turn vperm(V1,V2,mask) -> shuffle(V1,V2,mask) if mask is a constant.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00007699 if (ConstantVector *Mask = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(II->getOperand(3))) {
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007700 assert(Mask->getNumOperands() == 16 && "Bad type for intrinsic!");
7701
7702 // Check that all of the elements are integer constants or undefs.
7703 bool AllEltsOk = true;
7704 for (unsigned i = 0; i != 16; ++i) {
7705 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(Mask->getOperand(i)) &&
7706 !isa<UndefValue>(Mask->getOperand(i))) {
7707 AllEltsOk = false;
7708 break;
7709 }
7710 }
7711
7712 if (AllEltsOk) {
7713 // Cast the input vectors to byte vectors.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007714 Value *Op0 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
7715 II->getOperand(1), Mask->getType(), CI);
7716 Value *Op1 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
7717 II->getOperand(2), Mask->getType(), CI);
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007718 Value *Result = UndefValue::get(Op0->getType());
7719
7720 // Only extract each element once.
7721 Value *ExtractedElts[32];
7722 memset(ExtractedElts, 0, sizeof(ExtractedElts));
7723
7724 for (unsigned i = 0; i != 16; ++i) {
7725 if (isa<UndefValue>(Mask->getOperand(i)))
7726 continue;
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +00007727 unsigned Idx=cast<ConstantInt>(Mask->getOperand(i))->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007728 Idx &= 31; // Match the hardware behavior.
7729
7730 if (ExtractedElts[Idx] == 0) {
7731 Instruction *Elt =
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00007732 new ExtractElementInst(Idx < 16 ? Op0 : Op1, Idx&15, "tmp");
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007733 InsertNewInstBefore(Elt, CI);
7734 ExtractedElts[Idx] = Elt;
7735 }
7736
7737 // Insert this value into the result vector.
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00007738 Result = new InsertElementInst(Result, ExtractedElts[Idx], i,"tmp");
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007739 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(Result), CI);
7740 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007741 return CastInst::create(Instruction::BitCast, Result, CI.getType());
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007742 }
7743 }
7744 break;
7745
Chris Lattnera728ddc2006-01-13 21:28:09 +00007746 case Intrinsic::stackrestore: {
7747 // If the save is right next to the restore, remove the restore. This can
7748 // happen when variable allocas are DCE'd.
7749 if (IntrinsicInst *SS = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(II->getOperand(1))) {
7750 if (SS->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::stacksave) {
7751 BasicBlock::iterator BI = SS;
7752 if (&*++BI == II)
7753 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
7754 }
7755 }
7756
7757 // If the stack restore is in a return/unwind block and if there are no
7758 // allocas or calls between the restore and the return, nuke the restore.
7759 TerminatorInst *TI = II->getParent()->getTerminator();
7760 if (isa<ReturnInst>(TI) || isa<UnwindInst>(TI)) {
7761 BasicBlock::iterator BI = II;
7762 bool CannotRemove = false;
7763 for (++BI; &*BI != TI; ++BI) {
7764 if (isa<AllocaInst>(BI) ||
7765 (isa<CallInst>(BI) && !isa<IntrinsicInst>(BI))) {
7766 CannotRemove = true;
7767 break;
7768 }
7769 }
7770 if (!CannotRemove)
7771 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
7772 }
7773 break;
7774 }
7775 }
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007776 }
7777
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00007778 return visitCallSite(II);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007779}
7780
7781// InvokeInst simplification
7782//
7783Instruction *InstCombiner::visitInvokeInst(InvokeInst &II) {
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00007784 return visitCallSite(&II);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007785}
7786
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00007787// visitCallSite - Improvements for call and invoke instructions.
7788//
7789Instruction *InstCombiner::visitCallSite(CallSite CS) {
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00007790 bool Changed = false;
7791
7792 // If the callee is a constexpr cast of a function, attempt to move the cast
7793 // to the arguments of the call/invoke.
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00007794 if (transformConstExprCastCall(CS)) return 0;
7795
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00007796 Value *Callee = CS.getCalledValue();
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00007797
Chris Lattner08b22ec2005-05-13 07:09:09 +00007798 if (Function *CalleeF = dyn_cast<Function>(Callee))
7799 if (CalleeF->getCallingConv() != CS.getCallingConv()) {
7800 Instruction *OldCall = CS.getInstruction();
7801 // If the call and callee calling conventions don't match, this call must
7802 // be unreachable, as the call is undefined.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00007803 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(),
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00007804 UndefValue::get(PointerType::get(Type::Int1Ty)), OldCall);
Chris Lattner08b22ec2005-05-13 07:09:09 +00007805 if (!OldCall->use_empty())
7806 OldCall->replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(OldCall->getType()));
7807 if (isa<CallInst>(OldCall)) // Not worth removing an invoke here.
7808 return EraseInstFromFunction(*OldCall);
7809 return 0;
7810 }
7811
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00007812 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Callee) || isa<UndefValue>(Callee)) {
7813 // This instruction is not reachable, just remove it. We insert a store to
7814 // undef so that we know that this code is not reachable, despite the fact
7815 // that we can't modify the CFG here.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00007816 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(),
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00007817 UndefValue::get(PointerType::get(Type::Int1Ty)),
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00007818 CS.getInstruction());
7819
7820 if (!CS.getInstruction()->use_empty())
7821 CS.getInstruction()->
7822 replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(CS.getInstruction()->getType()));
7823
7824 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(CS.getInstruction())) {
7825 // Don't break the CFG, insert a dummy cond branch.
7826 new BranchInst(II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00007827 ConstantInt::getTrue(), II);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00007828 }
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00007829 return EraseInstFromFunction(*CS.getInstruction());
7830 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00007831
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00007832 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(Callee->getType());
7833 const FunctionType *FTy = cast<FunctionType>(PTy->getElementType());
7834 if (FTy->isVarArg()) {
7835 // See if we can optimize any arguments passed through the varargs area of
7836 // the call.
7837 for (CallSite::arg_iterator I = CS.arg_begin()+FTy->getNumParams(),
7838 E = CS.arg_end(); I != E; ++I)
7839 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(*I)) {
7840 // If this cast does not effect the value passed through the varargs
7841 // area, we can eliminate the use of the cast.
7842 Value *Op = CI->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007843 if (CI->isLosslessCast()) {
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00007844 *I = Op;
7845 Changed = true;
7846 }
7847 }
7848 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007849
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00007850 return Changed ? CS.getInstruction() : 0;
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00007851}
7852
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007853// transformConstExprCastCall - If the callee is a constexpr cast of a function,
7854// attempt to move the cast to the arguments of the call/invoke.
7855//
7856bool InstCombiner::transformConstExprCastCall(CallSite CS) {
7857 if (!isa<ConstantExpr>(CS.getCalledValue())) return false;
7858 ConstantExpr *CE = cast<ConstantExpr>(CS.getCalledValue());
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007859 if (CE->getOpcode() != Instruction::BitCast ||
7860 !isa<Function>(CE->getOperand(0)))
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007861 return false;
Reid Spencer8863f182004-07-18 00:38:32 +00007862 Function *Callee = cast<Function>(CE->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007863 Instruction *Caller = CS.getInstruction();
7864
7865 // Okay, this is a cast from a function to a different type. Unless doing so
7866 // would cause a type conversion of one of our arguments, change this call to
7867 // be a direct call with arguments casted to the appropriate types.
7868 //
7869 const FunctionType *FT = Callee->getFunctionType();
7870 const Type *OldRetTy = Caller->getType();
7871
Chris Lattnera2b18de2007-05-19 06:51:32 +00007872 const FunctionType *ActualFT =
7873 cast<FunctionType>(cast<PointerType>(CE->getType())->getElementType());
7874
7875 // If the parameter attributes don't match up, don't do the xform. We don't
7876 // want to lose an sret attribute or something.
7877 if (FT->getParamAttrs() != ActualFT->getParamAttrs())
7878 return false;
7879
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00007880 // Check to see if we are changing the return type...
7881 if (OldRetTy != FT->getReturnType()) {
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +00007882 if (Callee->isDeclaration() && !Caller->use_empty() &&
Chris Lattner46013f42007-01-06 19:53:32 +00007883 // Conversion is ok if changing from pointer to int of same size.
7884 !(isa<PointerType>(FT->getReturnType()) &&
7885 TD->getIntPtrType() == OldRetTy))
Chris Lattnerec479922007-01-06 02:09:32 +00007886 return false; // Cannot transform this return value.
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00007887
7888 // If the callsite is an invoke instruction, and the return value is used by
7889 // a PHI node in a successor, we cannot change the return type of the call
7890 // because there is no place to put the cast instruction (without breaking
7891 // the critical edge). Bail out in this case.
7892 if (!Caller->use_empty())
7893 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller))
7894 for (Value::use_iterator UI = II->use_begin(), E = II->use_end();
7895 UI != E; ++UI)
7896 if (PHINode *PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(*UI))
7897 if (PN->getParent() == II->getNormalDest() ||
Chris Lattneraeb2a1d2004-02-08 21:44:31 +00007898 PN->getParent() == II->getUnwindDest())
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00007899 return false;
7900 }
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007901
7902 unsigned NumActualArgs = unsigned(CS.arg_end()-CS.arg_begin());
7903 unsigned NumCommonArgs = std::min(FT->getNumParams(), NumActualArgs);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007904
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007905 CallSite::arg_iterator AI = CS.arg_begin();
7906 for (unsigned i = 0, e = NumCommonArgs; i != e; ++i, ++AI) {
7907 const Type *ParamTy = FT->getParamType(i);
Andrew Lenharthb8e604c2006-06-28 01:01:52 +00007908 const Type *ActTy = (*AI)->getType();
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007909 ConstantInt *c = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(*AI);
Dale Johannesen16ff3042007-04-04 19:16:42 +00007910 //Some conversions are safe even if we do not have a body.
Andrew Lenharthb8e604c2006-06-28 01:01:52 +00007911 //Either we can cast directly, or we can upconvert the argument
Chris Lattnerec479922007-01-06 02:09:32 +00007912 bool isConvertible = ActTy == ParamTy ||
Chris Lattner46013f42007-01-06 19:53:32 +00007913 (isa<PointerType>(ParamTy) && isa<PointerType>(ActTy)) ||
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00007914 (ParamTy->isInteger() && ActTy->isInteger() &&
Reid Spencerabaa8ca2007-01-08 16:32:00 +00007915 ParamTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() >= ActTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) ||
7916 (c && ParamTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() >= ActTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()
Zhou Sheng0fc50952007-03-25 05:01:29 +00007917 && c->getValue().isStrictlyPositive());
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +00007918 if (Callee->isDeclaration() && !isConvertible) return false;
Dale Johannesen16ff3042007-04-04 19:16:42 +00007919
7920 // Most other conversions can be done if we have a body, even if these
7921 // lose information, e.g. int->short.
7922 // Some conversions cannot be done at all, e.g. float to pointer.
7923 // Logic here parallels CastInst::getCastOpcode (the design there
7924 // requires legality checks like this be done before calling it).
7925 if (ParamTy->isInteger()) {
7926 if (const VectorType *VActTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(ActTy)) {
7927 if (VActTy->getBitWidth() != ParamTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits())
7928 return false;
7929 }
7930 if (!ActTy->isInteger() && !ActTy->isFloatingPoint() &&
7931 !isa<PointerType>(ActTy))
7932 return false;
7933 } else if (ParamTy->isFloatingPoint()) {
7934 if (const VectorType *VActTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(ActTy)) {
7935 if (VActTy->getBitWidth() != ParamTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits())
7936 return false;
7937 }
7938 if (!ActTy->isInteger() && !ActTy->isFloatingPoint())
7939 return false;
7940 } else if (const VectorType *VParamTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(ParamTy)) {
7941 if (const VectorType *VActTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(ActTy)) {
7942 if (VActTy->getBitWidth() != VParamTy->getBitWidth())
7943 return false;
7944 }
7945 if (VParamTy->getBitWidth() != ActTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits())
7946 return false;
7947 } else if (isa<PointerType>(ParamTy)) {
7948 if (!ActTy->isInteger() && !isa<PointerType>(ActTy))
7949 return false;
7950 } else {
7951 return false;
7952 }
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007953 }
7954
7955 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs && !FT->isVarArg() &&
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +00007956 Callee->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007957 return false; // Do not delete arguments unless we have a function body...
7958
7959 // Okay, we decided that this is a safe thing to do: go ahead and start
7960 // inserting cast instructions as necessary...
7961 std::vector<Value*> Args;
7962 Args.reserve(NumActualArgs);
7963
7964 AI = CS.arg_begin();
7965 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumCommonArgs; ++i, ++AI) {
7966 const Type *ParamTy = FT->getParamType(i);
7967 if ((*AI)->getType() == ParamTy) {
7968 Args.push_back(*AI);
7969 } else {
Reid Spencer8a903db2006-12-18 08:47:13 +00007970 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(*AI,
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007971 false, ParamTy, false);
Reid Spencer8a903db2006-12-18 08:47:13 +00007972 CastInst *NewCast = CastInst::create(opcode, *AI, ParamTy, "tmp");
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007973 Args.push_back(InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, *Caller));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007974 }
7975 }
7976
7977 // If the function takes more arguments than the call was taking, add them
7978 // now...
7979 for (unsigned i = NumCommonArgs; i != FT->getNumParams(); ++i)
7980 Args.push_back(Constant::getNullValue(FT->getParamType(i)));
7981
7982 // If we are removing arguments to the function, emit an obnoxious warning...
7983 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs)
7984 if (!FT->isVarArg()) {
Bill Wendlinge8156192006-12-07 01:30:32 +00007985 cerr << "WARNING: While resolving call to function '"
7986 << Callee->getName() << "' arguments were dropped!\n";
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007987 } else {
7988 // Add all of the arguments in their promoted form to the arg list...
7989 for (unsigned i = FT->getNumParams(); i != NumActualArgs; ++i, ++AI) {
7990 const Type *PTy = getPromotedType((*AI)->getType());
7991 if (PTy != (*AI)->getType()) {
7992 // Must promote to pass through va_arg area!
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007993 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(*AI, false,
7994 PTy, false);
Reid Spencer8a903db2006-12-18 08:47:13 +00007995 Instruction *Cast = CastInst::create(opcode, *AI, PTy, "tmp");
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007996 InsertNewInstBefore(Cast, *Caller);
7997 Args.push_back(Cast);
7998 } else {
7999 Args.push_back(*AI);
8000 }
8001 }
8002 }
8003
8004 if (FT->getReturnType() == Type::VoidTy)
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00008005 Caller->setName(""); // Void type should not have a name.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008006
8007 Instruction *NC;
8008 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
Chris Lattneraeb2a1d2004-02-08 21:44:31 +00008009 NC = new InvokeInst(Callee, II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
Chris Lattner93e985f2007-02-13 02:10:56 +00008010 &Args[0], Args.size(), Caller->getName(), Caller);
Chris Lattnere4370262005-05-14 12:25:32 +00008011 cast<InvokeInst>(II)->setCallingConv(II->getCallingConv());
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008012 } else {
Chris Lattner93e985f2007-02-13 02:10:56 +00008013 NC = new CallInst(Callee, &Args[0], Args.size(), Caller->getName(), Caller);
Chris Lattnera9e92112005-05-06 06:48:21 +00008014 if (cast<CallInst>(Caller)->isTailCall())
8015 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setTailCall();
Chris Lattnere4370262005-05-14 12:25:32 +00008016 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setCallingConv(cast<CallInst>(Caller)->getCallingConv());
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008017 }
8018
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00008019 // Insert a cast of the return type as necessary.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008020 Value *NV = NC;
8021 if (Caller->getType() != NV->getType() && !Caller->use_empty()) {
8022 if (NV->getType() != Type::VoidTy) {
Reid Spencer8a903db2006-12-18 08:47:13 +00008023 const Type *CallerTy = Caller->getType();
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00008024 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(NC, false,
8025 CallerTy, false);
Reid Spencer8a903db2006-12-18 08:47:13 +00008026 NV = NC = CastInst::create(opcode, NC, CallerTy, "tmp");
Chris Lattnerbb609042003-10-30 00:46:41 +00008027
8028 // If this is an invoke instruction, we should insert it after the first
8029 // non-phi, instruction in the normal successor block.
8030 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
8031 BasicBlock::iterator I = II->getNormalDest()->begin();
8032 while (isa<PHINode>(I)) ++I;
8033 InsertNewInstBefore(NC, *I);
8034 } else {
8035 // Otherwise, it's a call, just insert cast right after the call instr
8036 InsertNewInstBefore(NC, *Caller);
8037 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00008038 AddUsersToWorkList(*Caller);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008039 } else {
Chris Lattnerc30bda72004-10-17 21:22:38 +00008040 NV = UndefValue::get(Caller->getType());
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008041 }
8042 }
8043
8044 if (Caller->getType() != Type::VoidTy && !Caller->use_empty())
8045 Caller->replaceAllUsesWith(NV);
Chris Lattnerf22a5c62007-03-02 19:59:19 +00008046 Caller->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00008047 RemoveFromWorkList(Caller);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008048 return true;
8049}
8050
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00008051/// FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI - If we have something like phi [add (a,b), add(c,d)]
8052/// and if a/b/c/d and the add's all have a single use, turn this into two phi's
8053/// and a single binop.
8054Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN) {
8055 Instruction *FirstInst = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0));
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008056 assert(isa<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst) || isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst) ||
8057 isa<CmpInst>(FirstInst));
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00008058 unsigned Opc = FirstInst->getOpcode();
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00008059 Value *LHSVal = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
8060 Value *RHSVal = FirstInst->getOperand(1);
8061
8062 const Type *LHSType = LHSVal->getType();
8063 const Type *RHSType = RHSVal->getType();
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00008064
8065 // Scan to see if all operands are the same opcode, all have one use, and all
8066 // kill their operands (i.e. the operands have one use).
Chris Lattnera90a24c2006-11-01 04:55:47 +00008067 for (unsigned i = 0; i != PN.getNumIncomingValues(); ++i) {
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00008068 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
Chris Lattnera90a24c2006-11-01 04:55:47 +00008069 if (!I || I->getOpcode() != Opc || !I->hasOneUse() ||
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008070 // Verify type of the LHS matches so we don't fold cmp's of different
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00008071 // types or GEP's with different index types.
8072 I->getOperand(0)->getType() != LHSType ||
8073 I->getOperand(1)->getType() != RHSType)
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00008074 return 0;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008075
8076 // If they are CmpInst instructions, check their predicates
8077 if (Opc == Instruction::ICmp || Opc == Instruction::FCmp)
8078 if (cast<CmpInst>(I)->getPredicate() !=
8079 cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst)->getPredicate())
8080 return 0;
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00008081
8082 // Keep track of which operand needs a phi node.
8083 if (I->getOperand(0) != LHSVal) LHSVal = 0;
8084 if (I->getOperand(1) != RHSVal) RHSVal = 0;
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00008085 }
8086
Chris Lattner53738a42006-11-08 19:42:28 +00008087 // Otherwise, this is safe to transform, determine if it is profitable.
8088
8089 // If this is a GEP, and if the index (not the pointer) needs a PHI, bail out.
8090 // Indexes are often folded into load/store instructions, so we don't want to
8091 // hide them behind a phi.
8092 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst) && RHSVal == 0)
8093 return 0;
8094
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00008095 Value *InLHS = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00008096 Value *InRHS = FirstInst->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner53738a42006-11-08 19:42:28 +00008097 PHINode *NewLHS = 0, *NewRHS = 0;
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00008098 if (LHSVal == 0) {
8099 NewLHS = new PHINode(LHSType, FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getName()+".pn");
8100 NewLHS->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
8101 NewLHS->addIncoming(InLHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00008102 InsertNewInstBefore(NewLHS, PN);
8103 LHSVal = NewLHS;
8104 }
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00008105
8106 if (RHSVal == 0) {
8107 NewRHS = new PHINode(RHSType, FirstInst->getOperand(1)->getName()+".pn");
8108 NewRHS->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
8109 NewRHS->addIncoming(InRHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00008110 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRHS, PN);
8111 RHSVal = NewRHS;
8112 }
8113
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00008114 // Add all operands to the new PHIs.
8115 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
8116 if (NewLHS) {
8117 Value *NewInLHS =cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(0);
8118 NewLHS->addIncoming(NewInLHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
8119 }
8120 if (NewRHS) {
8121 Value *NewInRHS =cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(1);
8122 NewRHS->addIncoming(NewInRHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
8123 }
8124 }
8125
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00008126 if (BinaryOperator *BinOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst))
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00008127 return BinaryOperator::create(BinOp->getOpcode(), LHSVal, RHSVal);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008128 else if (CmpInst *CIOp = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst))
8129 return CmpInst::create(CIOp->getOpcode(), CIOp->getPredicate(), LHSVal,
8130 RHSVal);
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00008131 else {
8132 assert(isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst));
8133 return new GetElementPtrInst(LHSVal, RHSVal);
8134 }
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00008135}
8136
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00008137/// isSafeToSinkLoad - Return true if we know that it is safe sink the load out
8138/// of the block that defines it. This means that it must be obvious the value
8139/// of the load is not changed from the point of the load to the end of the
8140/// block it is in.
Chris Lattnerfd905ca2007-02-01 22:30:07 +00008141///
8142/// Finally, it is safe, but not profitable, to sink a load targetting a
8143/// non-address-taken alloca. Doing so will cause us to not promote the alloca
8144/// to a register.
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00008145static bool isSafeToSinkLoad(LoadInst *L) {
8146 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = L, E = L->getParent()->end();
8147
8148 for (++BBI; BBI != E; ++BBI)
8149 if (BBI->mayWriteToMemory())
8150 return false;
Chris Lattnerfd905ca2007-02-01 22:30:07 +00008151
8152 // Check for non-address taken alloca. If not address-taken already, it isn't
8153 // profitable to do this xform.
8154 if (AllocaInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocaInst>(L->getOperand(0))) {
8155 bool isAddressTaken = false;
8156 for (Value::use_iterator UI = AI->use_begin(), E = AI->use_end();
8157 UI != E; ++UI) {
8158 if (isa<LoadInst>(UI)) continue;
8159 if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(*UI)) {
8160 // If storing TO the alloca, then the address isn't taken.
8161 if (SI->getOperand(1) == AI) continue;
8162 }
8163 isAddressTaken = true;
8164 break;
8165 }
8166
8167 if (!isAddressTaken)
8168 return false;
8169 }
8170
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00008171 return true;
8172}
8173
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008174
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00008175// FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI - If all operands to a PHI node are the same "unary"
8176// operator and they all are only used by the PHI, PHI together their
8177// inputs, and do the operation once, to the result of the PHI.
8178Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN) {
8179 Instruction *FirstInst = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0));
8180
8181 // Scan the instruction, looking for input operations that can be folded away.
8182 // If all input operands to the phi are the same instruction (e.g. a cast from
8183 // the same type or "+42") we can pull the operation through the PHI, reducing
8184 // code size and simplifying code.
8185 Constant *ConstantOp = 0;
8186 const Type *CastSrcTy = 0;
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00008187 bool isVolatile = false;
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00008188 if (isa<CastInst>(FirstInst)) {
8189 CastSrcTy = FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getType();
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008190 } else if (isa<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst) || isa<CmpInst>(FirstInst)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008191 // Can fold binop, compare or shift here if the RHS is a constant,
8192 // otherwise call FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI.
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00008193 ConstantOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(FirstInst->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00008194 if (ConstantOp == 0)
8195 return FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PN);
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00008196 } else if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(FirstInst)) {
8197 isVolatile = LI->isVolatile();
8198 // We can't sink the load if the loaded value could be modified between the
8199 // load and the PHI.
8200 if (LI->getParent() != PN.getIncomingBlock(0) ||
8201 !isSafeToSinkLoad(LI))
8202 return 0;
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00008203 } else if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst)) {
Chris Lattner53738a42006-11-08 19:42:28 +00008204 if (FirstInst->getNumOperands() == 2)
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00008205 return FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PN);
8206 // Can't handle general GEPs yet.
8207 return 0;
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00008208 } else {
8209 return 0; // Cannot fold this operation.
8210 }
8211
8212 // Check to see if all arguments are the same operation.
8213 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
8214 if (!isa<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))) return 0;
8215 Instruction *I = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008216 if (!I->hasOneUse() || !I->isSameOperationAs(FirstInst))
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00008217 return 0;
8218 if (CastSrcTy) {
8219 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() != CastSrcTy)
8220 return 0; // Cast operation must match.
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00008221 } else if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(I)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008222 // We can't sink the load if the loaded value could be modified between
8223 // the load and the PHI.
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00008224 if (LI->isVolatile() != isVolatile ||
8225 LI->getParent() != PN.getIncomingBlock(i) ||
8226 !isSafeToSinkLoad(LI))
8227 return 0;
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00008228 } else if (I->getOperand(1) != ConstantOp) {
8229 return 0;
8230 }
8231 }
8232
8233 // Okay, they are all the same operation. Create a new PHI node of the
8234 // correct type, and PHI together all of the LHS's of the instructions.
8235 PHINode *NewPN = new PHINode(FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getType(),
8236 PN.getName()+".in");
Chris Lattner55517062005-01-29 00:39:08 +00008237 NewPN->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
Chris Lattnerb5893442004-11-14 19:29:34 +00008238
8239 Value *InVal = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
8240 NewPN->addIncoming(InVal, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00008241
8242 // Add all operands to the new PHI.
Chris Lattnerb5893442004-11-14 19:29:34 +00008243 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
8244 Value *NewInVal = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(0);
8245 if (NewInVal != InVal)
8246 InVal = 0;
8247 NewPN->addIncoming(NewInVal, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
8248 }
8249
8250 Value *PhiVal;
8251 if (InVal) {
8252 // The new PHI unions all of the same values together. This is really
8253 // common, so we handle it intelligently here for compile-time speed.
8254 PhiVal = InVal;
8255 delete NewPN;
8256 } else {
8257 InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, PN);
8258 PhiVal = NewPN;
8259 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008260
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00008261 // Insert and return the new operation.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008262 if (CastInst* FirstCI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(FirstInst))
8263 return CastInst::create(FirstCI->getOpcode(), PhiVal, PN.getType());
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +00008264 else if (isa<LoadInst>(FirstInst))
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00008265 return new LoadInst(PhiVal, "", isVolatile);
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00008266 else if (BinaryOperator *BinOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst))
Chris Lattnerb5893442004-11-14 19:29:34 +00008267 return BinaryOperator::create(BinOp->getOpcode(), PhiVal, ConstantOp);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008268 else if (CmpInst *CIOp = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst))
8269 return CmpInst::create(CIOp->getOpcode(), CIOp->getPredicate(),
8270 PhiVal, ConstantOp);
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00008271 else
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008272 assert(0 && "Unknown operation");
Jeff Cohenca5183d2007-03-05 00:00:42 +00008273 return 0;
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00008274}
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +00008275
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +00008276/// DeadPHICycle - Return true if this PHI node is only used by a PHI node cycle
8277/// that is dead.
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +00008278static bool DeadPHICycle(PHINode *PN,
8279 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> &PotentiallyDeadPHIs) {
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +00008280 if (PN->use_empty()) return true;
8281 if (!PN->hasOneUse()) return false;
8282
8283 // Remember this node, and if we find the cycle, return.
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +00008284 if (!PotentiallyDeadPHIs.insert(PN))
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +00008285 return true;
8286
8287 if (PHINode *PU = dyn_cast<PHINode>(PN->use_back()))
8288 return DeadPHICycle(PU, PotentiallyDeadPHIs);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008289
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +00008290 return false;
8291}
8292
Chris Lattner473945d2002-05-06 18:06:38 +00008293// PHINode simplification
8294//
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00008295Instruction *InstCombiner::visitPHINode(PHINode &PN) {
Owen Andersonb64ab872006-07-10 22:15:25 +00008296 // If LCSSA is around, don't mess with Phi nodes
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +00008297 if (MustPreserveLCSSA) return 0;
Owen Andersond1b78a12006-07-10 19:03:49 +00008298
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +00008299 if (Value *V = PN.hasConstantValue())
8300 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, V);
8301
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +00008302 // If all PHI operands are the same operation, pull them through the PHI,
8303 // reducing code size.
8304 if (isa<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0)) &&
8305 PN.getIncomingValue(0)->hasOneUse())
8306 if (Instruction *Result = FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PN))
8307 return Result;
8308
8309 // If this is a trivial cycle in the PHI node graph, remove it. Basically, if
8310 // this PHI only has a single use (a PHI), and if that PHI only has one use (a
8311 // PHI)... break the cycle.
Chris Lattnerff9f13a2007-01-15 07:30:06 +00008312 if (PN.hasOneUse()) {
8313 Instruction *PHIUser = cast<Instruction>(PN.use_back());
8314 if (PHINode *PU = dyn_cast<PHINode>(PHIUser)) {
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +00008315 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> PotentiallyDeadPHIs;
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +00008316 PotentiallyDeadPHIs.insert(&PN);
8317 if (DeadPHICycle(PU, PotentiallyDeadPHIs))
8318 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, UndefValue::get(PN.getType()));
8319 }
Chris Lattnerff9f13a2007-01-15 07:30:06 +00008320
8321 // If this phi has a single use, and if that use just computes a value for
8322 // the next iteration of a loop, delete the phi. This occurs with unused
8323 // induction variables, e.g. "for (int j = 0; ; ++j);". Detecting this
8324 // common case here is good because the only other things that catch this
8325 // are induction variable analysis (sometimes) and ADCE, which is only run
8326 // late.
8327 if (PHIUser->hasOneUse() &&
8328 (isa<BinaryOperator>(PHIUser) || isa<GetElementPtrInst>(PHIUser)) &&
8329 PHIUser->use_back() == &PN) {
8330 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, UndefValue::get(PN.getType()));
8331 }
8332 }
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +00008333
Chris Lattner60921c92003-12-19 05:58:40 +00008334 return 0;
Chris Lattner473945d2002-05-06 18:06:38 +00008335}
8336
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008337static Value *InsertCastToIntPtrTy(Value *V, const Type *DTy,
8338 Instruction *InsertPoint,
8339 InstCombiner *IC) {
Reid Spencerabaa8ca2007-01-08 16:32:00 +00008340 unsigned PtrSize = DTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
8341 unsigned VTySize = V->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008342 // We must cast correctly to the pointer type. Ensure that we
8343 // sign extend the integer value if it is smaller as this is
8344 // used for address computation.
8345 Instruction::CastOps opcode =
8346 (VTySize < PtrSize ? Instruction::SExt :
8347 (VTySize == PtrSize ? Instruction::BitCast : Instruction::Trunc));
8348 return IC->InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, DTy, *InsertPoint);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008349}
8350
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +00008351
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00008352Instruction *InstCombiner::visitGetElementPtrInst(GetElementPtrInst &GEP) {
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008353 Value *PtrOp = GEP.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00008354 // Is it 'getelementptr %P, i32 0' or 'getelementptr %P'
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00008355 // If so, eliminate the noop.
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +00008356 if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 1)
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008357 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, PtrOp);
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +00008358
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008359 if (isa<UndefValue>(GEP.getOperand(0)))
8360 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, UndefValue::get(GEP.getType()));
8361
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +00008362 bool HasZeroPointerIndex = false;
8363 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(GEP.getOperand(1)))
8364 HasZeroPointerIndex = C->isNullValue();
8365
8366 if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 2 && HasZeroPointerIndex)
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008367 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, PtrOp);
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +00008368
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008369 // Eliminate unneeded casts for indices.
8370 bool MadeChange = false;
Chris Lattnerdb9654e2007-03-25 20:43:09 +00008371
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +00008372 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
Chris Lattnerdb9654e2007-03-25 20:43:09 +00008373 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEP.getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +00008374 if (isa<SequentialType>(*GTI)) {
8375 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(GEP.getOperand(i))) {
Chris Lattner76b7a062007-01-15 07:02:54 +00008376 if (CI->getOpcode() == Instruction::ZExt ||
8377 CI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt) {
8378 const Type *SrcTy = CI->getOperand(0)->getType();
8379 // We can eliminate a cast from i32 to i64 iff the target
8380 // is a 32-bit pointer target.
8381 if (SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() >= TD->getPointerSizeInBits()) {
8382 MadeChange = true;
8383 GEP.setOperand(i, CI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008384 }
8385 }
8386 }
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +00008387 // If we are using a wider index than needed for this platform, shrink it
8388 // to what we need. If the incoming value needs a cast instruction,
8389 // insert it. This explicit cast can make subsequent optimizations more
8390 // obvious.
8391 Value *Op = GEP.getOperand(i);
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00008392 if (TD->getTypeSize(Op->getType()) > TD->getPointerSize())
Chris Lattner4f1134e2004-04-17 18:16:10 +00008393 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008394 GEP.setOperand(i, ConstantExpr::getTrunc(C, TD->getIntPtrType()));
Chris Lattner4f1134e2004-04-17 18:16:10 +00008395 MadeChange = true;
8396 } else {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008397 Op = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, Op, TD->getIntPtrType(),
8398 GEP);
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +00008399 GEP.setOperand(i, Op);
8400 MadeChange = true;
8401 }
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008402 }
Chris Lattnerdb9654e2007-03-25 20:43:09 +00008403 }
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008404 if (MadeChange) return &GEP;
8405
Chris Lattnerdb9654e2007-03-25 20:43:09 +00008406 // If this GEP instruction doesn't move the pointer, and if the input operand
8407 // is a bitcast of another pointer, just replace the GEP with a bitcast of the
8408 // real input to the dest type.
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00008409 if (GEP.hasAllZeroIndices() && isa<BitCastInst>(GEP.getOperand(0)))
Chris Lattnerdb9654e2007-03-25 20:43:09 +00008410 return new BitCastInst(cast<BitCastInst>(GEP.getOperand(0))->getOperand(0),
8411 GEP.getType());
8412
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +00008413 // Combine Indices - If the source pointer to this getelementptr instruction
8414 // is a getelementptr instruction, combine the indices of the two
8415 // getelementptr instructions into a single instruction.
8416 //
Chris Lattner72588fc2007-02-15 22:48:32 +00008417 SmallVector<Value*, 8> SrcGEPOperands;
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00008418 if (User *Src = dyn_castGetElementPtr(PtrOp))
Chris Lattner72588fc2007-02-15 22:48:32 +00008419 SrcGEPOperands.append(Src->op_begin(), Src->op_end());
Chris Lattnerebd985c2004-03-25 22:59:29 +00008420
8421 if (!SrcGEPOperands.empty()) {
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008422 // Note that if our source is a gep chain itself that we wait for that
8423 // chain to be resolved before we perform this transformation. This
8424 // avoids us creating a TON of code in some cases.
8425 //
8426 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(SrcGEPOperands[0]) &&
8427 cast<Instruction>(SrcGEPOperands[0])->getNumOperands() == 2)
8428 return 0; // Wait until our source is folded to completion.
8429
Chris Lattner72588fc2007-02-15 22:48:32 +00008430 SmallVector<Value*, 8> Indices;
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008431
8432 // Find out whether the last index in the source GEP is a sequential idx.
8433 bool EndsWithSequential = false;
8434 for (gep_type_iterator I = gep_type_begin(*cast<User>(PtrOp)),
8435 E = gep_type_end(*cast<User>(PtrOp)); I != E; ++I)
Chris Lattnerbe97b4e2004-05-08 22:41:42 +00008436 EndsWithSequential = !isa<StructType>(*I);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008437
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +00008438 // Can we combine the two pointer arithmetics offsets?
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008439 if (EndsWithSequential) {
Chris Lattnerdecd0812003-03-05 22:33:14 +00008440 // Replace: gep (gep %P, long B), long A, ...
8441 // With: T = long A+B; gep %P, T, ...
8442 //
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008443 Value *Sum, *SO1 = SrcGEPOperands.back(), *GO1 = GEP.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008444 if (SO1 == Constant::getNullValue(SO1->getType())) {
8445 Sum = GO1;
8446 } else if (GO1 == Constant::getNullValue(GO1->getType())) {
8447 Sum = SO1;
8448 } else {
8449 // If they aren't the same type, convert both to an integer of the
8450 // target's pointer size.
8451 if (SO1->getType() != GO1->getType()) {
8452 if (Constant *SO1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO1)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008453 SO1 = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(SO1C, GO1->getType(), true);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008454 } else if (Constant *GO1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(GO1)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008455 GO1 = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(GO1C, SO1->getType(), true);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008456 } else {
8457 unsigned PS = TD->getPointerSize();
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00008458 if (TD->getTypeSize(SO1->getType()) == PS) {
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008459 // Convert GO1 to SO1's type.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008460 GO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(GO1, SO1->getType(), &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008461
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00008462 } else if (TD->getTypeSize(GO1->getType()) == PS) {
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008463 // Convert SO1 to GO1's type.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008464 SO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(SO1, GO1->getType(), &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008465 } else {
8466 const Type *PT = TD->getIntPtrType();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008467 SO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(SO1, PT, &GEP, this);
8468 GO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(GO1, PT, &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008469 }
8470 }
8471 }
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008472 if (isa<Constant>(SO1) && isa<Constant>(GO1))
8473 Sum = ConstantExpr::getAdd(cast<Constant>(SO1), cast<Constant>(GO1));
8474 else {
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00008475 Sum = BinaryOperator::createAdd(SO1, GO1, PtrOp->getName()+".sum");
8476 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(Sum), GEP);
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008477 }
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008478 }
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008479
8480 // Recycle the GEP we already have if possible.
8481 if (SrcGEPOperands.size() == 2) {
8482 GEP.setOperand(0, SrcGEPOperands[0]);
8483 GEP.setOperand(1, Sum);
8484 return &GEP;
8485 } else {
8486 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), SrcGEPOperands.begin()+1,
8487 SrcGEPOperands.end()-1);
8488 Indices.push_back(Sum);
8489 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), GEP.op_begin()+2, GEP.op_end());
8490 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008491 } else if (isa<Constant>(*GEP.idx_begin()) &&
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008492 cast<Constant>(*GEP.idx_begin())->isNullValue() &&
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008493 SrcGEPOperands.size() != 1) {
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +00008494 // Otherwise we can do the fold if the first index of the GEP is a zero
Chris Lattnerebd985c2004-03-25 22:59:29 +00008495 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), SrcGEPOperands.begin()+1,
8496 SrcGEPOperands.end());
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +00008497 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), GEP.idx_begin()+1, GEP.idx_end());
8498 }
8499
8500 if (!Indices.empty())
Chris Lattner1ccd1852007-02-12 22:56:41 +00008501 return new GetElementPtrInst(SrcGEPOperands[0], &Indices[0],
8502 Indices.size(), GEP.getName());
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +00008503
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008504 } else if (GlobalValue *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalValue>(PtrOp)) {
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +00008505 // GEP of global variable. If all of the indices for this GEP are
8506 // constants, we can promote this to a constexpr instead of an instruction.
8507
8508 // Scan for nonconstants...
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +00008509 SmallVector<Constant*, 8> Indices;
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +00008510 User::op_iterator I = GEP.idx_begin(), E = GEP.idx_end();
8511 for (; I != E && isa<Constant>(*I); ++I)
8512 Indices.push_back(cast<Constant>(*I));
8513
8514 if (I == E) { // If they are all constants...
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +00008515 Constant *CE = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(GV,
8516 &Indices[0],Indices.size());
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +00008517
8518 // Replace all uses of the GEP with the new constexpr...
8519 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, CE);
8520 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008521 } else if (Value *X = getBitCastOperand(PtrOp)) { // Is the operand a cast?
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +00008522 if (!isa<PointerType>(X->getType())) {
8523 // Not interesting. Source pointer must be a cast from pointer.
8524 } else if (HasZeroPointerIndex) {
8525 // transform: GEP (cast [10 x ubyte]* X to [0 x ubyte]*), long 0, ...
8526 // into : GEP [10 x ubyte]* X, long 0, ...
8527 //
8528 // This occurs when the program declares an array extern like "int X[];"
8529 //
8530 const PointerType *CPTy = cast<PointerType>(PtrOp->getType());
8531 const PointerType *XTy = cast<PointerType>(X->getType());
8532 if (const ArrayType *XATy =
8533 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(XTy->getElementType()))
8534 if (const ArrayType *CATy =
8535 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(CPTy->getElementType()))
8536 if (CATy->getElementType() == XATy->getElementType()) {
8537 // At this point, we know that the cast source type is a pointer
8538 // to an array of the same type as the destination pointer
8539 // array. Because the array type is never stepped over (there
8540 // is a leading zero) we can fold the cast into this GEP.
8541 GEP.setOperand(0, X);
8542 return &GEP;
8543 }
8544 } else if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 2) {
8545 // Transform things like:
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00008546 // %t = getelementptr ubyte* cast ([2 x int]* %str to uint*), uint %V
8547 // into: %t1 = getelementptr [2 x int*]* %str, int 0, uint %V; cast
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +00008548 const Type *SrcElTy = cast<PointerType>(X->getType())->getElementType();
8549 const Type *ResElTy=cast<PointerType>(PtrOp->getType())->getElementType();
8550 if (isa<ArrayType>(SrcElTy) &&
8551 TD->getTypeSize(cast<ArrayType>(SrcElTy)->getElementType()) ==
8552 TD->getTypeSize(ResElTy)) {
8553 Value *V = InsertNewInstBefore(
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00008554 new GetElementPtrInst(X, Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty),
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +00008555 GEP.getOperand(1), GEP.getName()), GEP);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008556 // V and GEP are both pointer types --> BitCast
8557 return new BitCastInst(V, GEP.getType());
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +00008558 }
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00008559
8560 // Transform things like:
8561 // getelementptr sbyte* cast ([100 x double]* X to sbyte*), int %tmp
8562 // (where tmp = 8*tmp2) into:
8563 // getelementptr [100 x double]* %arr, int 0, int %tmp.2
8564
8565 if (isa<ArrayType>(SrcElTy) &&
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00008566 (ResElTy == Type::Int8Ty || ResElTy == Type::Int8Ty)) {
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00008567 uint64_t ArrayEltSize =
8568 TD->getTypeSize(cast<ArrayType>(SrcElTy)->getElementType());
8569
8570 // Check to see if "tmp" is a scale by a multiple of ArrayEltSize. We
8571 // allow either a mul, shift, or constant here.
8572 Value *NewIdx = 0;
8573 ConstantInt *Scale = 0;
8574 if (ArrayEltSize == 1) {
8575 NewIdx = GEP.getOperand(1);
8576 Scale = ConstantInt::get(NewIdx->getType(), 1);
8577 } else if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner6e2f8432005-09-14 17:32:56 +00008578 NewIdx = ConstantInt::get(CI->getType(), 1);
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00008579 Scale = CI;
8580 } else if (Instruction *Inst =dyn_cast<Instruction>(GEP.getOperand(1))){
8581 if (Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
8582 isa<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00008583 ConstantInt *ShAmt = cast<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1));
8584 uint32_t ShAmtVal = ShAmt->getLimitedValue(64);
8585 Scale = ConstantInt::get(Inst->getType(), 1ULL << ShAmtVal);
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00008586 NewIdx = Inst->getOperand(0);
8587 } else if (Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul &&
8588 isa<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1))) {
8589 Scale = cast<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1));
8590 NewIdx = Inst->getOperand(0);
8591 }
8592 }
8593
8594 // If the index will be to exactly the right offset with the scale taken
8595 // out, perform the transformation.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00008596 if (Scale && Scale->getZExtValue() % ArrayEltSize == 0) {
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +00008597 if (isa<ConstantInt>(Scale))
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00008598 Scale = ConstantInt::get(Scale->getType(),
8599 Scale->getZExtValue() / ArrayEltSize);
8600 if (Scale->getZExtValue() != 1) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008601 Constant *C = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(Scale, NewIdx->getType(),
8602 true /*SExt*/);
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00008603 Instruction *Sc = BinaryOperator::createMul(NewIdx, C, "idxscale");
8604 NewIdx = InsertNewInstBefore(Sc, GEP);
8605 }
8606
8607 // Insert the new GEP instruction.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008608 Instruction *NewGEP =
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00008609 new GetElementPtrInst(X, Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty),
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00008610 NewIdx, GEP.getName());
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008611 NewGEP = InsertNewInstBefore(NewGEP, GEP);
8612 // The NewGEP must be pointer typed, so must the old one -> BitCast
8613 return new BitCastInst(NewGEP, GEP.getType());
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00008614 }
8615 }
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +00008616 }
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00008617 }
8618
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00008619 return 0;
8620}
8621
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00008622Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAllocationInst(AllocationInst &AI) {
8623 // Convert: malloc Ty, C - where C is a constant != 1 into: malloc [C x Ty], 1
8624 if (AI.isArrayAllocation()) // Check C != 1
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00008625 if (const ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(AI.getArraySize())) {
8626 const Type *NewTy =
8627 ArrayType::get(AI.getAllocatedType(), C->getZExtValue());
Chris Lattner0006bd72002-11-09 00:49:43 +00008628 AllocationInst *New = 0;
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00008629
8630 // Create and insert the replacement instruction...
8631 if (isa<MallocInst>(AI))
Nate Begeman14b05292005-11-05 09:21:28 +00008632 New = new MallocInst(NewTy, 0, AI.getAlignment(), AI.getName());
Chris Lattner0006bd72002-11-09 00:49:43 +00008633 else {
8634 assert(isa<AllocaInst>(AI) && "Unknown type of allocation inst!");
Nate Begeman14b05292005-11-05 09:21:28 +00008635 New = new AllocaInst(NewTy, 0, AI.getAlignment(), AI.getName());
Chris Lattner0006bd72002-11-09 00:49:43 +00008636 }
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +00008637
8638 InsertNewInstBefore(New, AI);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008639
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00008640 // Scan to the end of the allocation instructions, to skip over a block of
8641 // allocas if possible...
8642 //
8643 BasicBlock::iterator It = New;
8644 while (isa<AllocationInst>(*It)) ++It;
8645
8646 // Now that I is pointing to the first non-allocation-inst in the block,
8647 // insert our getelementptr instruction...
8648 //
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00008649 Value *NullIdx = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
Chris Lattner693787a2005-05-04 19:10:26 +00008650 Value *V = new GetElementPtrInst(New, NullIdx, NullIdx,
8651 New->getName()+".sub", It);
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00008652
8653 // Now make everything use the getelementptr instead of the original
8654 // allocation.
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +00008655 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, V);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008656 } else if (isa<UndefValue>(AI.getArraySize())) {
8657 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, Constant::getNullValue(AI.getType()));
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00008658 }
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +00008659
8660 // If alloca'ing a zero byte object, replace the alloca with a null pointer.
8661 // Note that we only do this for alloca's, because malloc should allocate and
8662 // return a unique pointer, even for a zero byte allocation.
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008663 if (isa<AllocaInst>(AI) && AI.getAllocatedType()->isSized() &&
Chris Lattnercf27afb2004-07-02 22:55:47 +00008664 TD->getTypeSize(AI.getAllocatedType()) == 0)
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +00008665 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, Constant::getNullValue(AI.getType()));
8666
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00008667 return 0;
8668}
8669
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +00008670Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFreeInst(FreeInst &FI) {
8671 Value *Op = FI.getOperand(0);
8672
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00008673 // free undef -> unreachable.
8674 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op)) {
8675 // Insert a new store to null because we cannot modify the CFG here.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00008676 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(),
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00008677 UndefValue::get(PointerType::get(Type::Int1Ty)), &FI);
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00008678 return EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
8679 }
Chris Lattner6fe55412007-04-14 00:20:02 +00008680
Chris Lattner6160e852004-02-28 04:57:37 +00008681 // If we have 'free null' delete the instruction. This can happen in stl code
8682 // when lots of inlining happens.
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00008683 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op))
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00008684 return EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
Chris Lattner6fe55412007-04-14 00:20:02 +00008685
8686 // Change free <ty>* (cast <ty2>* X to <ty>*) into free <ty2>* X
8687 if (BitCastInst *CI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op)) {
8688 FI.setOperand(0, CI->getOperand(0));
8689 return &FI;
8690 }
8691
8692 // Change free (gep X, 0,0,0,0) into free(X)
8693 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEPI = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Op)) {
8694 if (GEPI->hasAllZeroIndices()) {
8695 AddToWorkList(GEPI);
8696 FI.setOperand(0, GEPI->getOperand(0));
8697 return &FI;
8698 }
8699 }
8700
8701 // Change free(malloc) into nothing, if the malloc has a single use.
8702 if (MallocInst *MI = dyn_cast<MallocInst>(Op))
8703 if (MI->hasOneUse()) {
8704 EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
8705 return EraseInstFromFunction(*MI);
8706 }
Chris Lattner6160e852004-02-28 04:57:37 +00008707
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +00008708 return 0;
8709}
8710
8711
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00008712/// InstCombineLoadCast - Fold 'load (cast P)' -> cast (load P)' when possible.
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +00008713static Instruction *InstCombineLoadCast(InstCombiner &IC, LoadInst &LI) {
8714 User *CI = cast<User>(LI.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +00008715 Value *CastOp = CI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +00008716
8717 const Type *DestPTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +00008718 if (const PointerType *SrcTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType())) {
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +00008719 const Type *SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +00008720
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +00008721 if (DestPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(DestPTy) ||
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00008722 isa<VectorType>(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +00008723 // If the source is an array, the code below will not succeed. Check to
8724 // see if a trivial 'gep P, 0, 0' will help matters. Only do this for
8725 // constants.
8726 if (const ArrayType *ASrcTy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcPTy))
8727 if (Constant *CSrc = dyn_cast<Constant>(CastOp))
8728 if (ASrcTy->getNumElements() != 0) {
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +00008729 Value *Idxs[2];
8730 Idxs[0] = Idxs[1] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
8731 CastOp = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(CSrc, Idxs, 2);
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +00008732 SrcTy = cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType());
8733 SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
8734 }
8735
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +00008736 if ((SrcPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy) ||
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00008737 isa<VectorType>(SrcPTy)) &&
Chris Lattnerb1515fe2005-03-29 06:37:47 +00008738 // Do not allow turning this into a load of an integer, which is then
8739 // casted to a pointer, this pessimizes pointer analysis a lot.
8740 (isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy) == isa<PointerType>(LI.getType())) &&
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +00008741 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(SrcPTy) ==
8742 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(DestPTy)) {
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008743
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +00008744 // Okay, we are casting from one integer or pointer type to another of
8745 // the same size. Instead of casting the pointer before the load, cast
8746 // the result of the loaded value.
8747 Value *NewLoad = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(CastOp,
8748 CI->getName(),
8749 LI.isVolatile()),LI);
8750 // Now cast the result of the load.
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00008751 return new BitCastInst(NewLoad, LI.getType());
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +00008752 }
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +00008753 }
8754 }
8755 return 0;
8756}
8757
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00008758/// isSafeToLoadUnconditionally - Return true if we know that executing a load
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +00008759/// from this value cannot trap. If it is not obviously safe to load from the
8760/// specified pointer, we do a quick local scan of the basic block containing
8761/// ScanFrom, to determine if the address is already accessed.
8762static bool isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(Value *V, Instruction *ScanFrom) {
8763 // If it is an alloca or global variable, it is always safe to load from.
8764 if (isa<AllocaInst>(V) || isa<GlobalVariable>(V)) return true;
8765
8766 // Otherwise, be a little bit agressive by scanning the local block where we
8767 // want to check to see if the pointer is already being loaded or stored
Alkis Evlogimenos7b6ec602004-09-20 06:42:58 +00008768 // from/to. If so, the previous load or store would have already trapped,
8769 // so there is no harm doing an extra load (also, CSE will later eliminate
8770 // the load entirely).
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +00008771 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = ScanFrom, E = ScanFrom->getParent()->begin();
8772
Alkis Evlogimenos7b6ec602004-09-20 06:42:58 +00008773 while (BBI != E) {
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +00008774 --BBI;
8775
8776 if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI)) {
8777 if (LI->getOperand(0) == V) return true;
8778 } else if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI))
8779 if (SI->getOperand(1) == V) return true;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008780
Alkis Evlogimenos7b6ec602004-09-20 06:42:58 +00008781 }
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +00008782 return false;
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00008783}
8784
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +00008785Instruction *InstCombiner::visitLoadInst(LoadInst &LI) {
8786 Value *Op = LI.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner5f16a132004-01-12 04:13:56 +00008787
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +00008788 // Attempt to improve the alignment.
8789 unsigned KnownAlign = GetKnownAlignment(Op, TD);
8790 if (KnownAlign > LI.getAlignment())
8791 LI.setAlignment(KnownAlign);
8792
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +00008793 // load (cast X) --> cast (load X) iff safe
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +00008794 if (isa<CastInst>(Op))
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +00008795 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineLoadCast(*this, LI))
8796 return Res;
8797
8798 // None of the following transforms are legal for volatile loads.
8799 if (LI.isVolatile()) return 0;
Chris Lattner62f254d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +00008800
Chris Lattner62f254d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +00008801 if (&LI.getParent()->front() != &LI) {
8802 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &LI; --BBI;
Chris Lattner9c1f0fd2005-09-12 22:21:03 +00008803 // If the instruction immediately before this is a store to the same
8804 // address, do a simple form of store->load forwarding.
Chris Lattner62f254d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +00008805 if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI))
8806 if (SI->getOperand(1) == LI.getOperand(0))
8807 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, SI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner9c1f0fd2005-09-12 22:21:03 +00008808 if (LoadInst *LIB = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI))
8809 if (LIB->getOperand(0) == LI.getOperand(0))
8810 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, LIB);
Chris Lattner62f254d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +00008811 }
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +00008812
8813 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEPI = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Op))
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00008814 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(GEPI->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +00008815 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate
8816 // that this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting
8817 // an unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the
8818 // CFG.
8819 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
8820 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
8821 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
8822 }
8823
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008824 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op)) {
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +00008825 // load null/undef -> undef
8826 if ((C->isNullValue() || isa<UndefValue>(C))) {
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00008827 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate that
8828 // this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting an
8829 // unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the CFG.
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +00008830 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
8831 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008832 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00008833 }
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +00008834
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008835 // Instcombine load (constant global) into the value loaded.
8836 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(Op))
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +00008837 if (GV->isConstant() && !GV->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008838 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, GV->getInitializer());
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008839
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008840 // Instcombine load (constantexpr_GEP global, 0, ...) into the value loaded.
8841 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Op))
8842 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr) {
8843 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(CE->getOperand(0)))
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +00008844 if (GV->isConstant() && !GV->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattner363f2a22005-09-26 05:28:06 +00008845 if (Constant *V =
8846 ConstantFoldLoadThroughGEPConstantExpr(GV->getInitializer(), CE))
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008847 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, V);
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +00008848 if (CE->getOperand(0)->isNullValue()) {
8849 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate
8850 // that this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting
8851 // an unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the
8852 // CFG.
8853 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
8854 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
8855 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
8856 }
8857
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008858 } else if (CE->isCast()) {
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008859 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineLoadCast(*this, LI))
8860 return Res;
8861 }
8862 }
Chris Lattnerf499eac2004-04-08 20:39:49 +00008863
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +00008864 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00008865 // Change select and PHI nodes to select values instead of addresses: this
8866 // helps alias analysis out a lot, allows many others simplifications, and
8867 // exposes redundancy in the code.
8868 //
8869 // Note that we cannot do the transformation unless we know that the
8870 // introduced loads cannot trap! Something like this is valid as long as
8871 // the condition is always false: load (select bool %C, int* null, int* %G),
8872 // but it would not be valid if we transformed it to load from null
8873 // unconditionally.
8874 //
8875 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op)) {
8876 // load (select (Cond, &V1, &V2)) --> select(Cond, load &V1, load &V2).
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +00008877 if (isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(SI->getOperand(1), SI) &&
8878 isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(SI->getOperand(2), SI)) {
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00008879 Value *V1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(SI->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner79f0c8e2004-09-20 10:15:10 +00008880 SI->getOperand(1)->getName()+".val"), LI);
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00008881 Value *V2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(SI->getOperand(2),
Chris Lattner79f0c8e2004-09-20 10:15:10 +00008882 SI->getOperand(2)->getName()+".val"), LI);
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00008883 return new SelectInst(SI->getCondition(), V1, V2);
8884 }
8885
Chris Lattner684fe212004-09-23 15:46:00 +00008886 // load (select (cond, null, P)) -> load P
8887 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
8888 if (C->isNullValue()) {
8889 LI.setOperand(0, SI->getOperand(2));
8890 return &LI;
8891 }
8892
8893 // load (select (cond, P, null)) -> load P
8894 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(2)))
8895 if (C->isNullValue()) {
8896 LI.setOperand(0, SI->getOperand(1));
8897 return &LI;
8898 }
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00008899 }
8900 }
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +00008901 return 0;
8902}
8903
Reid Spencer55af2b52007-01-19 21:20:31 +00008904/// InstCombineStoreToCast - Fold store V, (cast P) -> store (cast V), P
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00008905/// when possible.
8906static Instruction *InstCombineStoreToCast(InstCombiner &IC, StoreInst &SI) {
8907 User *CI = cast<User>(SI.getOperand(1));
8908 Value *CastOp = CI->getOperand(0);
8909
8910 const Type *DestPTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
8911 if (const PointerType *SrcTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType())) {
8912 const Type *SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
8913
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +00008914 if (DestPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00008915 // If the source is an array, the code below will not succeed. Check to
8916 // see if a trivial 'gep P, 0, 0' will help matters. Only do this for
8917 // constants.
8918 if (const ArrayType *ASrcTy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcPTy))
8919 if (Constant *CSrc = dyn_cast<Constant>(CastOp))
8920 if (ASrcTy->getNumElements() != 0) {
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +00008921 Value* Idxs[2];
8922 Idxs[0] = Idxs[1] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
8923 CastOp = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(CSrc, Idxs, 2);
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00008924 SrcTy = cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType());
8925 SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
8926 }
8927
Reid Spencer67f827c2007-01-20 23:35:48 +00008928 if ((SrcPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy)) &&
8929 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(SrcPTy) ==
8930 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00008931
8932 // Okay, we are casting from one integer or pointer type to another of
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +00008933 // the same size. Instead of casting the pointer before
8934 // the store, cast the value to be stored.
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00008935 Value *NewCast;
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00008936 Value *SIOp0 = SI.getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +00008937 Instruction::CastOps opcode = Instruction::BitCast;
8938 const Type* CastSrcTy = SIOp0->getType();
8939 const Type* CastDstTy = SrcPTy;
8940 if (isa<PointerType>(CastDstTy)) {
8941 if (CastSrcTy->isInteger())
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00008942 opcode = Instruction::IntToPtr;
Reid Spencer67f827c2007-01-20 23:35:48 +00008943 } else if (isa<IntegerType>(CastDstTy)) {
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00008944 if (isa<PointerType>(SIOp0->getType()))
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00008945 opcode = Instruction::PtrToInt;
8946 }
8947 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SIOp0))
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +00008948 NewCast = ConstantExpr::getCast(opcode, C, CastDstTy);
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00008949 else
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008950 NewCast = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +00008951 CastInst::create(opcode, SIOp0, CastDstTy, SIOp0->getName()+".c"),
8952 SI);
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00008953 return new StoreInst(NewCast, CastOp);
8954 }
8955 }
8956 }
8957 return 0;
8958}
8959
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +00008960Instruction *InstCombiner::visitStoreInst(StoreInst &SI) {
8961 Value *Val = SI.getOperand(0);
8962 Value *Ptr = SI.getOperand(1);
8963
8964 if (isa<UndefValue>(Ptr)) { // store X, undef -> noop (even if volatile)
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00008965 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +00008966 ++NumCombined;
8967 return 0;
8968 }
Chris Lattner836692d2007-01-15 06:51:56 +00008969
8970 // If the RHS is an alloca with a single use, zapify the store, making the
8971 // alloca dead.
8972 if (Ptr->hasOneUse()) {
8973 if (isa<AllocaInst>(Ptr)) {
8974 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
8975 ++NumCombined;
8976 return 0;
8977 }
8978
8979 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Ptr))
8980 if (isa<AllocaInst>(GEP->getOperand(0)) &&
8981 GEP->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
8982 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
8983 ++NumCombined;
8984 return 0;
8985 }
8986 }
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +00008987
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +00008988 // Attempt to improve the alignment.
8989 unsigned KnownAlign = GetKnownAlignment(Ptr, TD);
8990 if (KnownAlign > SI.getAlignment())
8991 SI.setAlignment(KnownAlign);
8992
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00008993 // Do really simple DSE, to catch cases where there are several consequtive
8994 // stores to the same location, separated by a few arithmetic operations. This
8995 // situation often occurs with bitfield accesses.
8996 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &SI;
8997 for (unsigned ScanInsts = 6; BBI != SI.getParent()->begin() && ScanInsts;
8998 --ScanInsts) {
8999 --BBI;
9000
9001 if (StoreInst *PrevSI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI)) {
9002 // Prev store isn't volatile, and stores to the same location?
9003 if (!PrevSI->isVolatile() && PrevSI->getOperand(1) == SI.getOperand(1)) {
9004 ++NumDeadStore;
9005 ++BBI;
9006 EraseInstFromFunction(*PrevSI);
9007 continue;
9008 }
9009 break;
9010 }
9011
Chris Lattnerb4db97f2006-05-26 19:19:20 +00009012 // If this is a load, we have to stop. However, if the loaded value is from
9013 // the pointer we're loading and is producing the pointer we're storing,
9014 // then *this* store is dead (X = load P; store X -> P).
9015 if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI)) {
9016 if (LI == Val && LI->getOperand(0) == Ptr) {
9017 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
9018 ++NumCombined;
9019 return 0;
9020 }
9021 // Otherwise, this is a load from some other location. Stores before it
9022 // may not be dead.
9023 break;
9024 }
9025
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00009026 // Don't skip over loads or things that can modify memory.
Chris Lattnerb4db97f2006-05-26 19:19:20 +00009027 if (BBI->mayWriteToMemory())
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00009028 break;
9029 }
9030
9031
9032 if (SI.isVolatile()) return 0; // Don't hack volatile stores.
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +00009033
9034 // store X, null -> turns into 'unreachable' in SimplifyCFG
9035 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Ptr)) {
9036 if (!isa<UndefValue>(Val)) {
9037 SI.setOperand(0, UndefValue::get(Val->getType()));
9038 if (Instruction *U = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Val))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009039 AddToWorkList(U); // Dropped a use.
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +00009040 ++NumCombined;
9041 }
9042 return 0; // Do not modify these!
9043 }
9044
9045 // store undef, Ptr -> noop
9046 if (isa<UndefValue>(Val)) {
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00009047 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +00009048 ++NumCombined;
9049 return 0;
9050 }
9051
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00009052 // If the pointer destination is a cast, see if we can fold the cast into the
9053 // source instead.
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +00009054 if (isa<CastInst>(Ptr))
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00009055 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineStoreToCast(*this, SI))
9056 return Res;
9057 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Ptr))
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009058 if (CE->isCast())
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00009059 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineStoreToCast(*this, SI))
9060 return Res;
9061
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +00009062
9063 // If this store is the last instruction in the basic block, and if the block
9064 // ends with an unconditional branch, try to move it to the successor block.
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00009065 BBI = &SI; ++BBI;
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +00009066 if (BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(BBI))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009067 if (BI->isUnconditional())
9068 if (SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(SI))
9069 return 0; // xform done!
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +00009070
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +00009071 return 0;
9072}
9073
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009074/// SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock - Turn things like:
9075/// if () { *P = v1; } else { *P = v2 }
9076/// into a phi node with a store in the successor.
9077///
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009078/// Simplify things like:
9079/// *P = v1; if () { *P = v2; }
9080/// into a phi node with a store in the successor.
9081///
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009082bool InstCombiner::SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(StoreInst &SI) {
9083 BasicBlock *StoreBB = SI.getParent();
9084
9085 // Check to see if the successor block has exactly two incoming edges. If
9086 // so, see if the other predecessor contains a store to the same location.
9087 // if so, insert a PHI node (if needed) and move the stores down.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009088 BasicBlock *DestBB = StoreBB->getTerminator()->getSuccessor(0);
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009089
9090 // Determine whether Dest has exactly two predecessors and, if so, compute
9091 // the other predecessor.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009092 pred_iterator PI = pred_begin(DestBB);
9093 BasicBlock *OtherBB = 0;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009094 if (*PI != StoreBB)
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009095 OtherBB = *PI;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009096 ++PI;
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009097 if (PI == pred_end(DestBB))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009098 return false;
9099
9100 if (*PI != StoreBB) {
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009101 if (OtherBB)
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009102 return false;
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009103 OtherBB = *PI;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009104 }
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009105 if (++PI != pred_end(DestBB))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009106 return false;
9107
9108
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009109 // Verify that the other block ends in a branch and is not otherwise empty.
9110 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = OtherBB->getTerminator();
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009111 BranchInst *OtherBr = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(BBI);
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009112 if (!OtherBr || BBI == OtherBB->begin())
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009113 return false;
9114
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009115 // If the other block ends in an unconditional branch, check for the 'if then
9116 // else' case. there is an instruction before the branch.
9117 StoreInst *OtherStore = 0;
9118 if (OtherBr->isUnconditional()) {
9119 // If this isn't a store, or isn't a store to the same location, bail out.
9120 --BBI;
9121 OtherStore = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI);
9122 if (!OtherStore || OtherStore->getOperand(1) != SI.getOperand(1))
9123 return false;
9124 } else {
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +00009125 // Otherwise, the other block ended with a conditional branch. If one of the
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009126 // destinations is StoreBB, then we have the if/then case.
9127 if (OtherBr->getSuccessor(0) != StoreBB &&
9128 OtherBr->getSuccessor(1) != StoreBB)
9129 return false;
9130
9131 // Okay, we know that OtherBr now goes to Dest and StoreBB, so this is an
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +00009132 // if/then triangle. See if there is a store to the same ptr as SI that
9133 // lives in OtherBB.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009134 for (;; --BBI) {
9135 // Check to see if we find the matching store.
9136 if ((OtherStore = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI))) {
9137 if (OtherStore->getOperand(1) != SI.getOperand(1))
9138 return false;
9139 break;
9140 }
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +00009141 // If we find something that may be using the stored value, or if we run
9142 // out of instructions, we can't do the xform.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009143 if (isa<LoadInst>(BBI) || BBI->mayWriteToMemory() ||
9144 BBI == OtherBB->begin())
9145 return false;
9146 }
9147
9148 // In order to eliminate the store in OtherBr, we have to
9149 // make sure nothing reads the stored value in StoreBB.
9150 for (BasicBlock::iterator I = StoreBB->begin(); &*I != &SI; ++I) {
9151 // FIXME: This should really be AA driven.
9152 if (isa<LoadInst>(I) || I->mayWriteToMemory())
9153 return false;
9154 }
9155 }
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009156
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009157 // Insert a PHI node now if we need it.
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009158 Value *MergedVal = OtherStore->getOperand(0);
9159 if (MergedVal != SI.getOperand(0)) {
9160 PHINode *PN = new PHINode(MergedVal->getType(), "storemerge");
9161 PN->reserveOperandSpace(2);
9162 PN->addIncoming(SI.getOperand(0), SI.getParent());
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009163 PN->addIncoming(OtherStore->getOperand(0), OtherBB);
9164 MergedVal = InsertNewInstBefore(PN, DestBB->front());
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009165 }
9166
9167 // Advance to a place where it is safe to insert the new store and
9168 // insert it.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009169 BBI = DestBB->begin();
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009170 while (isa<PHINode>(BBI)) ++BBI;
9171 InsertNewInstBefore(new StoreInst(MergedVal, SI.getOperand(1),
9172 OtherStore->isVolatile()), *BBI);
9173
9174 // Nuke the old stores.
9175 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
9176 EraseInstFromFunction(*OtherStore);
9177 ++NumCombined;
9178 return true;
9179}
9180
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +00009181
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +00009182Instruction *InstCombiner::visitBranchInst(BranchInst &BI) {
9183 // Change br (not X), label True, label False to: br X, label False, True
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +00009184 Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00009185 BasicBlock *TrueDest;
9186 BasicBlock *FalseDest;
9187 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_Not(m_Value(X)), TrueDest, FalseDest)) &&
9188 !isa<Constant>(X)) {
9189 // Swap Destinations and condition...
9190 BI.setCondition(X);
9191 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
9192 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
9193 return &BI;
9194 }
9195
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009196 // Cannonicalize fcmp_one -> fcmp_oeq
9197 FCmpInst::Predicate FPred; Value *Y;
9198 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_FCmp(FPred, m_Value(X), m_Value(Y)),
9199 TrueDest, FalseDest)))
9200 if ((FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE || FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE ||
9201 FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE) && BI.getCondition()->hasOneUse()) {
9202 FCmpInst *I = cast<FCmpInst>(BI.getCondition());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009203 FCmpInst::Predicate NewPred = FCmpInst::getInversePredicate(FPred);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00009204 Instruction *NewSCC = new FCmpInst(NewPred, X, Y, "", I);
9205 NewSCC->takeName(I);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009206 // Swap Destinations and condition...
9207 BI.setCondition(NewSCC);
9208 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
9209 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009210 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00009211 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009212 AddToWorkList(NewSCC);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009213 return &BI;
9214 }
9215
9216 // Cannonicalize icmp_ne -> icmp_eq
9217 ICmpInst::Predicate IPred;
9218 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_ICmp(IPred, m_Value(X), m_Value(Y)),
9219 TrueDest, FalseDest)))
9220 if ((IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
9221 IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE || IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE ||
9222 IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE) && BI.getCondition()->hasOneUse()) {
9223 ICmpInst *I = cast<ICmpInst>(BI.getCondition());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009224 ICmpInst::Predicate NewPred = ICmpInst::getInversePredicate(IPred);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00009225 Instruction *NewSCC = new ICmpInst(NewPred, X, Y, "", I);
9226 NewSCC->takeName(I);
Chris Lattner40f5d702003-06-04 05:10:11 +00009227 // Swap Destinations and condition...
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00009228 BI.setCondition(NewSCC);
Chris Lattner40f5d702003-06-04 05:10:11 +00009229 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
9230 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009231 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00009232 I->eraseFromParent();;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009233 AddToWorkList(NewSCC);
Chris Lattner40f5d702003-06-04 05:10:11 +00009234 return &BI;
9235 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009236
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +00009237 return 0;
9238}
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00009239
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +00009240Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSwitchInst(SwitchInst &SI) {
9241 Value *Cond = SI.getCondition();
9242 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Cond)) {
9243 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add)
9244 if (ConstantInt *AddRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
9245 // change 'switch (X+4) case 1:' into 'switch (X) case -3'
9246 for (unsigned i = 2, e = SI.getNumOperands(); i != e; i += 2)
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009247 SI.setOperand(i,ConstantExpr::getSub(cast<Constant>(SI.getOperand(i)),
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +00009248 AddRHS));
9249 SI.setOperand(0, I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009250 AddToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +00009251 return &SI;
9252 }
9253 }
9254 return 0;
9255}
9256
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +00009257/// CheapToScalarize - Return true if the value is cheaper to scalarize than it
9258/// is to leave as a vector operation.
9259static bool CheapToScalarize(Value *V, bool isConstant) {
9260 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V))
9261 return true;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009262 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V)) {
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +00009263 if (isConstant) return true;
9264 // If all elts are the same, we can extract.
9265 Constant *Op0 = C->getOperand(0);
9266 for (unsigned i = 1; i < C->getNumOperands(); ++i)
9267 if (C->getOperand(i) != Op0)
9268 return false;
9269 return true;
9270 }
9271 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
9272 if (!I) return false;
9273
9274 // Insert element gets simplified to the inserted element or is deleted if
9275 // this is constant idx extract element and its a constant idx insertelt.
9276 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::InsertElement && isConstant &&
9277 isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(2)))
9278 return true;
9279 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Load && I->hasOneUse())
9280 return true;
9281 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I))
9282 if (BO->hasOneUse() &&
9283 (CheapToScalarize(BO->getOperand(0), isConstant) ||
9284 CheapToScalarize(BO->getOperand(1), isConstant)))
9285 return true;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009286 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(I))
9287 if (CI->hasOneUse() &&
9288 (CheapToScalarize(CI->getOperand(0), isConstant) ||
9289 CheapToScalarize(CI->getOperand(1), isConstant)))
9290 return true;
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +00009291
9292 return false;
9293}
9294
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +00009295/// Read and decode a shufflevector mask.
9296///
9297/// It turns undef elements into values that are larger than the number of
9298/// elements in the input.
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009299static std::vector<unsigned> getShuffleMask(const ShuffleVectorInst *SVI) {
9300 unsigned NElts = SVI->getType()->getNumElements();
9301 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(SVI->getOperand(2)))
9302 return std::vector<unsigned>(NElts, 0);
9303 if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI->getOperand(2)))
9304 return std::vector<unsigned>(NElts, 2*NElts);
9305
9306 std::vector<unsigned> Result;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009307 const ConstantVector *CP = cast<ConstantVector>(SVI->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009308 for (unsigned i = 0, e = CP->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
9309 if (isa<UndefValue>(CP->getOperand(i)))
9310 Result.push_back(NElts*2); // undef -> 8
9311 else
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009312 Result.push_back(cast<ConstantInt>(CP->getOperand(i))->getZExtValue());
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009313 return Result;
9314}
9315
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +00009316/// FindScalarElement - Given a vector and an element number, see if the scalar
9317/// value is already around as a register, for example if it were inserted then
9318/// extracted from the vector.
9319static Value *FindScalarElement(Value *V, unsigned EltNo) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009320 assert(isa<VectorType>(V->getType()) && "Not looking at a vector?");
9321 const VectorType *PTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType());
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +00009322 unsigned Width = PTy->getNumElements();
9323 if (EltNo >= Width) // Out of range access.
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +00009324 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
9325
9326 if (isa<UndefValue>(V))
9327 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
9328 else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V))
9329 return Constant::getNullValue(PTy->getElementType());
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009330 else if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V))
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +00009331 return CP->getOperand(EltNo);
9332 else if (InsertElementInst *III = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
9333 // If this is an insert to a variable element, we don't know what it is.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009334 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(III->getOperand(2)))
9335 return 0;
9336 unsigned IIElt = cast<ConstantInt>(III->getOperand(2))->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +00009337
9338 // If this is an insert to the element we are looking for, return the
9339 // inserted value.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009340 if (EltNo == IIElt)
9341 return III->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +00009342
9343 // Otherwise, the insertelement doesn't modify the value, recurse on its
9344 // vector input.
9345 return FindScalarElement(III->getOperand(0), EltNo);
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +00009346 } else if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(V)) {
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009347 unsigned InEl = getShuffleMask(SVI)[EltNo];
9348 if (InEl < Width)
9349 return FindScalarElement(SVI->getOperand(0), InEl);
9350 else if (InEl < Width*2)
9351 return FindScalarElement(SVI->getOperand(1), InEl - Width);
9352 else
9353 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +00009354 }
9355
9356 // Otherwise, we don't know.
9357 return 0;
9358}
9359
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +00009360Instruction *InstCombiner::visitExtractElementInst(ExtractElementInst &EI) {
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +00009361
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +00009362 // If vector val is undef, replace extract with scalar undef.
Chris Lattner1f13c882006-03-31 18:25:14 +00009363 if (isa<UndefValue>(EI.getOperand(0)))
9364 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
9365
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +00009366 // If vector val is constant 0, replace extract with scalar 0.
Chris Lattner1f13c882006-03-31 18:25:14 +00009367 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(EI.getOperand(0)))
9368 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, Constant::getNullValue(EI.getType()));
9369
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009370 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +00009371 // If vector val is constant with uniform operands, replace EI
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +00009372 // with that operand
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +00009373 Constant *op0 = C->getOperand(0);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +00009374 for (unsigned i = 1; i < C->getNumOperands(); ++i)
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +00009375 if (C->getOperand(i) != op0) {
9376 op0 = 0;
9377 break;
9378 }
9379 if (op0)
9380 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, op0);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +00009381 }
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +00009382
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +00009383 // If extracting a specified index from the vector, see if we can recursively
9384 // find a previously computed scalar that was inserted into the vector.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009385 if (ConstantInt *IdxC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner85464092007-04-09 01:37:55 +00009386 unsigned IndexVal = IdxC->getZExtValue();
9387 unsigned VectorWidth =
9388 cast<VectorType>(EI.getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements();
9389
9390 // If this is extracting an invalid index, turn this into undef, to avoid
9391 // crashing the code below.
9392 if (IndexVal >= VectorWidth)
9393 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
9394
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00009395 // This instruction only demands the single element from the input vector.
9396 // If the input vector has a single use, simplify it based on this use
9397 // property.
Chris Lattner85464092007-04-09 01:37:55 +00009398 if (EI.getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() && VectorWidth != 1) {
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00009399 uint64_t UndefElts;
9400 if (Value *V = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(EI.getOperand(0),
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009401 1 << IndexVal,
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00009402 UndefElts)) {
9403 EI.setOperand(0, V);
9404 return &EI;
9405 }
9406 }
9407
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009408 if (Value *Elt = FindScalarElement(EI.getOperand(0), IndexVal))
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +00009409 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, Elt);
Chris Lattnerb7300fa2007-04-14 23:02:14 +00009410
9411 // If the this extractelement is directly using a bitcast from a vector of
9412 // the same number of elements, see if we can find the source element from
9413 // it. In this case, we will end up needing to bitcast the scalars.
9414 if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
9415 if (const VectorType *VT =
9416 dyn_cast<VectorType>(BCI->getOperand(0)->getType()))
9417 if (VT->getNumElements() == VectorWidth)
9418 if (Value *Elt = FindScalarElement(BCI->getOperand(0), IndexVal))
9419 return new BitCastInst(Elt, EI.getType());
9420 }
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +00009421 }
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +00009422
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +00009423 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +00009424 if (I->hasOneUse()) {
9425 // Push extractelement into predecessor operation if legal and
9426 // profitable to do so
9427 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I)) {
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +00009428 bool isConstantElt = isa<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1));
9429 if (CheapToScalarize(BO, isConstantElt)) {
9430 ExtractElementInst *newEI0 =
9431 new ExtractElementInst(BO->getOperand(0), EI.getOperand(1),
9432 EI.getName()+".lhs");
9433 ExtractElementInst *newEI1 =
9434 new ExtractElementInst(BO->getOperand(1), EI.getOperand(1),
9435 EI.getName()+".rhs");
9436 InsertNewInstBefore(newEI0, EI);
9437 InsertNewInstBefore(newEI1, EI);
9438 return BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(), newEI0, newEI1);
9439 }
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +00009440 } else if (isa<LoadInst>(I)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00009441 Value *Ptr = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, I->getOperand(0),
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +00009442 PointerType::get(EI.getType()), EI);
9443 GetElementPtrInst *GEP =
Reid Spencerde331242006-11-29 01:11:01 +00009444 new GetElementPtrInst(Ptr, EI.getOperand(1), I->getName() + ".gep");
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +00009445 InsertNewInstBefore(GEP, EI);
9446 return new LoadInst(GEP);
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +00009447 }
9448 }
9449 if (InsertElementInst *IE = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(I)) {
9450 // Extracting the inserted element?
9451 if (IE->getOperand(2) == EI.getOperand(1))
9452 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, IE->getOperand(1));
9453 // If the inserted and extracted elements are constants, they must not
9454 // be the same value, extract from the pre-inserted value instead.
9455 if (isa<Constant>(IE->getOperand(2)) &&
9456 isa<Constant>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
9457 AddUsesToWorkList(EI);
9458 EI.setOperand(0, IE->getOperand(0));
9459 return &EI;
9460 }
9461 } else if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(I)) {
9462 // If this is extracting an element from a shufflevector, figure out where
9463 // it came from and extract from the appropriate input element instead.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009464 if (ConstantInt *Elt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
9465 unsigned SrcIdx = getShuffleMask(SVI)[Elt->getZExtValue()];
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009466 Value *Src;
9467 if (SrcIdx < SVI->getType()->getNumElements())
9468 Src = SVI->getOperand(0);
9469 else if (SrcIdx < SVI->getType()->getNumElements()*2) {
9470 SrcIdx -= SVI->getType()->getNumElements();
9471 Src = SVI->getOperand(1);
9472 } else {
9473 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
Chris Lattnerdf084ff2006-03-30 22:02:40 +00009474 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00009475 return new ExtractElementInst(Src, SrcIdx);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +00009476 }
9477 }
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +00009478 }
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +00009479 return 0;
9480}
9481
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009482/// CollectSingleShuffleElements - If V is a shuffle of values that ONLY returns
9483/// elements from either LHS or RHS, return the shuffle mask and true.
9484/// Otherwise, return false.
9485static bool CollectSingleShuffleElements(Value *V, Value *LHS, Value *RHS,
9486 std::vector<Constant*> &Mask) {
9487 assert(V->getType() == LHS->getType() && V->getType() == RHS->getType() &&
9488 "Invalid CollectSingleShuffleElements");
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009489 unsigned NumElts = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009490
9491 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009492 Mask.assign(NumElts, UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009493 return true;
9494 } else if (V == LHS) {
9495 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009496 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, i));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009497 return true;
9498 } else if (V == RHS) {
9499 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009500 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, i+NumElts));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009501 return true;
9502 } else if (InsertElementInst *IEI = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
9503 // If this is an insert of an extract from some other vector, include it.
9504 Value *VecOp = IEI->getOperand(0);
9505 Value *ScalarOp = IEI->getOperand(1);
9506 Value *IdxOp = IEI->getOperand(2);
9507
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +00009508 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp))
9509 return false;
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009510 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +00009511
9512 if (isa<UndefValue>(ScalarOp)) { // inserting undef into vector.
9513 // Okay, we can handle this if the vector we are insertinting into is
9514 // transitively ok.
9515 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(VecOp, LHS, RHS, Mask)) {
9516 // If so, update the mask to reflect the inserted undef.
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009517 Mask[InsertedIdx] = UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty);
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +00009518 return true;
9519 }
9520 } else if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)){
9521 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) &&
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009522 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == V->getType()) {
9523 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009524 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009525
9526 // This must be extracting from either LHS or RHS.
9527 if (EI->getOperand(0) == LHS || EI->getOperand(0) == RHS) {
9528 // Okay, we can handle this if the vector we are insertinting into is
9529 // transitively ok.
9530 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(VecOp, LHS, RHS, Mask)) {
9531 // If so, update the mask to reflect the inserted value.
9532 if (EI->getOperand(0) == LHS) {
9533 Mask[InsertedIdx & (NumElts-1)] =
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009534 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009535 } else {
9536 assert(EI->getOperand(0) == RHS);
9537 Mask[InsertedIdx & (NumElts-1)] =
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009538 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx+NumElts);
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009539
9540 }
9541 return true;
9542 }
9543 }
9544 }
9545 }
9546 }
9547 // TODO: Handle shufflevector here!
9548
9549 return false;
9550}
9551
9552/// CollectShuffleElements - We are building a shuffle of V, using RHS as the
9553/// RHS of the shuffle instruction, if it is not null. Return a shuffle mask
9554/// that computes V and the LHS value of the shuffle.
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009555static Value *CollectShuffleElements(Value *V, std::vector<Constant*> &Mask,
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009556 Value *&RHS) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009557 assert(isa<VectorType>(V->getType()) &&
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009558 (RHS == 0 || V->getType() == RHS->getType()) &&
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009559 "Invalid shuffle!");
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009560 unsigned NumElts = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009561
9562 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009563 Mask.assign(NumElts, UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009564 return V;
9565 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009566 Mask.assign(NumElts, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, 0));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009567 return V;
9568 } else if (InsertElementInst *IEI = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
9569 // If this is an insert of an extract from some other vector, include it.
9570 Value *VecOp = IEI->getOperand(0);
9571 Value *ScalarOp = IEI->getOperand(1);
9572 Value *IdxOp = IEI->getOperand(2);
9573
9574 if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)) {
9575 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp) &&
9576 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == V->getType()) {
9577 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009578 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
9579 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009580
9581 // Either the extracted from or inserted into vector must be RHSVec,
9582 // otherwise we'd end up with a shuffle of three inputs.
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009583 if (EI->getOperand(0) == RHS || RHS == 0) {
9584 RHS = EI->getOperand(0);
9585 Value *V = CollectShuffleElements(VecOp, Mask, RHS);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009586 Mask[InsertedIdx & (NumElts-1)] =
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009587 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, NumElts+ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009588 return V;
9589 }
9590
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009591 if (VecOp == RHS) {
9592 Value *V = CollectShuffleElements(EI->getOperand(0), Mask, RHS);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009593 // Everything but the extracted element is replaced with the RHS.
9594 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i) {
9595 if (i != InsertedIdx)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009596 Mask[i] = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, NumElts+i);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009597 }
9598 return V;
9599 }
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009600
9601 // If this insertelement is a chain that comes from exactly these two
9602 // vectors, return the vector and the effective shuffle.
9603 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(IEI, EI->getOperand(0), RHS, Mask))
9604 return EI->getOperand(0);
9605
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009606 }
9607 }
9608 }
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009609 // TODO: Handle shufflevector here!
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009610
9611 // Otherwise, can't do anything fancy. Return an identity vector.
9612 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009613 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, i));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009614 return V;
9615}
9616
9617Instruction *InstCombiner::visitInsertElementInst(InsertElementInst &IE) {
9618 Value *VecOp = IE.getOperand(0);
9619 Value *ScalarOp = IE.getOperand(1);
9620 Value *IdxOp = IE.getOperand(2);
9621
Chris Lattner599ded12007-04-09 01:11:16 +00009622 // Inserting an undef or into an undefined place, remove this.
9623 if (isa<UndefValue>(ScalarOp) || isa<UndefValue>(IdxOp))
9624 ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
9625
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009626 // If the inserted element was extracted from some other vector, and if the
9627 // indexes are constant, try to turn this into a shufflevector operation.
9628 if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)) {
9629 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp) &&
9630 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == IE.getType()) {
9631 unsigned NumVectorElts = IE.getType()->getNumElements();
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +00009632 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
9633 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009634 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009635
9636 if (ExtractedIdx >= NumVectorElts) // Out of range extract.
9637 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
9638
9639 if (InsertedIdx >= NumVectorElts) // Out of range insert.
9640 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, UndefValue::get(IE.getType()));
9641
9642 // If we are extracting a value from a vector, then inserting it right
9643 // back into the same place, just use the input vector.
9644 if (EI->getOperand(0) == VecOp && ExtractedIdx == InsertedIdx)
9645 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
9646
9647 // We could theoretically do this for ANY input. However, doing so could
9648 // turn chains of insertelement instructions into a chain of shufflevector
9649 // instructions, and right now we do not merge shufflevectors. As such,
9650 // only do this in a situation where it is clear that there is benefit.
9651 if (isa<UndefValue>(VecOp) || isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(VecOp)) {
9652 // Turn this into shuffle(EIOp0, VecOp, Mask). The result has all of
9653 // the values of VecOp, except then one read from EIOp0.
9654 // Build a new shuffle mask.
9655 std::vector<Constant*> Mask;
9656 if (isa<UndefValue>(VecOp))
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009657 Mask.assign(NumVectorElts, UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009658 else {
9659 assert(isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(VecOp) && "Unknown thing");
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009660 Mask.assign(NumVectorElts, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty,
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009661 NumVectorElts));
9662 }
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009663 Mask[InsertedIdx] = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009664 return new ShuffleVectorInst(EI->getOperand(0), VecOp,
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009665 ConstantVector::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009666 }
9667
9668 // If this insertelement isn't used by some other insertelement, turn it
9669 // (and any insertelements it points to), into one big shuffle.
9670 if (!IE.hasOneUse() || !isa<InsertElementInst>(IE.use_back())) {
9671 std::vector<Constant*> Mask;
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009672 Value *RHS = 0;
9673 Value *LHS = CollectShuffleElements(&IE, Mask, RHS);
9674 if (RHS == 0) RHS = UndefValue::get(LHS->getType());
9675 // We now have a shuffle of LHS, RHS, Mask.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009676 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHS, RHS, ConstantVector::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009677 }
9678 }
9679 }
9680
9681 return 0;
9682}
9683
9684
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +00009685Instruction *InstCombiner::visitShuffleVectorInst(ShuffleVectorInst &SVI) {
9686 Value *LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
9687 Value *RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009688 std::vector<unsigned> Mask = getShuffleMask(&SVI);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +00009689
9690 bool MadeChange = false;
9691
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00009692 // Undefined shuffle mask -> undefined value.
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009693 if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI.getOperand(2)))
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +00009694 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, UndefValue::get(SVI.getType()));
9695
Chris Lattnere4929dd2007-01-05 07:36:08 +00009696 // If we have shuffle(x, undef, mask) and any elements of mask refer to
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009697 // the undef, change them to undefs.
Chris Lattnere4929dd2007-01-05 07:36:08 +00009698 if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI.getOperand(1))) {
9699 // Scan to see if there are any references to the RHS. If so, replace them
9700 // with undef element refs and set MadeChange to true.
9701 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
9702 if (Mask[i] >= e && Mask[i] != 2*e) {
9703 Mask[i] = 2*e;
9704 MadeChange = true;
9705 }
9706 }
9707
9708 if (MadeChange) {
9709 // Remap any references to RHS to use LHS.
9710 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
9711 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
9712 if (Mask[i] == 2*e)
9713 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
9714 else
9715 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Mask[i]));
9716 }
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009717 SVI.setOperand(2, ConstantVector::get(Elts));
Chris Lattnere4929dd2007-01-05 07:36:08 +00009718 }
9719 }
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009720
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009721 // Canonicalize shuffle(x ,x,mask) -> shuffle(x, undef,mask')
9722 // Canonicalize shuffle(undef,x,mask) -> shuffle(x, undef,mask').
9723 if (LHS == RHS || isa<UndefValue>(LHS)) {
9724 if (isa<UndefValue>(LHS) && LHS == RHS) {
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +00009725 // shuffle(undef,undef,mask) -> undef.
9726 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, LHS);
9727 }
9728
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009729 // Remap any references to RHS to use LHS.
9730 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
9731 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +00009732 if (Mask[i] >= 2*e)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009733 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +00009734 else {
9735 if ((Mask[i] >= e && isa<UndefValue>(RHS)) ||
9736 (Mask[i] < e && isa<UndefValue>(LHS)))
9737 Mask[i] = 2*e; // Turn into undef.
9738 else
9739 Mask[i] &= (e-1); // Force to LHS.
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009740 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Mask[i]));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +00009741 }
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +00009742 }
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009743 SVI.setOperand(0, SVI.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +00009744 SVI.setOperand(1, UndefValue::get(RHS->getType()));
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009745 SVI.setOperand(2, ConstantVector::get(Elts));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +00009746 LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
9747 RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +00009748 MadeChange = true;
9749 }
9750
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +00009751 // Analyze the shuffle, are the LHS or RHS and identity shuffles?
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009752 bool isLHSID = true, isRHSID = true;
Chris Lattner706126d2006-04-16 00:03:56 +00009753
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009754 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
9755 if (Mask[i] >= e*2) continue; // Ignore undef values.
9756 // Is this an identity shuffle of the LHS value?
9757 isLHSID &= (Mask[i] == i);
9758
9759 // Is this an identity shuffle of the RHS value?
9760 isRHSID &= (Mask[i]-e == i);
Chris Lattner706126d2006-04-16 00:03:56 +00009761 }
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +00009762
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009763 // Eliminate identity shuffles.
9764 if (isLHSID) return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, LHS);
9765 if (isRHSID) return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, RHS);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +00009766
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +00009767 // If the LHS is a shufflevector itself, see if we can combine it with this
9768 // one without producing an unusual shuffle. Here we are really conservative:
9769 // we are absolutely afraid of producing a shuffle mask not in the input
9770 // program, because the code gen may not be smart enough to turn a merged
9771 // shuffle into two specific shuffles: it may produce worse code. As such,
9772 // we only merge two shuffles if the result is one of the two input shuffle
9773 // masks. In this case, merging the shuffles just removes one instruction,
9774 // which we know is safe. This is good for things like turning:
9775 // (splat(splat)) -> splat.
9776 if (ShuffleVectorInst *LHSSVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(LHS)) {
9777 if (isa<UndefValue>(RHS)) {
9778 std::vector<unsigned> LHSMask = getShuffleMask(LHSSVI);
9779
9780 std::vector<unsigned> NewMask;
9781 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i)
9782 if (Mask[i] >= 2*e)
9783 NewMask.push_back(2*e);
9784 else
9785 NewMask.push_back(LHSMask[Mask[i]]);
9786
9787 // If the result mask is equal to the src shuffle or this shuffle mask, do
9788 // the replacement.
9789 if (NewMask == LHSMask || NewMask == Mask) {
9790 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
9791 for (unsigned i = 0, e = NewMask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
9792 if (NewMask[i] >= e*2) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009793 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +00009794 } else {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009795 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, NewMask[i]));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +00009796 }
9797 }
9798 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHSSVI->getOperand(0),
9799 LHSSVI->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009800 ConstantVector::get(Elts));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +00009801 }
9802 }
9803 }
Chris Lattnerc5eff442007-01-30 22:32:46 +00009804
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +00009805 return MadeChange ? &SVI : 0;
9806}
9807
9808
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +00009809
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +00009810
9811/// TryToSinkInstruction - Try to move the specified instruction from its
9812/// current block into the beginning of DestBlock, which can only happen if it's
9813/// safe to move the instruction past all of the instructions between it and the
9814/// end of its block.
9815static bool TryToSinkInstruction(Instruction *I, BasicBlock *DestBlock) {
9816 assert(I->hasOneUse() && "Invariants didn't hold!");
9817
Chris Lattner108e9022005-10-27 17:13:11 +00009818 // Cannot move control-flow-involving, volatile loads, vaarg, etc.
9819 if (isa<PHINode>(I) || I->mayWriteToMemory()) return false;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009820
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +00009821 // Do not sink alloca instructions out of the entry block.
Dan Gohmanecb7a772007-03-22 16:38:57 +00009822 if (isa<AllocaInst>(I) && I->getParent() ==
9823 &DestBlock->getParent()->getEntryBlock())
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +00009824 return false;
9825
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +00009826 // We can only sink load instructions if there is nothing between the load and
9827 // the end of block that could change the value.
9828 if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(I)) {
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +00009829 for (BasicBlock::iterator Scan = LI, E = LI->getParent()->end();
9830 Scan != E; ++Scan)
9831 if (Scan->mayWriteToMemory())
9832 return false;
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +00009833 }
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +00009834
9835 BasicBlock::iterator InsertPos = DestBlock->begin();
9836 while (isa<PHINode>(InsertPos)) ++InsertPos;
9837
Chris Lattner4bc5f802005-08-08 19:11:57 +00009838 I->moveBefore(InsertPos);
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +00009839 ++NumSunkInst;
9840 return true;
9841}
9842
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +00009843
9844/// AddReachableCodeToWorklist - Walk the function in depth-first order, adding
9845/// all reachable code to the worklist.
9846///
9847/// This has a couple of tricks to make the code faster and more powerful. In
9848/// particular, we constant fold and DCE instructions as we go, to avoid adding
9849/// them to the worklist (this significantly speeds up instcombine on code where
9850/// many instructions are dead or constant). Additionally, if we find a branch
9851/// whose condition is a known constant, we only visit the reachable successors.
9852///
9853static void AddReachableCodeToWorklist(BasicBlock *BB,
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +00009854 SmallPtrSet<BasicBlock*, 64> &Visited,
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009855 InstCombiner &IC,
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +00009856 const TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +00009857 std::vector<BasicBlock*> Worklist;
9858 Worklist.push_back(BB);
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +00009859
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +00009860 while (!Worklist.empty()) {
9861 BB = Worklist.back();
9862 Worklist.pop_back();
9863
9864 // We have now visited this block! If we've already been here, ignore it.
9865 if (!Visited.insert(BB)) continue;
9866
9867 for (BasicBlock::iterator BBI = BB->begin(), E = BB->end(); BBI != E; ) {
9868 Instruction *Inst = BBI++;
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +00009869
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +00009870 // DCE instruction if trivially dead.
9871 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(Inst)) {
9872 ++NumDeadInst;
9873 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *Inst;
9874 Inst->eraseFromParent();
9875 continue;
9876 }
9877
9878 // ConstantProp instruction if trivially constant.
9879 if (Constant *C = ConstantFoldInstruction(Inst, TD)) {
9880 DOUT << "IC: ConstFold to: " << *C << " from: " << *Inst;
9881 Inst->replaceAllUsesWith(C);
9882 ++NumConstProp;
9883 Inst->eraseFromParent();
9884 continue;
9885 }
Chris Lattner3ccc6bc2007-07-20 22:06:41 +00009886
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +00009887 IC.AddToWorkList(Inst);
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +00009888 }
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +00009889
9890 // Recursively visit successors. If this is a branch or switch on a
9891 // constant, only visit the reachable successor.
9892 TerminatorInst *TI = BB->getTerminator();
9893 if (BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(TI)) {
9894 if (BI->isConditional() && isa<ConstantInt>(BI->getCondition())) {
9895 bool CondVal = cast<ConstantInt>(BI->getCondition())->getZExtValue();
9896 Worklist.push_back(BI->getSuccessor(!CondVal));
9897 continue;
9898 }
9899 } else if (SwitchInst *SI = dyn_cast<SwitchInst>(TI)) {
9900 if (ConstantInt *Cond = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getCondition())) {
9901 // See if this is an explicit destination.
9902 for (unsigned i = 1, e = SI->getNumSuccessors(); i != e; ++i)
9903 if (SI->getCaseValue(i) == Cond) {
9904 Worklist.push_back(SI->getSuccessor(i));
9905 continue;
9906 }
9907
9908 // Otherwise it is the default destination.
9909 Worklist.push_back(SI->getSuccessor(0));
9910 continue;
9911 }
9912 }
9913
9914 for (unsigned i = 0, e = TI->getNumSuccessors(); i != e; ++i)
9915 Worklist.push_back(TI->getSuccessor(i));
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +00009916 }
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +00009917}
9918
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +00009919bool InstCombiner::DoOneIteration(Function &F, unsigned Iteration) {
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00009920 bool Changed = false;
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +00009921 TD = &getAnalysis<TargetData>();
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +00009922
9923 DEBUG(DOUT << "\n\nINSTCOMBINE ITERATION #" << Iteration << " on "
9924 << F.getNameStr() << "\n");
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00009925
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +00009926 {
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +00009927 // Do a depth-first traversal of the function, populate the worklist with
9928 // the reachable instructions. Ignore blocks that are not reachable. Keep
9929 // track of which blocks we visit.
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +00009930 SmallPtrSet<BasicBlock*, 64> Visited;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009931 AddReachableCodeToWorklist(F.begin(), Visited, *this, TD);
Jeff Cohen00b168892005-07-27 06:12:32 +00009932
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +00009933 // Do a quick scan over the function. If we find any blocks that are
9934 // unreachable, remove any instructions inside of them. This prevents
9935 // the instcombine code from having to deal with some bad special cases.
9936 for (Function::iterator BB = F.begin(), E = F.end(); BB != E; ++BB)
9937 if (!Visited.count(BB)) {
9938 Instruction *Term = BB->getTerminator();
9939 while (Term != BB->begin()) { // Remove instrs bottom-up
9940 BasicBlock::iterator I = Term; --I;
Chris Lattner6ffe5512004-04-27 15:13:33 +00009941
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +00009942 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *I;
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +00009943 ++NumDeadInst;
9944
9945 if (!I->use_empty())
9946 I->replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(I->getType()));
9947 I->eraseFromParent();
9948 }
9949 }
9950 }
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00009951
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009952 while (!Worklist.empty()) {
9953 Instruction *I = RemoveOneFromWorkList();
9954 if (I == 0) continue; // skip null values.
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00009955
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +00009956 // Check to see if we can DCE the instruction.
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +00009957 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(I)) {
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +00009958 // Add operands to the worklist.
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +00009959 if (I->getNumOperands() < 4)
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00009960 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +00009961 ++NumDeadInst;
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +00009962
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +00009963 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *I;
Chris Lattnerad5fec12005-01-28 19:32:01 +00009964
9965 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009966 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +00009967 continue;
9968 }
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +00009969
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +00009970 // Instruction isn't dead, see if we can constant propagate it.
Chris Lattner0a19ffa2007-01-30 23:16:15 +00009971 if (Constant *C = ConstantFoldInstruction(I, TD)) {
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +00009972 DOUT << "IC: ConstFold to: " << *C << " from: " << *I;
Chris Lattnerad5fec12005-01-28 19:32:01 +00009973
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +00009974 // Add operands to the worklist.
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00009975 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattnerc736d562002-12-05 22:41:53 +00009976 ReplaceInstUsesWith(*I, C);
9977
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +00009978 ++NumConstProp;
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +00009979 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009980 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +00009981 continue;
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +00009982 }
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +00009983
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +00009984 // See if we can trivially sink this instruction to a successor basic block.
9985 if (I->hasOneUse()) {
9986 BasicBlock *BB = I->getParent();
9987 BasicBlock *UserParent = cast<Instruction>(I->use_back())->getParent();
9988 if (UserParent != BB) {
9989 bool UserIsSuccessor = false;
9990 // See if the user is one of our successors.
9991 for (succ_iterator SI = succ_begin(BB), E = succ_end(BB); SI != E; ++SI)
9992 if (*SI == UserParent) {
9993 UserIsSuccessor = true;
9994 break;
9995 }
9996
9997 // If the user is one of our immediate successors, and if that successor
9998 // only has us as a predecessors (we'd have to split the critical edge
9999 // otherwise), we can keep going.
10000 if (UserIsSuccessor && !isa<PHINode>(I->use_back()) &&
10001 next(pred_begin(UserParent)) == pred_end(UserParent))
10002 // Okay, the CFG is simple enough, try to sink this instruction.
10003 Changed |= TryToSinkInstruction(I, UserParent);
10004 }
10005 }
10006
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000010007 // Now that we have an instruction, try combining it to simplify it...
Reid Spencera9b81012007-03-26 17:44:01 +000010008#ifndef NDEBUG
10009 std::string OrigI;
10010#endif
10011 DEBUG(std::ostringstream SS; I->print(SS); OrigI = SS.str(););
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000010012 if (Instruction *Result = visit(*I)) {
Chris Lattner3dec1f22002-05-10 15:38:35 +000010013 ++NumCombined;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000010014 // Should we replace the old instruction with a new one?
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +000010015 if (Result != I) {
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000010016 DOUT << "IC: Old = " << *I
10017 << " New = " << *Result;
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +000010018
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000010019 // Everything uses the new instruction now.
10020 I->replaceAllUsesWith(Result);
10021
10022 // Push the new instruction and any users onto the worklist.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010023 AddToWorkList(Result);
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000010024 AddUsersToWorkList(*Result);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000010025
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000010026 // Move the name to the new instruction first.
10027 Result->takeName(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000010028
10029 // Insert the new instruction into the basic block...
10030 BasicBlock *InstParent = I->getParent();
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010031 BasicBlock::iterator InsertPos = I;
10032
10033 if (!isa<PHINode>(Result)) // If combining a PHI, don't insert
10034 while (isa<PHINode>(InsertPos)) // middle of a block of PHIs.
10035 ++InsertPos;
10036
10037 InstParent->getInstList().insert(InsertPos, Result);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000010038
Chris Lattner00d51312004-05-01 23:27:23 +000010039 // Make sure that we reprocess all operands now that we reduced their
10040 // use counts.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010041 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattner216d4d82004-05-01 23:19:52 +000010042
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000010043 // Instructions can end up on the worklist more than once. Make sure
10044 // we do not process an instruction that has been deleted.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010045 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000010046
10047 // Erase the old instruction.
10048 InstParent->getInstList().erase(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +000010049 } else {
Evan Chengc7baf682007-03-27 16:44:48 +000010050#ifndef NDEBUG
Reid Spencera9b81012007-03-26 17:44:01 +000010051 DOUT << "IC: Mod = " << OrigI
10052 << " New = " << *I;
Evan Chengc7baf682007-03-27 16:44:48 +000010053#endif
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +000010054
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000010055 // If the instruction was modified, it's possible that it is now dead.
10056 // if so, remove it.
Chris Lattner00d51312004-05-01 23:27:23 +000010057 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(I)) {
10058 // Make sure we process all operands now that we are reducing their
10059 // use counts.
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000010060 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010061
Chris Lattner00d51312004-05-01 23:27:23 +000010062 // Instructions may end up in the worklist more than once. Erase all
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000010063 // occurrences of this instruction.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010064 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010065 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000010066 } else {
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000010067 AddToWorkList(I);
10068 AddUsersToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000010069 }
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +000010070 }
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000010071 Changed = true;
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000010072 }
10073 }
10074
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000010075 assert(WorklistMap.empty() && "Worklist empty, but map not?");
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000010076 return Changed;
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000010077}
10078
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000010079
10080bool InstCombiner::runOnFunction(Function &F) {
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +000010081 MustPreserveLCSSA = mustPreserveAnalysisID(LCSSAID);
10082
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000010083 bool EverMadeChange = false;
10084
10085 // Iterate while there is work to do.
10086 unsigned Iteration = 0;
10087 while (DoOneIteration(F, Iteration++))
10088 EverMadeChange = true;
10089 return EverMadeChange;
10090}
10091
Brian Gaeke96d4bf72004-07-27 17:43:21 +000010092FunctionPass *llvm::createInstructionCombiningPass() {
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000010093 return new InstCombiner();
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000010094}
Brian Gaeked0fde302003-11-11 22:41:34 +000010095